Yamaha RX-A1070 de handleiding

Categorie
Auto media-ontvangers
Type
de handleiding
AV Receiver
Owner’s Manual
EN
This unit is a product for enjoying video and music at home.
This manual explains preparations and operations for everyday users of the unit.
Read the supplied booklet “Quick Start Guide” before using the unit.
En 2
CONTENTS
Introduction 5
Accessories................................................................................... 5
About this book ............................................................................ 5
About remote control .................................................................... 6
Batteries ......................................................................................................................................................... 6
Operating range of the remote control......................................................................................................... 6
FEATURES 7
What you can do with the unit........................................................ 7
AV CONTROLLER............................................................................................................................................. 9
AV SETUP GUIDE (for tablet) .......................................................................................................................... 9
Application for smartphone / tablets “MusicCast CONTROLLER”............................................................... 9
Part names and functions .............................................................10
Front panel ................................................................................................................................................... 10
Front display (indicators) ............................................................................................................................ 12
Rear panel..................................................................................................................................................... 13
Remote control ............................................................................................................................................ 15
PREPARATIONS 16
General setup procedure ..............................................................16
1 Connecting speakers ..................................................................17
Basic speaker configuration ........................................................................................................................ 18
Advanced speaker configuration ................................................................................................................ 26
2 Connecting a TV and playback devices .........................................32
Input/output jacks and cables .................................................................................................................... 32
Connecting a TV ........................................................................................................................................... 33
Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) ................................................................................. 34
Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) ......................................................................................... 36
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel ................................................................................................ 37
3 Connecting the radio antennas....................................................38
FM/AM antennas (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) ......................................................38
DAB/FM antenna (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) ..........................................................38
4 Connecting a network cable or preparing the wireless antenna .....39
Connecting the network cable.....................................................................................................................39
Preparing the wireless antenna ...................................................................................................................39
5 Connecting other devices............................................................40
Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function ........................................................................40
6 Connecting the power cable........................................................40
7 Selecting an on-screen menu language ........................................41
8 Configuring the necessary speaker settings..................................42
9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) ..................43
Measuring at one listening position (single measure) ................................................................................45
Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)........................................................................46
Checking the measurement results .............................................................................................................47
Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments .................................................................................................48
Error messages .............................................................................................................................................49
Warning messages........................................................................................................................................50
10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly .................................51
Selecting the connection method ...............................................................................................................51
Connecting the unit to a wireless network..................................................................................................52
Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct) .............................................................57
11 Connecting to the MusicCast network ........................................59
MusicCast CONTROLLER ..............................................................................................................................59
Adding the unit to the MusicCast network ..................................................................................................59
PLAYBACK 60
Basic playback procedure.............................................................60
Selecting an HDMI output jack.....................................................................................................................60
Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch
(SCENE) ......................................................................................61
En 3
Registering a scene ...................................................................................................................................... 62
Selecting setting items to be included as scene assignments................................................................... 62
Selecting the sound mode.............................................................63
Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP HD
3
) ............................................................................. 64
Enjoying unprocessed playback.................................................................................................................. 67
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct).......................................................................................... 68
Playing back digitally compressed formats (such as MP3, etc.) with enriched sound
(Compressed Music Enhancer).................................................................................................................... 68
Listening to FM/AM radio
(except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) ........................69
Setting the frequency steps......................................................................................................................... 69
Selecting a frequency for reception............................................................................................................ 69
Registering favorite radio stations (presets) .............................................................................................. 70
Operating the radio on the TV ..................................................................................................................... 71
Listening to DAB radio
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)............................72
Preparing the DAB tuning ............................................................................................................................ 72
Selecting a DAB radio station for reception................................................................................................ 72
Registering favorite DAB radio stations (presets)....................................................................................... 73
Displaying the DAB information .................................................................................................................. 74
Checking reception strength of each DAB channel label ...........................................................................74
Listening to FM radio
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)............................76
Selecting a frequency for reception............................................................................................................ 76
Registering favorite FM radio stations (presets)......................................................................................... 76
Radio Data System tuning ........................................................................................................................... 78
Operating the radio on the TV ..................................................................................................................... 79
Playing back music via Bluetooth ..................................................80
Playing back Bluetooth device music on the unit ...................................................................................... 80
Enjoying audio using Bluetooth speakers/headphones ............................................................................ 81
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device.........................82
Connecting a USB storage device ............................................................................................................... 82
Playback of USB storage device contents .................................................................................................. 82
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) ...................85
Media sharing setup..................................................................................................................................... 85
Playback of PC music contents ................................................................................................................... 86
Listening to Internet radio ............................................................89
Playback of Internet radio............................................................................................................................89
Registering favorite Internet radio stations (Favorites) .............................................................................91
Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay..................................92
Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents ....................................................................................................92
Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) ..............94
Multi-zone configuration examples .............................................................................................................94
Preparing Zone2 ...........................................................................................................................................95
Controlling Zone2.........................................................................................................................................98
Registering favorite items (shortcut)........................................... 100
Registering an item.....................................................................................................................................100
Recalling a registered item.........................................................................................................................100
Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) ................. 101
Top menu screen ........................................................................................................................................102
Control screen.............................................................................................................................................102
Settings screen............................................................................................................................................103
Viewing the current status.......................................................... 104
Switching information on the front display ..............................................................................................104
Viewing the status information on the TV .................................................................................................105
Configuring playback settings for different playback sources
(Option menu)........................................................................... 106
Option menu items.....................................................................................................................................106
CONFIGURATIONS 111
Configuring input sources (Input menu)....................................... 111
Input menu items .......................................................................................................................................111
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) ............................. 113
Scene menu items ......................................................................................................................................113
Configuring sound programs/surround decoders
(DSP Program menu) ................................................................. 116
DSP Program menu items ..........................................................................................................................117
Configuring various functions (Setup menu) ................................ 119
Setup menu items.......................................................................................................................................120
Speaker (Manual Setup) .............................................................................................................................123
Sound ..........................................................................................................................................................127
Video............................................................................................................................................................129
En 4
HDMI ........................................................................................................................................................... 130
Network ...................................................................................................................................................... 131
Bluetooth.................................................................................................................................................... 133
Multi Zone................................................................................................................................................... 134
Function...................................................................................................................................................... 137
ECO ............................................................................................................................................................. 139
Language .................................................................................................................................................... 140
Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) ...............140
Types of information.................................................................................................................................. 141
Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu)............ 142
ADVANCED SETUP menu items ................................................................................................................. 143
Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) ..................................................................... 143
Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR)................................................................ 143
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID)........................................................................................... 144
Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TUNER FRQ STEP) ........................................................ 144
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) .......................................................................................... 144
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK)....................................................... 144
Selecting the HDMI 4K signal format (4K MODE) ...................................................................................... 145
Switching the DTS format notification setting (DTS MODE) .................................................................... 145
Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) ........................................................................... 145
Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE)............................................................................................... 146
Updating the firmware (FIRM. UPDATE).................................................................................................... 146
Checking the firmware version (VERSION) ............................................................................................... 146
Updating the unit’s firmware via the network .............................. 147
Updating the unit’s firmware immediately .............................................................................................. 147
Updating the unit’s firmware at power off ............................................................................................... 148
APPENDIX 149
Frequently asked questions ........................................................ 149
Troubleshooting ........................................................................150
First, check the following:.......................................................................................................................... 150
Power, system and remote control........................................................................................................... 150
Audio........................................................................................................................................................... 151
Video ........................................................................................................................................................... 153
FM/AM radio (AM radio feature is not available on the Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models)..... 154
DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) ................................................................... 154
Bluetooth ....................................................................................................................................................155
USB and network ........................................................................................................................................156
Error indications on the front display .......................................... 158
Glossary.................................................................................... 159
Audio information (audio decoding format) .............................................................................................159
Audio Information (Others) ........................................................................................................................161
HDMI and video information ......................................................................................................................161
Network information ..................................................................................................................................162
Yamaha technologies .................................................................................................................................162
Supported devices and file formats ............................................. 163
Supported devices......................................................................................................................................163
File formats .................................................................................................................................................163
Video signal flow........................................................................ 164
Video conversion table ...............................................................................................................................164
Multi-zone output .......................................................................................................................................165
Information on HDMI.................................................................. 165
HDMI Control...............................................................................................................................................165
Audio Return Channel (ARC) ......................................................................................................................167
HDMI signal compatibility ..........................................................................................................................167
Trademarks............................................................................... 168
Specifications............................................................................ 169
En 5
Introduction
Accessories
Check that the following accessories are supplied with the product.
#
AM antenna
(except Australia, U.K., Europe and
Russia models)
#
FM antenna
(except Australia, U.K., Europe and
Russia models)
#
DAB/FM antenna
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia
models only)
#
YPAO microphone
#
Power cable
#
Remote control
#
Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x2)
#
CD-ROM (Owner’s Manual)
#
Quick Start Guide
* (Except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models)
One of the above FM antennas is supplied depending on the region of purchase.
* The supplied power cable varies depending on the region of purchase.
About this book
The illustrations of the main unit and remote control used in this manual are of the U.S.A.
model, unless otherwise specified.
In this manual, illustrations of English menu screens are used as examples.
(China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
For information on how to control external devices with the remote control, refer to
Supplement for Remote Control” on the supplied CD-ROM.
Some features are not available in certain regions.
Due to product improvements, specifications and appearance are subject to change without
notice.
This manual explains operations using the supplied remote control.
This manual describes all the “iPod touch”, “iPhone” and “iPad” as the “iPod”. “iPod” refers to
“iPod touch”, “iPhone” and “iPad”, unless otherwise specified.
Icons used in this manual
Y
indicates precautions for use of the unit and its feature limitations.
X
indicates supplementary explanations for better use.
En 6
About remote control
This section explains how to use the supplied remote control.
Batteries
Insert the batteries the right way round.
Operating range of the remote control
Point the remote control at the remote control sensor on the unit and remain within the
operating range shown below.
30° 30°
Within
6 m (20 ft)
En 7
FEATURES
What you can do with the unit
The unit is equipped with the various useful features.
Connecting various devices (p.32)
A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks on
the unit allow you to connect video devices (such as BD/DVD
players), audio devices (such as CD players), game consoles,
camcorders, and other devices.
Playing back TV audio in surround
sound with a single HDMI cable
connection (Audio Return Channel:
ARC) (p.32)
When using an ARC-compatible TV, you only need one HDMI
cable to enable video output to the TV, audio input from the
TV, and the transmission of HDMI Control signals.
More advanced ENTERTAINMENT
sound programs (p.65)
By processing front left and front right sound fields
individually, the ENTERTAINMENT sound programs are
further improved in acoustic positioning and sound
transition. These programs allow you to enjoy clearer vocal
and instrumental sounds, distinct narrations, and more
dynamic sound effects.
Various wireless connection
methods (p.51)
The unit supports the Wi-Fi feature that allows the unit to
connect to your wireless router (access point) without a
network cable connection. In addition, Wireless Direct
enables connecting a mobile device to the unit directly
without router.
Surround playback with 5 speakers
placed in front (p.66)
If you have surround speakers but there is no space to place
them in the rear of your room, you can place them in the
front and enjoy multichannel surround sound with the 5
speakers placed in the front (Virtual CINEMA FRONT).
Home Audio Network with
MusicCast (p.59)
The unit supports the MusicCast feature that allows you to
link a MusicCast compatible device to another device in a
different room and play them back simultaneously, or
control all MusicCast compatible devices with the dedicated
application “MusicCast CONTROLLER”.
Low power consumption (p.140)
The ECO mode (power saving function) reduces the unit’s
power consumption.
HDMI Control
TV audio
Video from external
device
PL
Presence L
Sound field
PR
Presence R
Sound field
SL
Surround L
Sound field
SR
Surround R
Sound field
Image of sound field processing
En 8
CINEMA DSP
The excitement of a concert hall and the powerful sense of being inside a movie - we all want to enjoy these experiences in our own living room. Yamaha has pursued the fulfillment of these desires
for more than 30 years, and this fulfillment has now taken shape as the Yamaha AV receivers.
What is a sound field?
We perceive sound from a voice or an instrument not only as the sounds that are heard directly
but also as the “reflected” or “reverberant” sound that has been reflected by the walls or
ceiling of the building. The character of the reflected and reverberant sound is affected by the
shape, size, and material of the building, and all of these sounds taken together are what give
us the auditory sensation of being in that specific place.
This unique acoustical character of a specific space is what we call the “sound field”.
Conceptual diagram of a concert hall’s sound field
Conceptual diagram of a sound field created by the unit
CINEMA DSP
Yamaha has accumulated a massive amount of acoustical data by analyzing the actual sound
fields of concert halls and performance spaces around the world. “CINEMA DSP” allows this
data to be applied to create sound fields. This unit contains a wide variety of sound programs
using CINEMA DSP.
By selecting a sound program that is appropriate to the content of the playback source such as
movies, music, or games, you can maximize the acoustical effectiveness of that specific
content. (For example, a sound program designed for movies can give you the sensation of
actually being in that scene.)
CINEMA DSP HD
3
CINEMA DSP HD
3
” is Yamaha’s flagship 3D sound field playback technology that takes full
advantage of the massive amount of acoustic reflection data included in the sound field data.
It delivers more than twice as much capability for generating acoustic reflections as
conventional CINEMA DSP 3D, in addition to high-frequency playback capability, delivering an
utterly natural and powerful spatial sound field.
Capability for reproducing reflections
(when the sound program “Hall in Munich” is selected)
CINEMA DSP HD
3
Level
CINEMA DSP 3D
Time
En 9
Useful applications
The following applications provide you the flexibility to control the unit or assist you with the cable connections.
AV CONTROLLER
AV CONTROLLER” will turn your smartphone/tablet into a
Wi-Fi enabled remote control for your Yamaha network
products. This application provides you the flexibility to
control the available inputs, volume, mute, power
commands and playback source.
Functions
Power on/off and volume adjustment
Input, scene and sound mode selection
DSP Parameter adjustment
Playback control (including music selection for some
sources)
X
For details, search forAV CONTROLLER” on the App Store or Google
Play.
AV SETUP GUIDE (for tablet)
AV SETUP GUIDE” is an application that assists you with
cable connections between AV receiver and source devices
as well as AV receiver setup. This application guides you
through the various settings such as speaker connections,
TV and video/audio device connections and selecting the
speaker system.
Functions
Connection guide (speakers, TV and video/audio devices)
Setup guide (YPAO settings and various setup assistance
with illustrations)
Viewing owner’s manual
X
For details, search for “AV SETUP GUIDE” on the App Store or Google
Play.
MusicCast CONTROLLER
MusicCast CONTROLLER is an application that allows you to
link a MusicCast compatible device to other MusicCast
compatible devices in other rooms and play them back
simultaneously. This app lets you use your smartphone or
other mobile device instead of the remote control to easily
select music to play back as well as configure the unit and
MusicCast compatible devices.
Functions
Selecting and playing back various content
– Play back music from your mobile device
– Select an Internet radio station
– Play back music files stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
– Play back music files stored on a USB storage device
Operating and configuring the unit
– Select the input source, adjust the volume and mute the
audio output
– Select from a wide variety of sound processing features
X
For details, search for “MusicCast CONTROLLER” on the App Store or
Google Play.
En 10
Part names and functions
This section explains the functions of the parts of the unit.
Front panel
a MAIN ZONE z key
Turns on/off (standby) the unit.
b Standby indicator
Lights up when the unit is in standby mode under any of the
following conditions.
HDMI Control is enabled (p.130)
Standby Through is enabled (p.131)
Network Standby is enabled (p.132)
Bluetooth Standby is enabled (p.133)
c Front display
Displays information (p.12).
d Remote control sensor
Receives remote control signals (p.6).
e PURE DIRECT key
Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.68).
f INPUT knob
Selects an input source.
g Front panel door
For protecting controls and jacks (p.11).
h VOLUME knob
Adjusts the volume.
Opening the front panel door
To use controls or jacks behind the front panel door, gently
press the bottom of the door to open it. Keep the door closed
when not using controls or jacks behind the front panel door.
(Be careful not to trap your fingers.)
INPUT
MAIN ZONE
VOLUME
PURE DIRECT
eb c da
f
h
g
En 11
Inside of the front panel door
a ON SCREEN key
Displays the on-screen menu on the TV.
b Menu operations keys
Cursor keys: Select a menu or a parameter.
ENTER: Confirms a selected item.
RETURN: Returns to the previous screen.
c OPTION key
Displays the option menu (p.106).
d DISPLAY key
Displays status information on the TV (p.105).
e TONE CONTROL key
Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of
output sounds (p.107).
f STRAIGHT (CONNECT) key
Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.67).
Enters MusicCast CONTROLLER registration by holding down for 5
seconds (p.59).
g PROGRAM keys
Select a sound program or a surround decoder (p.63).
h SCENE keys
Select the assigned input source (including the selected radio
station or content when it is assigned), sound program, and
various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is
in standby mode (p.61).
i MULTI ZONE keys
ZONE 2: Enables/disables the audio output to Zone2 (p.98).
ZONE CONTROL: Changes the zone (main zone or Zone2) that is
controlled by the keys and knobs on the front panel (p.98).
j INFO (WPS) key
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.104).
Enters the wireless network connection setup (WPS push button
configuration) by holding down for 3 seconds (p.53).
k MEMORY key
Registers FM/AM/DAB radio stations as preset stations (p.70, p.73,
p.76).
Registers USB/network contents or Bluetooth input source as
shortcuts (p.100).
l FM and AM keys (except Australia, U.K., Europe and
Russia models)
Switch between FM and AM (p.69).
FM and DAB keys (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia
models only)
Switch between FM and DAB (p.72, p.69).
m PRESET keys
Select a preset FM/DAB radio station (p.73, p.77) (Australia, U.K.,
Europe and Russia models) or a preset FM/AM radio station (p.70)
(other models).
Selects a USB/network content from shortcuts (p.100).
n TUNING keys
Select the radio frequency (p.69).
o USB jack
For connecting a USB storage device (p.82).
p YPAO MIC jack
For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.43).
q PHONES jack
For connecting headphones.
r VIDEO AUX jacks
For connecting a device, such as a camcorder and a game console
(p.37).
OPTION
ON SCREEN
DISPLAY
RETURN
MULTI ZONE
VIDEO AUX
ZONE 2
ZONE CONTROL
YPAO MIC
PHONES
USB
SILENT CINEMA
TONE CONTROL
STRAIGHT
(
CONNECT
)
PROGRAM
SCENE
1234
HDMI IN
RL AUDIO
INFO(WPS)
MEMORY
FM AM
TUNING
PRESET
ENTER
5V 1A
a c e f j k mg l ndb
o p q
hi
r
(U.S.A. model)
En 12
Front display (indicators)
a HDMI
Lights up when HDMI signals are being input or output.
IN
Lights up when HDMI signals are being input.
OUT1/OUT2
Indicates the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI signal.
b ECO
Lights up when the unit is in the eco mode (p.140).
c Firmware update indicator
Lights up when a firmware update is available via the network
(p.147)
d LINK MASTER
Lights up when the unit is the master device of the MusicCast
network.
e ZONE2
Lights up when Zone2 is enabled (p.98).
f STEREO
Lights up when the unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal.
TUNED
Lights up when the unit is receiving an FM radio station signal
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) or an FM/AM radio
station signal (other models).
g PARTY
Lights up when the unit is in the party mode (p.99).
h Information display
Displays the current status (such as input name and sound mode
name). You can switch the information by pressing INFO (p.104).
i Volume indicator
Indicates the current volume.
j MUTE
Blinks when audio is temporarily muted.
k A-DRC
Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.107) is working.
l Signal strength indicator
Indicates the strength of the wireless network signal (p.51).
m Bluetooth indicator
Lights up when the unit is connecting to a Bluetooth device (p.80).
n Hi-Res
Lights up when the high-resolution mode (p.109) is working.
o CINEMA DSP indicator
CINEMA DSP HD” lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.64) is working.
CINEMA DSP !” lights up when CINEMA DSP HD
3
is activated.
p ENHANCER
Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68) is working.
q SLEEP
Lights up when the sleep timer is on.
r Cursor indicators
Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational.
s VIRTUAL
Lights up when the Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) or Virtual
Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) (p.64), or the virtual surround
processing (p.66) is working.
t Speaker indicators
Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output.
A Front speaker (L)
S Front speaker (R)
D Center speaker
F Surround speaker (L)
G Surround speaker (R)
H Surround back speaker (L)
J Surround back speaker (R)
K Surround back speaker
B Front presence speaker (L)
N Front presence speaker (R)
L Subwoofer
u YPAO VOL.
Lights up when YPAO Volume is enabled (p.107).
OUT
21
IN
A-DRC
VOL.
VIRTUAL
YPAO VOL.
3
ZONE
ECO
2
SBL SBRSB
SL
SW
SR
FPL
CL R
FPR
ENHANCER
SLEEP
STEREO TUNED
PARTY
MUTE
HD
LINK MASTER
Hi
-
Res
f
j
ki
h
ge
dbc
En 13
Rear panel
(U.S.A. model)
* The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper
connections.
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
AC IN
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R
5
6
L R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
AM
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
RS-232C
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
NETWORK
( 3
NET
)
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
p
n
qo
a d ic e mg h kfb
lj
En 14
a PHONO jacks
For connecting to a turntable (p.36).
b AUDIO 1-3 jacks
For connecting to audio playback devices and inputting audio signals (p.36).
c AV 1-4 jacks
For connecting to video/audio playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.34).
d HDMI OUT 1 jack
For connecting to an HDMI-compatible TV and outputting video/audio signals (p.32). When using ARC, TV
audio signal can also be input through the HDMI OUT 1 jack.
HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack
For connecting to an HDMI-compatible TV and outputting video/audio signals (p.33), or for connecting to
an HDMI-compatible device used in Zone2 (p.96).
e COMPONENT VIDEO (AV 1-2) jacks
For connecting to video playback devices that support component video and inputting video signals
(p.34).
f HDMI (AV 1-7) jacks
For connecting to HDMI-compatible playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.34).
g TRIGGER OUT 1-2 jacks
For connecting to devices that support the trigger function (p.40).
h REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
For connecting to an infrared signal receiver/emitter that allows you to operate the unit and other
devices from another room (p.96).
i NETWORK jack
For connecting to a network with a network cable (p.39).
j Wireless antenna
For a wireless (Wi-Fi) connection to a network (p.51) and a Bluetooth connection (p.80).
k RS-232C terminal
This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation. Consult your dealer for details.
l VOLTAGE SELECTOR
(Brazil and General models only)
Selects the switch position according to your local voltage (p.40).
m AC IN jack
For connecting the supplied power cable (p.40).
n ANTENNA jacks
For connecting to radio antennas (p.38).
o ZONE OUT jacks
For connecting to the external amplifier used in Zone2 and for outputting audio (p.95).
p SPEAKERS terminals
For connecting to speakers (p.17).
q PRE OUT jacks
For connecting to a subwoofer with built-in amplifier (p.23) or to an external power amplifier (p.31).
En 15
Remote control
a Remote control signal transmitter
Transmits infrared signals.
b z (receiver power) key
Turns on/off (standby) the unit.
c Input selection keys
Select an input source for playback.
AV 1-7: AV 1-7 jacks
V-AUX: VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel)
AUDIO 1-3: AUDIO 1-3 jacks
PHONO: PHONO jacks
TUNER: FM/AM/DAB radio
BLUETOOTH: Bluetooth connection
(the unit as a Bluetooth receiver)
USB: USB jack (on the front panel)
NET: NETWORK sources
(press repeatedly to select a desired network source)
d MAIN/ZONE2 switch
Changes the zone (main zone or Zone2) that is controlled by the
remote control (p.98).
e SCENE keys
Select the registered input source, sound program, and various
settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is in
standby mode (p.61).
f PROGRAM keys
Select a sound program, a surround decoder, an input source, a
network source, a registered item (shortcut), a browse screen
page, the volume of dialogue sounds or shuffle/repeat settings
(p.137).
g External device operation keys
Displays menus for the HDMI Control-compatible playback device
(p.165).
h ON SCREEN key
Displays the on-screen menu on the TV.
i Menu operation keys
Cursor keys: Select a menu or the parameter.
ENTER: Confirms a selected item.
RETURN: Returns to the previous screen.
j Radio keys
Operate the FM/AM/DAB radio when “TUNER” is selected as the
input source (p.69).
BAND: Switches between FM and DAB radio (Australia, U.K.,
Europe and Russia models), or FM and AM radio (other models).
PRESET: Select a preset station.
TUNING: Select the radio frequency.
External device operation keys
Let you perform playback operations when “USB” or “NET” is
selected as the input source, or control playback of the HDMI
Control-compatible playback device (p.165).
k Sound mode keys
Select a sound mode (p.63).
l INFO key
Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.104).
m SLEEP key
Pressing this key repeatedly will specify the time (120 min, 90 min,
60 min, 30 min, off), in which the unit switches to the standby mode.
n Numeric keys
Let you enter numerical values, such as radio frequencies.
MEMORY key
Registers FM/AM/DAB radio stations as presets (p.70, p.73, p.76).
Registers USB/network contents or Bluetooth input source as
shortcuts (p.100).
o HDMI OUT key
Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output (p.60).
p PARTY key
Turns on/off the party mode (p.99).
q VOLUME keys
Adjust the volume.
r MUTE key
Mutes the audio output.
s OPTION key
Displays the option menu (p.106).
t DISPLAY key
Displays status information on the TV (p.105).
X
(China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
For information on the keys other than those above, refer to
Supplement for Remote Control” on the supplied CD-ROM.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUMEPROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
p
r
o
s
t
a
c
b
e
d
f
q
g
n
m
h
j
k
l
i
(U.S.A. model)
En 16
PREPARATIONS
General setup procedure
1 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.17)
2 Connecting a TV and playback devices. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.32)
3 Connecting the radio antennas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.38)
4 Connecting a network cable or preparing the wireless antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.39)
5 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.40)
6 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.40)
7 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.41)
8 Configuring the necessary speaker settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.42)
9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.43)
10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.51)
11 Connecting to the MusicCast network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.59)
This completes all the preparations. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio and other content with the unit!
En 17
1 Connecting speakers
The unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers to create the favorite acoustic space in your room.
You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system (p.26).
Ideal speaker layout Functions of each speaker
X
We recommend using front presence speakers to have a full effect of the 3-dimensional sound fields. However,
the unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce
3-dimensional sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected (p.64).
Use “Ideal speaker layout” (diagram on the right) as reference. You do not need to exactly adjust the speaker
layout to this diagram since the YPAO function of the unit will automatically optimize the speaker settings (such
as distances) to suit the speaker layout.
When using only one surround back speaker, place it straight behind the listening position (middle of “SBL
and “SBR” in the diagram).
Caution
Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the unit’s speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
For details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.23).
E
12
3
9
4
67
5
9
R
0.3 m (1 ft) or more
1.8 m
(5.9 ft)
0.5 to 1 m
(1.6 to 3.3 ft)
1.8 m
(5.9 ft)
0.5 to 1 m
(1.6 to 3.3 ft)
10°~30°10°~30°
Speaker type Function
Front (L/R)
1 2
Produce front left/right channel sounds (stereo sounds).
Center 3 Produces center channel sounds (such as movie dialogues and vocals).
Surround (L/R)
4 5
Produce surround left/right channel sounds. Surround speakers also produce
surround back channel sounds when no surround back speakers are connected.
Surround back (L/R)
6 7
Produce surround back left/right channel sounds.
Front presence (L/R)
E R
Produce CINEMA DSP effect sounds or heights channel sounds of Dolby Atmos
and DTS:X contents.
Subwoofer 9
Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces bass parts of
other channels.
This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers to the unit and
place them on the left/right (or front/rear) sides of the room.
En 18
Basic speaker configuration
If you do not apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external amplifier) or multi-zone configurations, follow the procedure below to place the speakers in your room and connect
them to the unit.
Placing speakers in your room
Depending on the number of speakers, place the speakers and subwoofer in your room. This
section describes the representative speaker layout examples.
X
To have a full effect of Dolby Atmos contents, we recommend using a speaker system with a S mark. However,
you can also play back Dolby Atmos contents with the 7.1 system (using surround back speakers).
To have a full effect of DTS:X contents, we recommend using a speaker system with a S mark.
(About the number of channels) For example, “5.1.2” denotes “standard 5.1-channel plus 2 for overhead
speaker channels”. For details on how to place overhead speakers (presence speakers), see “Presence speaker
layout” (p.22).
7.1/5.1.2 system [S]
(using both surround back and front presence speakers)
This speaker system brings out the full performance of the unit and allows you to enjoy a
highly-natural 3-dimensional sound field with any contents.
X
The surround back speakers and front presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. The unit
automatically changes the speakers to be used, depending on the input signal and CINEMA DSP (p.64).
When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling or when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the
presence speakers, configure the “Layout (Front Presence)” setting in the “Setup” menu before performing
YPAO (p.42).
En 19
5.1.2 system [S] (using front presence speakers)
This speaker system uses the front presence speakers to produce a natural 3-dimensional
sound field, and also creates Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround
speakers to add a sense of depth to the rear sound field. This system is suited for enjoying not
only 5.1-channel but also for 7.1-channel contents.
X
When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling or when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the
presence speakers, configure the “Layout (Front Presence)” setting in the “Setup” menu before performing YPAO
(p.42).
7.1 system (using surround back speakers)
This speaker system creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and
surround speakers to produce a 3-dimensional sound field, and also allows you to enjoy
extended surround sounds using the surround back speakers.
En 20
5.1 system
X
You can enjoy surround sound even without the center speaker (4.1 system).
5.1 system (front 5.1-channel) (using surround speakers)
We recommend using this speaker system when you cannot place speakers in the rear side of
the room.
X
When placing surround speakers in the front side, set “Layout (Surround)” in the “Setup” menu to “Front” before
performing YPAO (p.42).
45
12
39
En 21
5.1 system (front 5.1-channel) (using front presence speakers)
We recommend using this speaker system when you cannot place speakers in the rear side of
the room.
X
When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling or when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the
presence speakers, configure the “Layout (Front Presence)” setting in the “Setup” menu before performing YPAO
(p.42).
2.1 system
X
Add the center speaker to configure a 3.1 system.
1
2
39
ER
En 22
Presence speaker layout
The unit provides three layout patterns for presence speakers (Front Height, Overhead and
Dolby Enabled SP). Choose a layout pattern that suits your listening environment.
X
You can enjoy Dolby Atmos, DTS:X or Cinema DSP HD
3
with any layout pattern.
Front Height
Install the presence speakers on the front side wall.
It delivers a natural sound field with excellent linkage of left, right, top and bottom sound
spaces, and sound extensity effectively.
Overhead
Install the presence speakers to the ceiling above the listening position.
It delivers realistic overhead sound effects and sound field with excellent linkage of front and
rear sound spaces effectively.
Y
For details on the installation position of ceiling speakers, see “Notes on installation of ceiling speakers” (p.22).
Dolby Enabled SP
Use the Dolby Enabled speakers as the presence speakers.
It utilizes sounds reflected from ceiling and lets you enjoy overhead sounds only from speakers
that are placed at the same level as traditional speakers.
X
Place the Dolby Enabled speakers on top of or near the traditional front speakers. A Dolby Enabled speaker unit
may be integrated into a traditional speaker. For details, refer to the instruction manual of the Dolby Enabled
speakers.
Notes on installation of ceiling speakers
When installing presence speakers to a ceiling, install them just above the listening position,
or the ceiling between the extensions of the front speakers and listening position.
Caution
Be sure to use speakers that are made for ceiling use and take anti-drop measures. Ask a qualified
contractor or dealer personnel for installation works.
En 23
Setting the speaker impedance
Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When using a 6-ohm
speaker for any channel, set the speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use
4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
1
Before connecting speakers, connect the power cable to an AC wall outlet.
2
While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z.
3
Check that “SPEAKER IMP.” is displayed on the front display.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select “6 Ω MIN”.
5
Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and remove the power
cable from the AC wall outlet.
You are now ready to connect the speakers.
Connecting speakers
Connect the speakers placed in your room to the unit.
Precaution for connecting of the speaker cables
Prepare speaker cables in a place away from the unit, to avoid accidentally dropping wire
strands into the unit's interior which could result in a short circuit or malfunction of the unit.
Improper connecting of the speaker cables may cause short circuit and also damage the unit
or the speakers.
Remove the unit’s power cable from an AC wall outlet and turn off the subwoofer before
connecting the speakers.
Twist the bare wires of the speaker cables firmly together.
Do not let the bare wires of the speaker cable touch one another.
Do not let the bare wires of the speaker cable come into contact with the unit's metal parts
(rear panel and screws).
If “Check SP Wires” appear on the front display when the unit is turned on, turn off the unit, and
then check the speaker cables short circuit.
MAIN ZONE z STRAIGHT
¡¡¡¡¡¡¡¡¡8¬MIN
SPEAKER¡IMP.
En 24
Speakers to be connected
If you have nine speakers, you can connect the both surround back speakers and front
presence speakers. In this case, the unit automatically changes the speakers to be used,
depending on the input signal and CINEMA DSP.
If you have seven speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers (*1) or front presence
speakers (*2).
If you have five speakers, use two of them as surround speakers (*3) or front presence speakers
(*4).
X
You can also connect up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to the unit.
When apply this speaker configuration, set “Power Amp Assign” (p.123) to “Basic” (default).
To use an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, etc.) to enhance speaker output, see “Connecting an
external power amplifier” (p.31).
Cables necessary for connection (commercially available)
Speaker cables (x the number of speakers)
Audio pin cable (two for connecting two subwoofers)
Connection diagram
Refer to the following diagram and connect the speakers to the unit.
Y
When using only one surround back speaker, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side).
Speaker type
Speaker system
(the number of channels)
7.1/5.1.2 5.1 2.1
Front (L/R) 1 2 (((
Center 3 ((
Surround (L/R) 4 5 ()*3
Surround back (L/R) 6 7 )*1
Front presence (L/R) E R )*2 )*4
Subwoofer 9 (((
+
+
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R L R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1
EXTRA SP2
1
67
2
3
45
9
9
ER
The unit (rear)
En 25
Connecting speaker cables
Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting the negative (-) terminal of the unit and
the speaker, and the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are colored to prevent
confusion, connect the black wire to the negative and the other wire to the positive terminal.
1
Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from the ends of the speaker cable, and
twist the bare wires of the cable firmly together.
2
Loosen the speaker terminal.
3
Insert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side (upper right or bottom left) of the
terminal.
4
Tighten the terminal.
Using a banana plug
(U.S.A., Canada, China, Brazil and General models only)
1
Tighten the speaker terminal.
2
Insert a banana plug into the end of the terminal.
Connecting the subwoofer (with built-in amplifier)
Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer.
FRONT
+
11
2
2
4
4
33
+ (red)
– (black)
FRONT
+
11
22
Banana plug
(
SINGLE
)
(
FRONT
)
SUBWOOFER
PRE OUT
CENTER
SUR. BACKSURRUND
1
2
SURROUND BACK
Audio pin cable
En 26
Advanced speaker configuration
In addition to the basic speaker configuration (p.18), the unit also allows you to apply the following speaker configurations to enhance your system.
Using the four internal
amplifiers for front speakers to
have more high-quality sounds
(Example) (Example) (Example)
Bi-amp
connection
Combining with an external
power amplifier (Hi-Fi
amplifier, etc.) to build an
extended system
Using the excess internal
amplifiers for stereo speakers
in another room
External power
amplifier
Main zone
Zone2
Bi-amp connection Power-amp channel expansion Multi-zone configuration
En 27
Available speaker configurations
Y
When applying one of these configurations, you need to configure the Power Amp Assign” setting in the “Setup
menu (p.42).
7.1 +1Zone
X
When Zone2 output is enabled (p.98), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound.
Main zone
Multi-zone
Power Amp Assign
(p.123)
Page
Output
channel
(max)
Bi-amp
Surround
back/ Front
presence
External power
amplifier
(required)
7 Surround back +1 (Zone2) 7.1 +1Zone 27
7 Front presence +1 (Zone2) 5.1.2 +1Zone 28
5 ) 5.1 Bi-Amp 28
7 ) Surround back Surround back 7.1 Bi-Amp [ext.SB] 29
Speaker Connect to
12 FRONT
3 CENTER
45 SURROUND
67 SURROUND BACK
ER (not used)
9 SUBWOOFER 1-2
Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP1
21
12
3
4
6
99
7
5
Main zone
Zone2
En 28
5.1.2 +1Zone
X
When Zone2 output is enabled (p.98), the front presence speakers in the main zone do not output sound.
5.1 Bi-Amp
Speaker Connect to
12 FRONT
3 CENTER
45 SURROUND
67 (not used)
ER EXTRA SP1
9 SUBWOOFER 1-2
Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP2
21
1
ER
2
3
4
99
5
Main zone
Zone2
Speaker Connect to
12 FRONT and EXTRA SP 1 (bi-amp connection)
3 CENTER
45 SURROUND
67 (not used)
ER (not used)
9 SUBWOOFER 1-2
1
3
45
99
2
Bi-amp
En 29
7.1 Bi-Amp [ext.SB]
Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp
connections
When using front speakers that support bi-amp connections, connect them to the FRONT
terminals and EXTRA SP1 terminals.
To enable the bi-amp function, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting in the “Setup” menu
after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet (p.42).
X
The FRONT terminals and EXTRA SP1 terminals output the same signals.
Speaker Connect to
12 FRONT and EXTRA SP 1 (bi-amp connection)
3 CENTER
45 SURROUND
67 SUR.BACK (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier
ER (not used)
9 SUBWOOFER 1-2
1
3
45
99
2
67
Bi-amp
via external amp
Caution
Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a
tweeter. Refer to the instruction manual of the speakers for details. If you are not making bi-amp
connections, make sure that the brackets or cables are connected before connecting the speaker
cables.
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R L R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
12
3
9
45
9
The unit (rear)
En 30
Connecting Zone2 speakers
When using Zone2 speakers, connect them to the EXTRA SP1 or EXTRA SP2 terminals.
To utilize the EXTRA SP terminals for Zone2 speakers, configure the “Power Amp Assign
setting in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet (p.42).
X
You can also connect Zone2 speakers using an external amplifier (p.95).
(when using surround back speakers in the main zone)
(when using front presence speakers in the main zone)
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R L R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
12
3
45
76
99
The unit (rear)
Main zone
Zone2
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R L R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
12
3
45
99
ER
The unit (rear)
Main zone
Zone2
En 31
Connecting an external power amplifier
When connecting an external power amplifier to enhance speaker output, connect the input
jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of the unit. The same channel signals are
output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.
a FRONT jacks
Output front channel sounds.
b SURROUND jacks
Output surround channel sounds.
c SUR. BACK jacks
Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one surround back speaker, connect the
external amplifier to the SINGLE jack (L side).
d CENTER jack
Outputs center channel sounds.
(Example)
Connecting front speakers via an external power amplifier
About external power amplifiers
We recommend using power amplifiers that meet the following conditions.
With unbalanced inputs
With volume control bypass (or without volume control circuit)
Output power: 100 W or more (6 to 8 Ω)
Caution
To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making
connections.
Remove the power cable of the unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them.
When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.
When using a pre-main amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, turn up the volume
of the pre-main amplifier enough and fix it. In this case, do not connect other devices (except the
unit) to the pre-main amplifier.
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
A
V 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
AC IN
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R L R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
RS-232C
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
NETWORK
( 3
NET
)
Y
P
RPB
Y
P
RPB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
a bcd
The unit (rear)
HDMI
V 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
1
2
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
ROUND
F.PRESENCE
L R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
RS-232C
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
NETWORK
( 3
NET
)
P
RPB
PRPB
NT VIDEO
MAIN IN
PR
SU
R
FRONT
L
R
L
R
The unit (rear)
PRE OUT (FRONT) jacks
Main input jack
Amplifier with
volume control
bypass
(such as A-S3000)
En 32
2 Connecting a TV and playback devices
Connect a TV and playback devices (video and audio devices) to the unit.
For information on how to connect a USB storage device, see “Connecting a USB storage device” (p.82).
Input/output jacks and cables
The unit is equipped with the following input/output jacks. Prepare the cables that match the jacks on your devices.
Video/audio jacks
To input/output video and audio signals, use the following
jacks.
HDMI jacks
Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single
jack. Use an HDMI cable.
Y
Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using a
cable less than 5.0 m (16.4 ft) long to prevent signal quality degradation.
X
The unit’s HDMI jacks support the HDMI Control, Audio Return Channel
(ARC), and 3D and 4K Ultra HD video transmission features.
Use high speed HDMI cables to enjoy 3D or 4K Ultra HD videos.
Video jacks
To input only video signals, use the following jacks.
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
Transmit video signals separated into three components:
luminance (Y), chrominance blue (Pb), and chrominance red
(Pr). Use a component video cable with three plugs.
VIDEO jacks
Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable.
Audio jacks
To input/output only audio signals, use the following jacks.
OPTICAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical cable.
Remove the tip protector (if available) before using the cable.
COAXIAL jacks
Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial cable.
AUDIO jacks
Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin cable
(RCA cable).
AV 1
HDMI cable
Y
P
R
P
B
AV 1
COMPONENT VIDEO
A
Component video cable
AV 1
VIDEO
Video pin cable
Digital optical cable
Digital coaxial cable
AUDIO3
Stereo pin cable
En 33
Connecting a TV
Connect a TV to the unit so that video input to the unit can be output to the TV.
You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on the unit.
HDMI connection
Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin
cable).
Y
You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.33).
X
You do not make an audio cable connection between the TV and the unit in the following cases:
If your TV supports Audio Return Channel (ARC)
If you will receive TV broadcasts only from the set-top box
If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit’s power
and volume with the TV’s remote control.
To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the HDMI settings on the unit. For details
on the settings, see “Information on HDMI” (p.165).
Connecting another TV or a projector
The unit has two HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to the unit with
an HDMI cable, you can switch the TV (or projector) to be used for watching videos with the
remote control (p.60).
Y
HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack.
If you set “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2”, you can connect a video monitor for
Zone2 to the HDMI OUT 2 jack and enjoy videos and audio using the video monitor (p.96).
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SURROUND
R
5
6
L
AM
FRONT
Y
P
R
PB
Y
P
R
PB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
HDMI
OPTICAL
1
AUDIO
OPTICAL
R
L
ARC(ZONE OUT)
12
HDMI OUT
(HDCP2.2)
AUDIO 1
(2 TV)
HDMI
HDMI
OO
R
L L
R
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT jack
AUDIO 1
(OPTICAL or AUDIO) jacks
Audio output
(digital optical or analog stereo)
TV
HDMI input
About Audio Return Channel (ARC)
ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways. If you connect a TV that supports ARC to the unit with a
single HDMI cable, you can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to the unit.
When using ARC, connect a TV with an HDMI cable that supports ARC.
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SURROUND
R
5
6
L
AM
FRONT
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
HDMI
ARC(ZONE OUT)
12
HDMI OUT
(HDCP2.2)
HDMI
HDMI
The unit
(rear)
HDMI OUT 2 jack
HDMI input
Projector
TV (already connected)
TV
En 34
Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players)
Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game consoles to the
unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video device, choose one of
the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI connection if the video device has
an HDMI output jack.
Y
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting
(p.137) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COMPONENT VIDEO (A, B), COAXIAL (3, 4, 5)
and OPTICAL (1, 2, 6) jacks to another input source.
X
If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on the unit will be
determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.109) in the “Option” menu.
HDMI connection
Connect a video device to the unit with an HDMI cable.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-7 on the remote control, the video/audio played
back on the video device will be output from the unit.
Component video connection
Connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and an audio cable (digital
coaxial or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the audio
output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-2 on the remote control, the video/audio played
back on the video device will be output from the unit.
X
To connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and a digital optical cable, use “Input
Assignment” (p.137) in the “Setup” menu to assign the COMPONENT VIDEO and OPTICAL jacks to the same input
source.
I
OUT
ARC
1
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
AV 3 AV 4
OPTICAL
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
CENTER
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R
6
L R RL L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
N
E
Y
P
R
P
B
Y
P
R
P
B
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
C
P2.2)
HDMI
HDMI
HDMI
The unit (rear)
HDMI output
Video device
HDMI (AV 1-7) jacks
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio
Component video
Digital coaxial AV 1-2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL)
Analog stereo AV 1-2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + AUDIO)
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKER
S
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENC
R
5
6
L R RL
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-A
M
AM
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1
EXTRA SP2
TRIG
G
OU
T
1
2
12V
0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
Y
P
RPB
Y
P
RPB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
YP
B
P
R
YP
B
P
R
R
L
COAXIAL
L
R
L
R
P
R
P
B
Y
Y
B
P
RP
CC
The unit (rear)
AV 1-2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks
Video output
(component video)
Video device
Audio output
(digital or analog stereo)
AV 1-2 (COAXIAL) or
AV 1-2 (AUDIO) jacks
En 35
Composite video connection
Connect a video device to the unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial,
digital optical, or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the
audio output jacks available on your video device.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-4 on the remote control, the video/audio played
back on the video device will be output from the unit.
Output jacks on video device
Input jacks on the unit
Video Audio
Composite video
Digital coaxial AV 1-2 (VIDEO + COAXIAL)
Digital optical AV 3 (VIDEO + OPTICAL)
Analog stereo AV 1-4 (VIDEO + AUDIO)
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
(1 BD/DV
D
AV 1
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
ZON
ZONE 2
R
5
6
AM
Y
Y
COM
A
V
B
A
V
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
VIDEO
L
R
L
R
OO
C C
V
V
The unit (rear)
AV 1-4 (VIDEO)
jacks
Video output
(composite video)
Video device
Audio output
(any of digital coaxial, digital optical,
analog stereo)
Any of AV 1-2 (COAXIAL),
AV 3 (OPTICAL),
AV 1-4 (AUDIO) jacks
En 36
Connecting audio devices (such as CD players)
Connect audio devices such as CD players and a turntable to the unit. Depending on the audio
output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the following connections.
Y
The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting
(p.137) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COAXIAL (3, 4, 5) and OPTICAL (1, 2, 6) jacks
to another input source.
X
If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on the unit will be
determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.109) in the “Option” menu.
If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-4, AUDIO 1-3 or PHONO on the remote control,
the audio played back on the audio device will be output from the unit.
Audio output jacks on audio device Audio input jacks on the unit
Digital coaxial
AV 1-2 (COAXIAL)
AUDIO 3 (COAXIAL)
Digital optical
AV 3 (OPTICAL)
AUDIO 1-2 (OPTICAL)
Analog stereo
AV 1-4 (AUDIO)
AUDIO 1-3 (AUDIO)
Turntable (PHONO) PHONO
When connecting a turntable
•The PHONO jack of the unit is compatible with an MM cartridge. To connect a turntable with a
low-output MC cartridge, use a boosting transformer.
Connecting the turntable to the GND terminal of the unit may reduce noise in the signal.
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SURROUND
R
5
6
L
AM
FRONT
Y
P
R
PB
Y
P
R
PB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
R
L
PHONO
GND
R
L
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
L
PHONO
GND
C C
L
R
L
R
O O
L
R
L
R
Audio output
(any of digital coaxial, digital optical,
analog stereo)
Any of AV 1-4, AUDIO 1-3
(COAXIAL, OPTICAL, AUDIO) jacks
The unit
(rear)
Audio device
PHONO jacks
Audio output
(PHONO)
Turntable
Ground lead
En 37
Connecting to the jacks on the front panel
Use the VIDEO AUX jack to temporarily connect a playback device to the unit.
Use the USB jack to connect a USB storage device. For details, see “Connecting a USB storage
device” (p.82).
Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume on the
unit.
HDMI connection
Connect an HDMI-compatible device (such as game consoles and camcorders) to the unit with
an HDMI cable.
If you select “VIDEO AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX on the remote control, the
video/audio played back on the device will be output from the unit.
Y
You need to prepare an HDMI cable that matches the output jacks on your device.
The VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack does not support HDCP 2.2.
Analog stereo connection
Connect an audio playback device (such as CD players) to the unit with a stereo pin cable.
If you select “VIDEO AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the audio played back on the
device will be output from the unit.
X
If you connect devices to both the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack and VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks, the unit outputs
audio input through the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack.
If you connect video devices to both the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack and VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks, the unit
outputs video/audio input through the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack.
DISPLAY
RETURN
VIDEO AUX
ZONE 2
ZONE CONTROL
YPAO MIC
PHONES
USB
SILENT CINEMA
HDMI IN
RL AUDIO
ENTER
5V 1A
HDMI
Game console
Camcorder
The unit (front)
DISPLAY
RETURN
VIDEO AUX
ZONE 2
ZONE CONTROL
YPAO MIC
PHONES
USB
SILENT CINEMA
HDMI IN
RL AUDIO
ENTER
5V 1A
RL
The unit (front)
Audio device
En 38
3 Connecting the radio antennas
Connect the supplied radio antenna to the unit.
FM/AM antennas (except Australia, U.K., Europe and
Russia models)
Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit.
Fix the end of the FM antenna to a wall, and place the AM antenna on a flat surface.
Assembling the AM antenna
Connecting the AM antenna
X
Unwind only the length of cable needed from the AM antenna unit.
The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity.
DAB/FM antenna (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia
models only)
Connect the supplied DAB/FM antenna to the unit and fix the antenna ends to a wall.
Y
The antenna should be stretched out horizontally.
If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the height, direction or placement of the DAB/FM
antenna.
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
IN
R
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R
5
6
L R RL L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
AM
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
Y
P
RPB
Y
P
RPB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
FM antenna
AM antenna
The unit (rear)
Hold down Insert Release
IN
R
E
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R
5
6
L R RL L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
AM
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
Y
P
RPB
Y
P
RPB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
R
L
75
(4 RADIO)
DAB/FM
DAB/FM antenna
The unit (rear)
En 39
4 Connecting a network cable or preparing the wireless antenna
Connect the unit to a router (access point) with a network cable, or prepare the wireless
antenna for establishing a wireless network connection.
You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on media servers, such as PCs and Network
Attached Storage (NAS), on the unit.
Connecting the network cable
Connect the unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5 or
higher straight cable).
X
If you want to use a wired (network cable) connection when a wireless connection has been made, set “Network
Connection” (p.131) in the “Setup” menu to “Wired”.
If you are using a router that supports DHCP, you do not need to configure any network settings for the unit, as
the network parameters (such as the IP address) will be assigned automatically to it. You only need to configure
the network settings if your router does not support DHCP or if you want to configure the network parameters
manually (p.131).
You can check whether the network parameters (such as IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in
“Network” (p.141) in the “Information” menu.
Y
Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of network devices (such as a router) may
block the access of the unit to the network devices or the Internet. In these cases, configure the security
software or firewall settings appropriately.
Each server must be connected to the same subnet as the unit.
To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended.
Preparing the wireless antenna
If you want to establish a wireless network connection, stand the wireless antenna up straight.
For information on how to connect the unit to a network device wirelessly, see “Connecting to
a network device wirelessly” (p.51).
Y
Do not apply excessive force on the antenna. Doing so may damage it.
AV 6 AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
AC IN
RS-232C
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
NETWORK
( 3
NET
)
LAN
WAN
Network Attached Storage
(NAS)
Internet
Modem
Router
Network cable
PC
The unit (rear)
Mobile device
En 40
5 Connecting other devices
Connect a device compatible with the trigger function.
Connecting a device compatible with the trigger
function
The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operating the unit (such
as powering on/off and input selection). If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that supports a
system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the trigger function by
connecting the external device to one of the TRIGGER OUT jacks with a monaural mini-plug
cable.
X
You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output1” and “Trigger Output2” (p.138) in the “Setup
menu.
6 Connecting the power cable
Before connecting the power cable (Brazil and General models only)
Set the switch position of VOLTAGE SELECTOR according to your local voltage. Voltages are
AC 110–120/220–240 V, 50/60 Hz.
Y
Make sure you set VOLTAGE SELECTOR of the unit BEFORE plugging the power cable into an AC wall outlet.
Improper setting of VOLTAGE SELECTOR may cause damage to the unit and create a potential fire hazard.
After all the connections are complete, connect the supplied power cable to the unit and then
to an AC wall outlet.
HDMI
3
AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
1
2
SPEAKERS
CENTER FRONT
SURROUND BACK
F.PRESENCE
R R RL L L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
E
OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
R
OUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
RS-232C
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
NETWORK
( 3
NET
)
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
The unit (rear)
TRIGGER OUT 1-2 jacks
System connector
jack
Yamaha subwoofer that
supports a system connection
AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
AC IN
E
RS
CENTER FRONT
N
CE
RL L
-
AMP
S
P1
RS-232C
GGER
O
UT
.
1A
T
AL
NETWORK
( 3
NET
)
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
220V-
240V
110V-
120V
The unit (rear)
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
OUT
O
TE
AC IN
CENTER
FRONT
R L
RS-232C
NETWORK
( 3
NET
)
To an AC wall outlet
The unit (rear)
En 41
7 Selecting an on-screen menu language
Select the desired on-screen menu language from English (default),
Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian, Italian and Chinese.
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video
from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
X
If you turn on the unit for the first time, the message regarding the network
setup appears. For now, press RETURN and proceed to Step 3.
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Language” and the
cursor keys (q/w) to select the desired language.
6
To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
7
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
X
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
RETURN
z
Cursor keys
En 42
8 Configuring the necessary speaker settings
If you use any of the following speaker configurations, follow the
procedure below to configure the corresponding speaker settings
manually before performing YPAO.
Advanced speaker configuration (p.26)
Using the surround speakers for front 5.1-channel system (Virtual
CINEMA FRONT) (p.20)
Using the presence speakers for Dolby Atmos or DTS:X playback (p.22)
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video
from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
X
If you turn on the unit for the first time, the message regarding the network
setup appears. For now, press RETURN and proceed to Step 3.
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to select “Speaker” and
then “Manual Setup”.
6
Configure the corresponding speaker settings.
When using bi-amp connection or Zone2 speakers, select “Power
Amp Assign” (p.123), then select your speaker system.
When using the surround speakers for front 5.1-channel system
(Virtual CINEMA FRONT), select “Configuration!Layout!
“Surround” (p.124), then select “Front”.
When using the presence speakers for Dolby Atmos or DTS:X
playback, select “Configuration!Layout! “Front
Presence” (p.125), then select your front presence speaker
layout.
7
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
RETURN
z
Cursor keys
En 43
9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO)
The Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) function
detects speaker connections, measures the distances from them to your
listening position(s), and then automatically optimizes the speaker
settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your
room.
X
The YPAO function of the unit adopts the YPAO-R.S.C. (Reflected Sound Control)
technology that enables to create natural sound fields like a room specifically designed
for acoustic perfection.
Y
Note the following regarding YPAO measurement.
Test tones are output at high volume and may surprise or frighten small children.
Test tone volume cannot be adjusted.
Keep the room as quiet as possible.
Stay in a corner of the room behind the listening position so that you do not become
an obstacle between speakers and the YPAO microphone.
Do not connect headphones.
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video
from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
X
If you turn on the unit for the first time, the message regarding the network
setup appears. For now, press RETURN and proceed to Step 3.
3
Turn on the subwoofer and set the volume to half. If the
crossover frequency is adjustable, set it to maximum.
4
Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position and
connect it to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel.
X
Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position (same height as your
ears). We recommend the use of a tripod as a microphone stand. You can use the
tripod screws to stabilize the microphone.
The following screen appears on the TV.
X
To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting the
measurement.
VOLUME HIGH CUT
CROSSOVER/
MIN MAXMIN MAX
9
YPAO MIC
9
12
3
45
The unit (front)
YPAO
microphone
Ear height
YPAO MIC
jack
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
RETURN
z
En 44
5
If desired, change the measuring method (multi/single).
1
Use the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” and press ENTER.
2
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER.
Settings
X
If you perform the multi measure, the speaker settings will be optimized for
you to enjoy surround sound in a wider space.
If you perform the multi measure, first place the YPAO microphone at the
listening position you will be seated most frequently.
This completes the preparations. See the following page to start the
measurement.
When “Multi Position” is set to Yes”:
“Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)” (p.46)
When “Multi Position” is set to No”:
“Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.45)
Yes
Select this option if you will have several listening positions
or if you want others to enjoy surround sound. You can take
measurements at up to 8 different positions in the room.
The speaker settings will be optimized to suit the area
defined by those positions (multi measure).
No (default)
Select this option if your listening position will always be
fixed. Take the measurements at only one position. The
speaker settings will be optimized to suit that position
(single measure).
a b
a
a
b
c
d
e
c
d
de
bac
Multi measure
(5 listening positions)
Multi measure
(2 listening positions +
front/back)
Multi measure
(1 listening position +
front/back/left/right)
Single measure
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 45
Measuring at one listening position
(single measure)
When “Multi Position” is set to “No”, follow the procedure below for
measurement. It takes about 3 minutes to perform the measurement.
1
To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select
Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to
start the measurement immediately.
X
To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement
finishes.
Y
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see
“Error messages” (p.49) or “Warning messages” (p.50).
X
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking
the measurement results” (p.47).
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press
ENTER.
3
To save the measurement results, use the cursor keys
(e/r) to select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The adjusted speaker settings are applied.
X
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
4
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “YES” or “NO” to
enable/disable YPAO Volume and press ENTER.
X
•If YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency levels are
automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural
sounds even at low volume.
You can also enable/disable YPAO Volume in “YPAO Volume” (p.107) in the
Option” menu.
5
Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit.
This completes optimization of the speaker settings.
Caution
The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere
where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on
top of AV equipment).
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
En 46
Measuring at multiple listening positions
(multi measure)
When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below for
measurement. It takes about 10 minutes to measure 8 listening
positions.
Y
If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error
messages” (p.49) or “Warning messages” (p.50).
1
To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select
Measure” and press ENTER.
The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to
start the measurement immediately.
X
To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN.
The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement at
the first position finishes.
2
Move the YPAO microphone to the next listening position
and press ENTER.
Repeat step 2 until measurements at all listening positions (up to
8) have been taken.
3
When the measurements at the positions you want to
measure are completed, use the cursor keys to select
CANCEL” and press ENTER.
When you have taken measurements at 8 listening positions, the
following screen appears automatically.
X
To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking
the measurement results” (p.47).
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press
ENTER.
5
To save the measurement result, use the cursor keys to
select “SAVE” and press ENTER.
The adjusted speaker settings are applied.
X
To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
En 47
6
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “YES” or “NO” to
enable/disable YPAO Volume and press ENTER.
X
•If YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency levels are
automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural
sounds even at low volume.
You can also enable/disable YPAO Volume in “YPAO Volume” (p.107) in the
Option” menu.
7
Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit.
This completes optimization of the speaker settings.
Checking the measurement results
You can check the YPAO measurement results.
1
After the measurement, use the cursor keys to select
Result” and press ENTER.
X
You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.120) in the “Setup” menu,
which displays the previous measurement results.
The following screen appears.
a Measurement result items
b Measurement result details
c The number of measured positions (when multi measure is
performed)
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item.
3
To finish checking the results and return to the previous
screen, press RETURN.
Caution
The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere
where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on
top of AV equipment).
Wiring
Polarity of each speaker
Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with the
reverse polarity (+/-).
Size
Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the
subwoofer)
Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency signals
effectively.
Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency
signals effectively.
Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker
Level Output level adjustment for each speaker
a
b
c
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
En 48
Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments
When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not
suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings and
reload the previous YPAO adjustments.
1
In the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto Setup”,
and then “Result” (p.119).
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload” and press
ENTER.
3
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 49
Error messages
If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again.
Error message Cause Remedy
E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected.
Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker connections.E-2: No Sur. SP One of the surround speakers cannot be detected.
E-3: No F.PRNS SP One of the front presence speakers cannot be detected.
E-4: SBR → SBL A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only.
When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the on-screen
instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speaker.
E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud.
Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select “PROCEED”,
YPAO takes the measurement again and ignores any noise detected.
E-6: Check Sur.
Surround back speakers are connected, but no surround speakers
are connected.
Surround speakers need to be connected in order to use surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen instructions
to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speakers.
E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed.
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again.
E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones.
Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the
measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”.
E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred.
Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on the unit. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the
nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
En 50
Warning messages
If a warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can still save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions.
However, we recommend you perform YPAO again in order to use the unit with the optimal speaker settings.
Warning message Cause Remedy
W-1: Out of Phase A speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity (+/-).
Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.47) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker identified by “Reverse”.
If the speaker is connected incorrectly:
Turn off the unit and then reconnect the speaker cable.
If the speaker is connected correctly:
Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are
connected correctly. In this case, you can ignore the message.
W-2: Over Distance
A speaker is placed more than 24 m (80 ft) from the listening
position.
Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.47) and move the speaker identified by “>24.00m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m (80 ft) of the
listening position.
W-3: Level Error There are significant volume differences between the speakers.
Select “Level” in “Result” (p.47) and check the speaker identified by “Over ±10.0dB”, then check the usage
environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the subwoofer. We recommend using
the same speakers or speakers with specifications that are as similar as possible.
En 51
10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly
Connect the unit to a wireless router (access point) or a mobile device by establishing a
wireless connection.
Selecting the connection method
Select a connection method according to your network environment.
Connecting with a wireless router (access point)
Connect the unit to a wireless router (access point).
You can enjoy Internet radio, AirPlay, or music files stored on media servers (PC/NAS) on the
unit.
For details on connection, see “Connecting the unit to a wireless network” (p.52).
Y
You cannot use the wireless network connection simultaneously with Wireless Direct (p.57).
Connecting without a wireless router (access point)
Connect a mobile device to the unit directly.
You can use the application for smartphone / tablet “AV CONTROLLER” (p.9) to control the unit
from mobiles devices or enjoy music files stored on mobiles devices on the unit.
For details on connection, see “Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless
Direct)” (p.57).
Y
You cannot use Wireless Direct simultaneously with the wired (network cable) connection (p.39) or the wireless
network connection (p.52).
•When Wireless Direct is enabled, the both the unit and mobile device cannot be connected to the Internet. In
this case, you cannot use the Internet services such as Internet radio. To use the Internet services, terminate
the Wireless Direct connection on the mobile device.
The unit
Wireless router
Mobile device
(such as iPhone)
Internet
Modem
The unit
Mobile device
(such as iPhone)
En 52
Connecting the unit to a wireless network
There are several methods to connect the unit to a wireless network.
Select a connection method according to your environment.
Using MusicCast CONTROLLER (p.59)
Sharing the iOS device setting (p.52)
Using the WPS push button configuration (p.53)
Using other connection methods (p.54)
Sharing the iOS device setting
You can easily set up a wireless connection by applying the connection
settings on iOS devices (iPhone/iPad/iPod touch).
Before proceeding, confirm that your iOS device is connected to a
wireless router.
Y
If you set up a wireless connection with this method, the following settings will be
initialized.
Network settings
Bluetooth settings
USB and network items registered as shortcuts
Internet radio stations register to “Favorites”
Account information for the network services
X
You need iOS device with iOS 7 or later. (The following procedure is a setup example
for iOS 8.)
This configuration does not work if the security method of your wireless router
(access point) is WEP. In this case, use other connection method.
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video
from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
Y
Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the
unit via HDMI.
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”.
6
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network
Connection” and press ENTER.
7
Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless
(Wi-Fi)” and select “OK”.
X
The checkmark indicates the current setting.
8
Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Share
Wi-Fi Settings (iOS)” and select “NEXT”.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
z
Cursor keys
En 53
9
After checking the on-screen message, use the cursor
keys (e/r) and ENTER to select “NEXT”.
10
On the iOS device, select the unit as the AirPlay speaker in
the Wi-Fi screen.
11
Check the network currently selected and tap “Next”.
When the sharing process finishes, the unit is automatically connected to
the selected network (access point).
Using the WPS push button configuration
You can easily set up a wireless connection with one push of the WPS
button.
Y
This configuration does not work if the security method of your wireless router (access
point) is WEP. In this case, use other connection method.
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Hold down INFO (WPS) on the front panel for 3 seconds.
Press WPS button on Access Point” appears on the front display.
3
Push the WPS button on the wireless router (access
point).
When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on
the front display.
If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another
connection method.
The name of the unit
Tap here to start setup
The network currently selected
About WPS
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) is a standard established by the Wi-Fi Alliance,
which allows easy establishment of a wireless home network.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
z
Cursor keys
En 54
Using other connection methods
If your wireless router (access point) does not support WPS push button
configuration method, follow the procedure below to configure the
wireless network settings.
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video
from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
Y
Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the
unit via HDMI.
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”.
6
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network
Connection” and press ENTER.
7
Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless
(Wi-Fi)” and select “OK”.
X
The checkmark indicates the current setting.
8
Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to select the
desired connection method and select “NEXT”.
The following connection methods are available.
WPS Button
You can set up a wireless connection with the WPS button
while viewing the TV screen. Follow the instructions
displayed on the TV screen.
Share Wi-Fi
Settings (iOS)
See “Sharing the iOS device setting” (p.52).
Access Point Scan
You can set up a wireless connection by searching for an
access point. For details on settings, see “Searching for an
access point” (p.55).
Manual Setting
You can set up a wireless connection by entering the
required information (such as SSID) manually.
For details on settings, see “Setting up the wireless
connection manually” (p.55).
PIN Code
You can set up a wireless connection by entering the unit’s
PIN code into the wireless router (access point). The
method is available if the wireless router (access point)
supports the WPS PIN code method. For details on settings,
see “Using the PIN code” (p.56).
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
z
Cursor keys
En 55
Searching for an access point
If you select “Access Point Scan” as the connection method, the unit
starts searching for access points. After a while, the list of available
access points appears on the TV screen.
1
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired
access point and select “NEXT”.
The wireless connection setting screen appears on the TV.
2
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key
and select “NEXT”.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and
press ENTER to start the connection process.
When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on
the TV screen.
If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another
connection method.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Setting up the wireless connection manually
If you select “Manual Setting” as the connection method, the wireless
connection setting screen appears on the TV.
You need to setup the SSID (network name), encryption method and
security key for your network.
1
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the SSID of the
access point and select “NEXT”.
2
Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check the
security method of the access point and select “NEXT”.
Settings
None, WEP, WPA2-PSK (AES), Mixed Mode
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 56
3
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key
and select “NEXT”.
If you selectNone” in Step 2, this setting is not available. Proceed
to Step 4.
If you select “WEP”, enter either 5 or 13 character string, or 10 or 26
hexadecimal digits.
If you select other method, enter either 8 to 63 character string, or
64 hexadecimal digits.
4
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and
press ENTER to start the connection process.
When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on
the TV screen.
If “Not connected” appears, check that all the information is
entered correctly, and repeat from Step 1.
5
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Using the PIN code
If you select “PIN Code” as the connection method, the list of available
access points appears on the TV screen.
1
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired
access point and select “NEXT”.
The PIN code of the unit appears on the TV screen.
2
Enter the unit’s PIN code into the wireless router (access
point).
For details on settings, refer to the instruction manual of the
wireless router (access point).
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and
press ENTER to start the connection process.
When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on
the TV screen.
If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another
connection method.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 57
Connecting a mobile device to the unit
directly (Wireless Direct)
Follow the procedure below to connect a mobile device to the unit
directly.
Y
Wireless Direct connection may be insecure since the communication is not strongly
encrypted. The unit may operate by playback operation on wireless devices connected
to the unit without permission.
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video
from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
Y
Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the
unit via HDMI.
3
Press ON SCREEN.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”.
6
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network
Connection” and press ENTER.
7
Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless
Direct” and select “OK”.
X
The checkmark indicates the current setting.
8
Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check the
desired security method and select “NEXT”.
Settings
None, WPA2-PSK (AES)
Y
If you select “None”, the connection may be insecure since the communication
is not encrypted.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
z
Cursor keys
En 58
9
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key
and select “NEXT”.
If you selectNone” in Step 8, this setting is not available. Proceed
to Step 10.
Otherwise, either 8 to 63 character string, or 64 hexadecimal digits.
10
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “OK” and press
ENTER to save the setting.
The settings made appear on the TV screen.
The SSID and security key information is required for setup of a
mobile device.
11
Configure the Wi-Fi settings of a mobile device.
For details on settings of your mobile device, refer to the
instruction manual of the mobile device.
1
Enable the Wi-Fi function on the mobile device.
2
Select the SSID displayed in Step 10 from the list of available
access points.
3
When you are prompted for a password, enter the security key
displayed in Step 10.
12
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 59
11 Connecting to the MusicCast network
MusicCast is a brand new wireless musical solution from Yamaha,
allowing you to share music among all of your rooms with a variety of
devices. You can enjoy music from your smartphone, PC, NAS drive and
music streaming service anywhere in your house with one easy-to-use
application. For more details and a lineup of MusicCast compatible
products, visit the Yamaha website.
Seamlessly control all MusicCast compatible devices with the
dedicated application “MusicCast CONTROLLER”.
•Link a MusicCast compatible device to another device in a different
room and play them back simultaneously.
Play back music from music streaming services. (The compatible music
streaming services may differ depending on your region and product.)
MusicCast CONTROLLER
To use the network features on the MusicCast compatible device, you
need the dedicated application “MusicCast CONTROLLER” for the
operation. Search for the free application “MusicCast CONTROLLER” on
the App Store or Google Play and install it to your device.
Adding the unit to the MusicCast network
Follow the procedure below to add the unit to the MusicCast network.
You can also configure the unit's wireless settings at once.
Y
The SSID and security key for your network will be needed.
If your router supports multiple SSID’s (network names), connect the mobile device
to the first access point (“SSID 1”, etc.).
1
Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit.
2
Tap the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application icon on
your mobile device and tap “Setup”.
X
If you have already connected other MusicCast compatible devices to the
network, tap “Settings” and then “Add New Device”.
3
Operate the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application
following the on screen instructions, then hold down
CONNECT on the front panel of the unit for 5 seconds.
4
Operate the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application
following the onscreen instructions to set up the network.
5
Operate the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application to
playback.
Y
AirPlay and DSD audio cannot be delivered.
When Pure Direct is enabled, input sources other than the network sources and USB
cannot be delivered.
If you configure the unit's wireless settings with this method, the signal strength
indicator of the front display lights up when the unit is connecting to a network (even
if a wired connection is used).
You can interlock the power of MusicCast devices with the power of the unit
(MusicCast master). For details, see “MusicCast Link Power Interlock” (p.133) in the
Setup” menu.
CONNECT
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
z
En 60
PLAYBACK
Basic playback procedure
1
Turn on the external devices (such as a TV or BD/DVD
player) connected to the unit.
2
Use the input selection keys to select an input source.
3
Start playback on the external device or select a radio
station.
Refer to the instruction manual for the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the corresponding
pages.
Listening to FM/AM radio (except Australia, U.K., Europe and
Russia models) (p.69)
Listening to DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models
only) (p.72)
Listening to FM radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models
only) (p.76)
Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.80)
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.82)
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.85)
Listening to Internet radio (p.89)
Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay (p.92)
4
Press VOLUME to adjust the volume.
X
To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute.
To adjust the treble/bass settings, use the “Option” menu or TONE CONTROL
on the front panel (p.107).
On-screen input selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select the desired input source and press
ENTER.
Selecting an HDMI output jack
1
Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack.
Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be used for
signal output changes.
X
You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.61).
•WhenOUT 1+2” is selected, the unit outputs video signals at the highest resolution
supported by both TVs (or projectors) connected to the unit. (For example, if you have
connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack and a 720p TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack,
the unit outputs 720p video signals.)
•If the HDMI OUT 2 jack is assigned to Zone2 (p.136), you can turn on/off each zone by
pressing HDMI OUT repeatedly.
OUT 1+2
Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1 and
HDMI OUT 2 jacks.
OUT 1
Output the signals at the selected HDMI OUT jack.
OUT 2
Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks.
OUT 1+2
HDMI OUT Sel.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
PR
OG
RAM
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
VOLUME
MUTE
HDMI OUT
Cursor keys
Input selection keys
En 61
Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE)
The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source, sound program, HDMI output and various settings with just one touch.
You can use up to 12 scenes to register your favorite settings and switch them depending on a playback source.
1
Press SCENE.
The input source and settings registered to the corresponding scene are selected. The unit turns on automatically when it is in standby mode.
By default, the following settings are registered for each scene.
X
You can select SCENE 1-4 by pressing SCENE on the remote control. Additionally, you can create 8 scenes (SCENE 5-12) and select those scenes from the “Scene” menu (p.113).
On-screen scene selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select a desired scene and press ENTER.
SCENE (SCENE key)
Input
Input (p.60) AV 1 AUDIO 1 NET RADIO TUNER
Audio Select (p.109) Auto Auto --
HDMI Output HDMI Output (p.60) OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2
Mode
DSP Program (p.63) Sci-Fi STRAIGHT 7ch Stereo 7ch Stereo
Pure Direct Mode (p.128) Auto Auto Auto Auto
Enhancer (p.68) Off On On On
Enhancer Hi-Res Mode (p.109) On On On On
1
2
3
4
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
SCENE
Cursor keys
En 62
Registering a scene
1
Set the unit to the condition (such as input source and
sound program) that you want to assign to a scene.
2
Hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete
appears on the front display.
X
•The SCENE link playback function allows you to start playback of an external device
connected to the unit via HDMI. To enable SCENE link playback, specify the device
type in “Device Control” (p.114) in the “Scene” menu.
(China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
To control your playback device after selecting a scene with the remote control of the
unit, change the external device assigned to the SCENE keys. For details, refer to
Supplement for Remote Control” in the supplied CD-ROM.
Selecting setting items to be included as
scene assignments
In addition to the default scene assignments (Input, HDMI Output and
Mode), you can also include the following setting items as the scene
assignments in “Detail” (p.114) in the “Scene” menu.
X
When the input source is TUNER, USB or NET, the selected radio station or content is
assigned.
SET Complete
SCENE1
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
Sound Tone Control, YPAO Volume, Adaptive DRC, Extra Bass
Surround
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode, Dialogue Lift, Dialogue Level,
Subwoofer Trim
Video Video Mode
Volume Master Volume
Lipsync Lipsync, Delay
Speaker Setup Setting Pattern, PEQ Select
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
SCENE
En 63
Selecting the sound mode
The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and surround
decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with your favorite
sound mode (such as sound field effect or stereo playback).
Selecting a sound program suitable for movies
Press MOVIE repeatedly.
This mode lets you enjoy sound field effects optimized for viewing
video sources, such as movies, TV programs, and games (p.64).
Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo playback
Press MUSIC repeatedly.
This mode lets you enjoy sound field effects optimized for listening
music sources or stereo playback (p.65).
Selecting a surround decoder
Press SUR. DECODE repeatedly.
This mode lets you enjoy unprocessed multichannel playback from
2-channel sources (p.67).
Switching to the straight decode mode
Press STRAIGHT.
This mode lets you enjoy unprocessed sounds in original channels
(p.67).
Switching to the Pure Direct mode
Press PURE DIRECT.
This mode lets you enjoy pure high fidelity sound by reducing the
electrical noise from other circuitry (p.68).
Enabling Compressed Music Enhancer
Press ENHANCER.
This mode lets you enjoy compressed music with additional depth and
breadth (p.68).
On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection
a Press ON SCREEN.
b Use the cursor keys to select “DSP Program” and press ENTER.
c Use the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround decoder
and press ENTER.
X
You can also switch the sound programs and surround decoder by pressing
PROGRAM.
You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in the
DSP Program” menu (p.116).
The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source.
You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound by looking at the
speaker indicators on the unit’s front panel (p.12) or at the “Audio Signal” screen in
the “Information” menu (p.140).
Precaution for enjoying Dolby Atmos®
Dolby Atmos contents are decoded as Dolby TrueHD or Dolby Digital Plus in
the following situations. (Dolby Atmos PCM format is always decoded as
Dolby Atmos.)
Neither surround back nor presence speakers are used.
Headphones are used (2-channel playback).
•When the Dolby Atmos decoder is working, virtual surround processing (such
as Virtual CINEMA FRONT) (p.66) does not work.
Precaution for enjoying DTS:X
•When DTS:X contents are played back, you can adjust the volume of dialogue
sounds in “DTS Dialogue Control” (p.108) in the “Option” menu.
•When the DTS:X decoder is working, virtual surround processing (such as
Virtual CINEMA FRONT) (p.64) does not work.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
MOVIE
MUSIC
SUR.DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER
PURE DIRECT
ON SCREEN
ENTER
PROGRAM
Cursor keys
En 64
Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP HD
3
)
The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha’s original DSP
technology (CINEMA DSP HD
3
). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual movie
theaters or concert halls in your room and enjoy natural stereoscopic sound fields.
X
To use the conventional CINEMA DSP, set “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.128) in the “Setup” menu toOff”.
The unit creates front Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce
3-dimensional sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected. However, we recommend
using front presence speakers in order to experience the full effect of the sound fields.
•The unit creates rear Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce
natural 3-dimensional sound fields when front presence speakers are connected.
If a multichannel source (6.1 channels or more) is input when no surround back speakers are connected, the
unit creates Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround speakers to add a sense of depth to the
rear sound field.
When VPS or VSBS is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display.
Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE)
The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources, such as movies, TV
programs, and games.
MOVIE THEATER
MUSIC
Hall in Vienna
CLASSICAL
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
FPL FPR
3
HD
CINEMA DSP !” lights up
Sound program category
Sound program
Standard
This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the surround feeling without
disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multichannel audio. Its design is
based on the concept of the ideal movie theater, in which the audience is
surrounded by beautiful reverberations from the left, right, and rear.
Spectacle
This program delivers the scale and grandeur of spectacular movie productions.
It delivers an expansive sound space to match the cinemascope wide-screen, and
boasts a broad dynamic range, providing everything from small delicate sounds
to powerful loud booms.
Sci-Fi
This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest
Sci-Fi and SFX movies. You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically created
virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation between dialogue, sound effects,
and background music.
Adventure
This program is ideal for reproducing the sound design of action and adventure
movies precisely. The sound field restrains reverberations, but puts emphasis on
reproducing a sensation of expansiveness on both sides, powerful space
expanded widely to the left and right. The restrained depth creates a clear and
powerful space, while also maintaining the articulation of the sounds and the
separation of the channels.
Drama
This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie
genres, from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are
modest, but suitably stereophonic. The sound effects and background music are
reproduced with a gentle echo that does not impinge on the articulation of the
dialogue. You’ll never get tired listening for long periods.
Mono Movie
This program reproduces monaural video sources, such as classic movies, in an
atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program creates a pleasant space
with depth, by adding breadth and the appropriate reverberation to the original
audio.
Enhanced
This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the dynamic sound transition
of 3D object audio. Its design is based on the concept of a movie theater with
multi-top speakers, in which the audience is overwhelmed by the natural and
powerful sound effects.
En 65
ENTERTAINMENT
Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback
(MUSIC)
The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources.
You can also select stereo playback.
CLASSICAL
Sports
This program allows listeners to enjoy the rich vividness of sport broadcasts and
light entertainment programs. In sports broadcasts, the commentators’ voices
are positioned clearly at the center, while the atmosphere inside the stadium is
realistically conveyed by the peripheral delivery of the sounds of the fans in a
suitable space.
Action Game
This program is suitable for action games, such as car racing and fighting games.
The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player feel like they are
right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater concentration. Use this
program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a more dynamic
and strong sound field.
Roleplaying Game
This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This program adds
depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction of background
music, special effects, and dialogue from a wide variety of scenes. Use this
program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a clearer and more
spatial sound field.
Music Video
This program allows you to enjoy videos of pop, rock, and jazz concerts, as if you
were there yourself. Immerse yourself in the hot concert atmosphere thanks to
the vividness of the singers and solos on stage, a presence sound field that
emphasizes the beat of rhythm instruments, and a surround sound field that
reproduces the space of a big live hall.
Recital/Opera
This program controls the amount of reverberations at an optimum level and
emphasizes the depth and clarity of human voices to offer the reverberations of
an orchestra box in front the listener at the same time as providing the acoustic
positioning and feeling of presence on the stage. The surround sound field is
relatively moderate, but the data for concert hall effects are used to represent the
inherent beauty of music. The listener will not be fatigued even after long hours of
opera entertainment.
Hall in Munich
This program simulates a Munich concert hall with approximately 2,500 seats that
uses stylish wood for the interior finishing. Fine, beautiful reverberations spread
richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center
left of the arena.
Hall in Vienna
This program simulates a 1,700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox
shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely
complex reverberations from all around the audience, producing a very full, rich
sound.
Hall in Amsterdam
The large, shoe box shaped hall seats about 2,200 around the circle stage.
Reflections are rich and pleasing while the sound travels freely.
Church in Freiburg
Located in the south of Germany, this grand, stone-built church has a pointed
tower at 120 meters in height. Its long and narrow shape and the high ceiling
enable the elongated reverberation time and limited initial reflection time. Thus,
the rich reverberation rather than the sound itself reproduces the atmosphere of
the church.
Church in
Royaumont
This program features the sound field created by the refectory (dining hall) of a
beautiful medieval Gothic monastery located in Royaumont on the outskirts of
Paris.
Chamber
This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling, like an audience
hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly
music and chamber music.
En 66
LIVE/CLUB
STEREO
Y
CINEMA DSP HD
3
(p.64) and Virtual CINEMA DSP (p.66) do not work when “2ch Stereo” or7ch Stereo” is selected.
Enjoying sound field effects without surround speakers
(Virtual CINEMA DSP)
If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) when no surround
speakers are connected, the unit utilizes Yamaha’s original virtual surround technology to
reproduce up to 7-channel surround sound and enable you to enjoy the well-oriented sound
field only with the front-side speakers. We recommend using presence speakers in order to
enjoy more effective stereoscopic sound field.
X
When Virtual CINEMA DSP is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display.
Enjoying surround sound with 5 speakers placed in
front (Virtual CINEMA FRONT)
If you have surround speakers but there is no space to place them in the rear of your room, you
can place them in the front (p.20) and enjoy multichannel surround sound using Virtual
CINEMA FRONT.
When “Layout (Surround)” (p.125) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Front”, the unit creates the
virtual surround speakers in the rear side to allow you to enjoy multichannel surround sound
with the 5 speakers placed in the front.
X
When Virtual CINEMA FRONT is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display.
Enjoying surround sound with headphones
(SILENT CINEMA)
You can enjoy surround or sound field effects, like a multichannel speaker system, with stereo
headphones by connecting the headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound
program or a surround decoder.
Village Vanguard
The Jazz club is on 7th Avenue, New York. This small club with the low ceiling
makes the powerful reflections converge toward the stage located in the center.
Warehouse Loft
The warehouse resembles some lofts in Soho. Sound reflects off the concrete
walls clearly with a lot of energy.
Cellar Club
This program simulates an intimate concert venue with a low ceiling and homey
atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field delivers powerful sounds that make you
feel as if you are sitting in the front row in front of a small stage.
The Roxy Theatre
This program creates the sound field of a 460-seat rock music concert venue in Los
Angeles. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the hall.
The Bottom Line
This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous
New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a
sound field offering real and vibrant sound.
2ch Stereo
Use this program to mix down multichannel sources to 2 channels. When
multichannel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and output
from the front speakers (this program does not utilize CINEMA DSP).
7ch Stereo
Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back
multichannel sources, the unit mixes down the source to 2 channels, and then
outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field
and is ideal for background music at parties.
En 67
Enjoying unprocessed playback
You can play back input sources without any sound field effect
processing.
Playing back in original channels
(straight decode)
When the straight decode mode is enabled, the unit produces stereo
sound from the front speakers for 2-channel sources such as CDs, and
produces unprocessed multichannel sounds for multichannel sources.
1
Press STRAIGHT.
Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is enabled
or disabled.
Y
To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround back
speakers are used, select a surround decoder (p.67).
•IfLayout (Surround)” (p.125) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Front”, Virtual CINEMA
FRONT (p.66) works when multichannel source is played back.
Playing back in extended multichannel
(surround decoder)
The surround decoder enables unprocessed multichannel playback from
2-channel or multichannel sources.
X
Speakers that produce sounds will change depending on your speaker system and
the selected decode type (p.117).
For details on each decoder, see “Glossary” (p.159).
1
Press SUR. DECODE to select a surround decoder.
Each time you press the key, the surround decoder changes.
Y
•When the Dolby Surround decoder is selected, virtual surround processing (such as
Virtual CINEMA FRONT) (p.66) does not work.
•If the Dolby Surround decoder is selected when only one surround back speaker is
used, no sound is output from the surround back speaker (except when a Dolby
Atmos content or a DTS:X content is played).
•When the Neural:X decoder is selected, virtual surround processing (such as Virtual
CINEMA FRONT) (p.64) does not work.
STRAIGHT
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
Auto
Uses the decoder automatically selected by input
source. The DTS Neural:X decoder is selected for DTS
sources and the Dolby Surround decoder is selected
for other sources.
bDsur
Uses the Dolby Surround decoder suitable for your
speaker layout. A real acoustic space (including
overhead) will be created especially when
object-based audio (such as Dolby Atmos content) is
played.
Neural:X
Uses the DTS Neural:X decoder suitable for your
speaker layout. A real acoustic space (including
overhead) will be created especially when
object-based audio (such as DTS:X content) is
played.
Neo:6 Cinema
Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder (or DTS-ES Matrix
decoder) suitable for movies. Sounds will be output
from the surround/surround back speakers.
Neo:6 Music
Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder (or DTS-ES Matrix
decoder) suitable for music. Sounds will be output
from the surround/surround back speakers.
†‡ Dsur
SUR. DECODE
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
STRAIGHT
SUR.DECODE
En 68
Enjoying pure high fidelity sound
(Pure Direct)
When Pure Direct is enabled, the unit plays back the selected source with
the least circuitry in order to reduce the electrical noise from other
circuitry (such as the front display). It allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound
quality.
1
Press PURE DIRECT.
Each time you press the key, Pure Direct is enabled or disabled.
Y
When Pure Direct is enabled, the following functions are not available.
Some settings for the speakers or sound programs
Operating the on-screen menu and “Option” menu
Using the multi-zone function
Viewing information on the front display (when not in operation)
Playing back digitally compressed formats
(such as MP3, etc.) with enriched sound
(Compressed Music Enhancer)
Compressed Music Enhancer adds depth and breadth to the sound,
allowing you to enjoy a dynamic sound close to the original sound before
it was compressed. This function can be used along with any other sound
modes.
In addition, Compressed Music Enhancer enhances the quality of
uncompressed digital audio (such as 2-channel PCM and FLAC) when
“Hi-Res Mode” (p.109) in the “Option” menu is set to “On” (default).
1
Press ENHANCER.
Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer is
enabled or disabled.
Y
Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on the following audio sources.
–Signals whose sampling frequency is over 48 kHz
–DSD audio
X
You can also use “Enhancer” (p.109) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable
Compressed Music Enhancer.
PURE DIRECT
L R
VOL.
Enhancer On
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
ENHANCERHi
-
Res
ENHANCER” lights up
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
PURE DIRECT
ENHANCER
En 69
Listening to FM/AM radio (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models)
You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or selecting
from registered radio stations.
Y
The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is
being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used in
U.S.A. model.
If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/AM
antennas.
Setting the frequency steps
(Brazil, Asia and General models only)
At the factory, the frequency step setting is set to 50 kHz for FM and 9 kHz
for AM. Depending on your country or region, set the frequency steps to
100 kHz for FM and 10 kHz for AM.
1
Set the unit to standby mode.
2
When holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press
MAIN ZONE z.
3
Press PROGRAM repeatedly to select “TUNER FRQ STEP”.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select “FM100/AM10”.
5
Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and
turn it on again.
Selecting a frequency for reception
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press BAND to select a band (FM or AM).
3
Use the following keys to set a frequency.
TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the key for
about a second to search stations automatically.
Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to select
98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT).
TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station.
STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received.
Y
Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of reception range.
X
You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio
reception in “FM Mode” (p.110) in the “Option” menu. When the signal reception for an
FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may improve it.
MAIN ZONE z STRAIGHT
PROGRAM
FM50/AM9
TUNER FRQ STEP
FM 87.50MHz
VOL.
FM 98.50MHz
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
P
RE
S
ET
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
TUNING
BAND
TUNER
Numeric keys
En 70
Registering favorite radio stations
(presets)
You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you have
registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their
preset numbers.
X
You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals by using
Auto Preset” (p.79).
Registering a radio station
Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number.
1
Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.69) to
tune into the desired radio station.
2
Hold down MEMORY for seconds.
The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio
station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter,
each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty
(unused) preset number after the most recently registered
number.
X
To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into
the desired radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and then
press MEMORY again.
Selecting a preset station
Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio
station.
You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the
numeric keys after pressing PRESET once.
Y
•“No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered.
•“Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered.
•“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
X
To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.79).
01:FM 98.50MHz
Preset OK
Preset
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
Preset number
01:Empty
FM 98.50MHz
Preset
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered
01:FM 98.50MHz
Preset
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
MEMORY
PRESET
TUNER
Numeric keys
En 71
Operating the radio on the TV
You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
Playback screen
a Radio station information
Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band
(FM/AM) and frequency.
b TUNED/STEREO indicators
TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station.
STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received.
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor key (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
Browse screen
a Preset station list
Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor key (q/w) to select a preset
station and press ENTER to tune into it.
b Preset number
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor key (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
Menu Function
Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list).
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the Menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
b
c
Menu Submenu Function
Utility
Memory
Registers the current station to the preset
number selected in the list.
Auto Preset
Automatically registers FM radio stations
with strong signals (up to 40 stations).
Clear Preset
Clear the preset station selected in the
list.
Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations.
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the
list.
1 Page Down
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the Menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
c
b
a
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
TUNER
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
En 72
Listening to DAB radio (Australia, U.K.,
Europe and Russia models only)
DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) uses digital signals for clearer sound
and more stable reception compared to analog signals. The unit can also
receive DAB+ (an upgraded version of DAB) that allows for more stations
using MPEG-4 audio codec (AAC+), which has a more efficient
transmission method.
Y
The unit supports Band III (174 to 240 MHz) only.
Be sure to check the DAB coverage in your area in that not all areas are currently being
covered. For a list of nationwide DAB statuses and worldwide DAB frequencies, check
WorldDMB online at http://www.worlddab.org/.
X
For details on the antenna connection, see “Connecting the radio antennas” (p.38).
Preparing the DAB tuning
Before tuning into DAB radio stations, follow the procedure below to
perform an initial scan.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press BAND to select the DAB band.
The following message appears on the front panel if you have not
performed an initial scan yet.
3
Press ENTER to start an initial scan.
When the initial scan finishes, the unit automatically tunes into the
first DAB radio station as stored in station order.
X
If no DAB radio stations are found by an initial scan, the message in Step 1
appears again. Press ENTER to start an initial scan again.
You can check reception strength of each DAB channel label (p.74).
To perform an initial scan again after some DAB radio stations are stored,
select “Init Scan” (p.106) in the “Option” menu. If you perform an initial scan
again, the DAB radio stations currently registered to the preset numbers will
be cleared.
Selecting a DAB radio station for reception
You can select a DAB radio station from the stations stored by the initial
scan.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press BAND to select the DAB band.
3
Press TUNING repeatedly to select a DAB radio station.
Y
“Off Air” appears when the selected DAB radio station is currently not
available.
When the unit is receiving a secondary station, “2” appears next to “DAB”.
X
You can watch videos input from external devices while listening to radio by
selecting the video input jack in “Video Out” (p.110) in the “Option” menu.
Press
[ENTER]
Init Scan
VOL.
>>>-------
30%
Init Scan
VOL.
BBC Radio 4
DAB
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
BBC Radio 4
DAB
Daily Service
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
BBC National
DAB 2
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
Secondary station
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
TUNING
BAND
ENTER
TUNER
En 73
Registering favorite DAB radio stations
(presets)
You can register up to 40 DAB radio stations as presets. Once you have
registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their
preset numbers.
X
You can register up to 40 favorite radio stations each for DAB and FM bands.
Registering a DAB radio station as presets
Select a DAB radio station and register it to a preset number.
1
Follow “Selecting a DAB radio station for reception”
(p.72) to tune into the desired DAB radio station.
2
Hold down MEMORY for seconds.
The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio
station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter,
each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty
(unused) preset number after the most recently registered
number.
X
To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into
the desired DAB radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and then
press MEMORY again.
Selecting a preset DAB radio station
Tune into a registered DAB radio station by selecting its preset number.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press BAND to select the DAB band.
3
Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired DAB radio
station.
You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the
numeric keys after pressing PRESET once.
Y
•“No Presets” appears when no DAB radio stations are registered.
•“Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered.
•“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
X
To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.71).
01:BBC Radio 4
Preset
Preset OK
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
Preset number
02:Empty
Preset
BBC Radio 4
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
Empty” (not in use) or “Overwrite?” (in use)
PRESET:01
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
MEMORY
PRESET
BAND
TUNER
En 74
Displaying the DAB information
The unit can receive various types of DAB information when it is tuned
into a DAB radio station.
1
Tune into the desired DAB radio station.
2
Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes.
About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the
displayed item appears.
X
Some information may not be available depending on the selected DAB radio
station.
Checking reception strength of each DAB
channel label
You can check reception strength of each DAB channel label (0 [none] to
100 [best]).
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press BAND to select the DAB band.
3
Press OPTION.
4
Use the cursor keys to selectTune AID” and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select the desired DAB
channel label.
6
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
DLS
(Dynamic Label
Segment)
Information on the current station
Ensemble Label Ensemble name
Program Type Station genre
Date And Time Current date and time
Audio Mode Audio mode (monaural/stereo) and bit rate
CH Label/Freq. Channel label and frequency
Signal Quality Signal reception quality (0 [none] to 100 [best])
DSP Program Sound mode name
Audio Decoder Decoder name
Info
Program Type
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
Item name
Classic FM
Classic Music
DAB
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
Information
Tune AID
12B Level: 80
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
DAB channel label Reception strength
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
INFO
BAND
OPTION
ENTER
TUNER
Cursor keys
En 75
DAB frequency information
The unit supports Band III (174 to 240 MHz) only.
Frequency Channel label
174.928 MHz 5A
176.640 MHz 5B
178.352 MHz 5C
180.064 MHz 5D
181.936 MHz 6A
183.648 MHz 6B
185.360 MHz 6C
187.072 MHz 6D
188.928 MHz 7A
190.640 MHz 7B
192.352 MHz 7C
194.064 MHz 7D
195.936 MHz 8A
197.648 MHz 8B
199.360 MHz 8C
201.072 MHz 8D
202.928 MHz 9A
204.640 MHz 9B
206.352 MHz 9C
208.064 MHz 9D
209.936 MHz 10A
211.648 MHz 10B
213.360 MHz 10C
215.072 MHz 10D
216.928 MHz 11A
218.640 MHz 11B
220.352 MHz 11C
222.064 MHz 11D
223.936 MHz 12A
225.648 MHz 12B
227.360 MHz 12C
229.072 MHz 12D
230.784 MHz 13A
232.496 MHz 13B
234.208 MHz 13C
235.776 MHz 13D
237.488 MHz 13E
239.200 MHz 13F
Frequency Channel label
En 76
Listening to FM radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or selecting
from registered radio stations.
Y
If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the DAB/FM
antennas.
Selecting a frequency for reception
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press BAND to select the FM band.
3
Use the following keys to set a frequency.
TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the key for
about a second to search stations automatically.
Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to select
98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT).
TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station.
“STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received.
Y
Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of reception range.
X
You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio
reception in “FM Mode (p.110) in the “Option” menu. When the signal reception for an
FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may improve it.
Registering favorite FM radio stations
(presets)
You can register up to 40 FM radio stations as presets. Once you have
registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their
preset numbers.
X
You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals by using
Auto Preset” (p.79).
Registering a radio station
Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number.
1
Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.76) to
tune into the desired radio station.
2
Hold down MEMORY for seconds.
The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio
station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter,
each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty
(unused) preset number after the most recently registered
number.
X
To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into
the desired radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and then
press MEMORY again.
FM 87.50MHz
VOL.
FM 98.50MHz
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
01:FM 98.50MHz
Preset OK
Preset
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
Preset number
01:Empty
FM 98.50MHz
Preset
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
MEMORY
PRESET
TUNING
BAND
TUNER
Numeric keys
En 77
Selecting a preset station
Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
2
Press BAND to select the FM band
3
Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio
station.
You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the
numeric keys after pressing PRESET once.
Y
•“No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered.
•“Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered.
•“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
X
To clear preset stations, use Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.79).
01:FM 98.50MHz
Preset
VOL.
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
STEREO TUNED
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
PRESET
BAND
TUNER
Numeric keys
En 78
Radio Data System tuning
(U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM stations in
many countries. The unit can receive various types of Radio Data System
data, such as “Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text” and
“Clock Time”, when it is tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting
station.
Displaying the Radio Data System
information
1
Tune into the desired Radio Data System broadcasting
station.
X
We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System
broadcasting stations (p.79).
2
Press INFO.
Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes.
About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the
displayed item appears.
Y
“Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text”, and “Clock Time” are not
displayed if the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System service.
Info
Program Type
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
STEREO TUNED
Item name
FM 98.50MHz
CLASSICS
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
STEREO TUNED
Information
Frequency (always displayed)
Program Service Program service name
Program Type Current program type
Radio Text Information on the current program
Clock Time Current time
DSP Program Sound mode name
Audio Decoder Decoder name
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
INFO
En 79
Operating the radio on the TV
You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV.
1
Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
Playback screen
a Radio station information
Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band
(DAB/FM) and frequency.
(U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.78), the Radio
Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text
and “Clock Time”) is also displayed.
b TUNED/STEREO indicators
TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station.
STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received.
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
Browse screen
a Preset station list
Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a preset
station and press ENTER to tune into it.
b Preset number
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
To close the submenu, press RETURN.
Y
(U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
Only Radio Data System broadcasting stations are stored automatically byAuto
Preset”.
Menu Function
Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list).
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
b
c
Menu Submenu Function
Utility
Memory
Registers the current station to the preset
number selected in the list.
Auto Preset
Automatically registers FM radio stations
with strong signals (up to 40 stations).
Clear Preset
Clear the preset station selected in the
list.
Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations.
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the
list.
1 Page Down
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the
background. Press one of the menu
operation keys to redisplay it.
c
b
a
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
TUNER
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
En 80
Playing back music via Bluetooth
You can play back music files stored on a Bluetooth device (such as
smartphones) on the unit. Also, you can enjoy audio played back on the
unit using Bluetooth speakers/headphones.
Y
•To use the Bluetooth function, set “Bluetooth” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu to “On”.
You cannot make Bluetooth connections to a Bluetooth device (such as smartphones)
and Bluetooth speakers/headphones at the same time.
Stand the wireless antenna upright for connecting to a Bluetooth device wirelessly.
For details, see “Preparing the wireless antenna” (p.39).
X
For details on supported Bluetooth devices, see “Supported devices and file formats”
(p.163).
Playing back Bluetooth device music on the
unit
Follow the procedure below to establish a Bluetooth connection
between a Bluetooth device (such as smartphones) and the unit, and
play back music stored the Bluetooth device on the unit.
Y
The unit does not support video playback via Bluetooth.
1
Press BLUETOOTH to select “Bluetooth” as the input
source.
2
On the Bluetooth device, select the unit (network name of
the unit) from the available device list.
A connection between the Bluetooth device and the unit will be
made.
If the pass key is required, enter the number “0000”.
3
On the Bluetooth device, select a song and start playback.
The playback screen (artist name, album name and song title) is
displayed on the TV.
X
If the unit detects the Bluetooth device previously connected, the unit automatically
connects to the Bluetooth device after Step 1. To establish another Bluetooth
connection, first terminate the current Bluetooth connection.
To terminate the Bluetooth connection, perform one of the following operations.
Perform the disconnect operation on the Bluetooth device.
Select an input source other than “Bluetooth” on the unit.
Select “Disconnect” in “Setup menu items” (p.120) in the “Setup” menu.
You can use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the
remote control to control playback.
The unit
Bluetooth speakers/
headphones
The unit
Bluetooth device
(such as smartphones)
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTER
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
NET
PH
O
N
O
US
B
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
O
N
O
N
SC
REEN
DI
S
PLAY
M
O
DE
M
O
VIE
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEEP
ENT
VO
L
U
M
E
PR
OG
RA
M
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
HT
ENHAN
C
E
R
P
U
RE DIRE
CT
M
EMOR
Y
MAIN
Z
O
NE 2
BLUETOOTH
External device
operation keys
En 81
Enjoying audio using Bluetooth
speakers/headphones
Follow the procedure below to establish a Bluetooth connection
between Bluetooth speakers/headphones and the unit, and enjoy audio
played back on the unit using Bluetooth speakers/headphones.
Y
To use this function, set “Transmitter” (p.134) in the “Setup” menu to “On”.
AirPlay and DSD audio cannot be delivered.
1
Use the input selection keys (except BLUETOOTH) to
select an input source.
2
Press ON SCREEN.
3
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to select “Setup!
Bluetooth!Audio Send!Device Search” and
OK”.
The list of available Bluetooth devices (BD addresses) is displayed.
4
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired
Bluetooth speakers/headphones.
X
The checkmark indicates the Bluetooth device currently selected.
5
While the Bluetooth speakers/headphones are in the
pairing mode, use the cursor keys to select “CONNECT
and press ENTER.
When the connection process finishes, audio played back on the
unit will be reproduced from the Bluetooth speakers/headphones.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
X
To terminate the Bluetooth connection, perform the disconnect operation on the
Bluetooth speakers/headphones.
Y
AirPlay and DSD audio cannot be delivered.
When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, input sources other than the network sources
and USB cannot be delivered.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ON SCREEN
ENTER
Input selection keys
Cursor keys
En 82
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device
You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on the unit.
The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or FAT32
format).
X
For details on playable file formats, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.163).
Connecting a USB storage device
1
Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack.
X
If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the them. In this
case, “Loading...” appears in the front display.
Y
Stop playback of the USB storage device before disconnect it from the USB jack.
Connect a USB memory device directly to the USB jack of the unit. Do not use
extension cables.
•The unit cannot charge USB devices while it is in standby mode.
Playback of USB storage device contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device contents
and start playback.
You can control the USB memory device with the menu displayed on the
TV screen.
1
Press USB to select “USB” as the input source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
X
If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is
displayed.
DISPLAY
RETURN
YPAO MIC
PHONES
USB
SILENT CINEMA
(
CONNECT
)
PROGRAM
ENTER
5V 1A
The unit (front)
USB storage device
Connected
USB
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
USB
En 83
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is
displayed.
X
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
To return to the top screen during menu operations on the browse screen,
hold down RETURN.
Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected.
If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden
files) during playback, playback stops automatically.
You can register your favorite items as shortcuts and access them directly by
selecting the shortcut numbers (p.100).
Browse screen
a Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.84) and playback status (such as
play/pause).
b List name
c Contents list
Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to
select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
d Item number/total
e Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
e
c
b
d
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
En 84
Playback screen
a Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.84) and playback status (such as
play/pause).
b Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information.
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
X
You can use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote
control to control playback.
Shuffle/repeat settings
You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for playback of USB storage
device contents.
1
When “USB” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
X
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Menu Function
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
c
b
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order.
x” appears on the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears on the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current
album (folder) repeatedly.
v” appears on the TV screen.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 85
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)
You can play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS on the unit.
Y
To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router (p.39). You can check whether
the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network Connection”
(p.131) in the “Information” menu.
The audio may be interrupted while using the wireless network connection. In this case, use the wired network
connection.
X
For details on playable file formats, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.163).
Media sharing setup
To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS, first you need to configure
the media sharing setting on each music server.
For a PC with Windows Media Player installed
The setting procedure may vary depending on the PC and Windows Media Player version (The
following procedure is a setup example for Windows Media Player 12).
1
Start Windows Media Player 12 on your PC.
2
Select “Stream”, then “Turn on media streaming”.
3
Click “Turn on media streaming”.
4
Select “Allowed” from the drop-down list next to the unit’s model name.
5
Click “OK” to exit.
X
For details on media sharing settings, refer to Windows Media Player help.
For a PC or a NAS with other DLNA server software
installed
Refer to the instruction manual for the device or software and configure the media sharing
settings.
En 86
Playback of PC music contents
Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and start
playback.
You can control the PC/NAS with the menu displayed on the TV screen.
1
Press NET repeatedly to select “SERVER” as the input
source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
X
If playback of a music file selected from the unit is ongoing on your PC, the
playback screen is displayed.
2
Use the cursor keys to select a music server and press
ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is
displayed.
X
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
To return to the top screen during menu operations on the browse screen, hold down
RETURN.
Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected.
If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files)
during playback, playback stops automatically.
•You can register your favorite items as shortcuts and access them directly by
selecting the shortcut numbers (p.100).
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
NET
Cursor keys
En 87
Browse screen
a Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.88) and playback status (such as
play/pause).
b List name
c Contents list
Displays the list of PC content. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and
press ENTER to confirm the selection.
d Item number/total
e Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
Playback screen
a Status indicators
Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.88) and playback status (such as
play/pause).
b Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information.
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
X
You can use the external device operation keys on the remote control to control
playback (some functions may not work depending on the PC/NAS).
You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control
playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.112).
Menu Function
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
e
c
b
d
Menu Function
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
c
b
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 88
Shuffle/repeat settings
You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for the playback of PC
music content.
1
When “SERVER” is selected as the input source, press
OPTION.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or
Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER.
X
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Item Setting Function
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function.
On (On)
Plays back songs in the current album
(folder) in random order.
x” appears on the TV screen.
Repeat
(Repeat)
Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function.
One (One)
Plays back the current song repeatedly.
c” appears on the TV screen.
All (All)
Plays back all songs in the current
album (folder) repeatedly.
v” appears on the TV screen.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
OPTION
ENTER
RETURN
Cursor keys
En 89
Listening to Internet radio
You can listen to Internet radio stations from all over the world.
Y
To use this function, the unit must be connected to the Internet (p.39). You can check
whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to
the unit in “Network” (p.131) in the “Information” menu.
You may not be able to receive some Internet radio stations.
The unit uses the airable.Radio service. airable is a service of Tune In GmbH.
This service may be discontinued without notice.
Folder names are different depending on the language.
Playback of Internet radio
1
Press NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the input
source.
The browse screen is displayed on the TV.
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and the
playback screen is displayed.
X
To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.
•You can register your favorite items as shortcuts and access them directly by
selecting the shortcut numbers (p.100).
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
NET
Cursor keys
En 90
Browse screen
a Playback indicator
b List name
c Contents list
Displays the list of Internet radio content. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select
an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection.
d Item number/total
e Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
Playback screen
a Playback indicator
b Playback information
Displays the station name, album name, song title, and elapsed time.
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information.
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item.
Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
X
You can use the external device operation key (s) on the remote control to stop
playback.
Some information may not be available depending on the station.
Menu Function
Add to favorites
(Remove from
favorites)
Adds/removes the station selected in the list to/from the
“Favorites” folder (p.91).
1 Page Up
Moves to the previous/next page of the list.
1 Page Down
10 Pages Up
Moves 10 pages forward/backward.
10 Pages Down
Return Returns to the higher-level list.
Now Playing Moves to the playback screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
e
c
b
d
Menu Function
Add to favorites Adds the current station to the “Favorites” folder (p.91).
Browse Moves to the browse screen.
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
c
b
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 91
Registering favorite Internet radio stations (Favorites)
By registering your favorite Internet radio stations to “Favorites”, you
can quickly access to them from the “Favorites” folder in the browse
screen.
X
You can also register up to 40 favorite USB and network contents or Bluetooth input
source as shortcuts (p.100).
Registering the station on the
browse/playback screen
1
Select the desired Internet radio station in the browse
screen or start playback of it to display the playback
screen.
2
Press the cursor key (r) to select “Add to favorites” and
press ENTER.
The selected station is added to the “Favorites” folder.
Radio stations registered to favorites are displayed with “S”.
Browse screen
X
To remove a station that is registered to favorites, select the station and then select
Remove from favorites”.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 92
Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay
The AirPlay function allows you to play back iTunes/iPod music on the unit via network.
Y
To use this function, the unit and your PC or iPod must be connected to the same router. You can check whether
the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.141) in the
Information” menu.
When using a multiple SSID router, access to the unit might be restricted depending on the SSID to connect.
Connect the iPod to the SSID which can access the unit.
X
For details on supported iPod devices, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.163).
You can restrict access to the unit using the AirPlay Password (p.103).
Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents
Follow the procedure below to play back iTunes/iPod music contents on the unit.
1
Turn on the unit, and start iTunes on the PC or display the playback screen
on the iPod.
If the iTunes/iPod recognizes the unit, the AirPlay icon appears.
Y
If the icon does not appear, check whether the unit and PC/iPod are connected to the router properly.
2
On the iTunes/iPod, click (tap) the AirPlay icon and select the unit (network
name of the unit) as the audio output device.
3
Select a song and start playback.
The unit automatically selects “AirPlay” as the input source and starts playback.
The playback screen is displayed on the TV.
X
You can turn on the unit automatically when starting playback on iTunes or iPod by setting “Network Standby
(p.132) in the “Setup” menu to “On”.
You can edit the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on iTunes/iPod in “Network Name”
(p.133) in the “Setup” menu.
You can adjust the unit’s volume from the iTunes/iPod during playback. To disable volume controls from
iTunes/iPod, set “Volume Interlock” (p.112) in the “Input” menu to “Off”.
PC
iTunes
iPhone/iPad/iPod touch
Router
(wired or wireless)
The unit
(wired or wireless)
Caution
When you use iTunes/iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be unexpectedly loud. This could
result in damage to the unit or speakers. If the volume suddenly increases during playback, stop
playback on the iTunes/iPod immediately.
iTunes (example) iOS 10 (example)
En 93
Playback screen
a Playback indicator
b Playback information
Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining time.
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information.
c Operation menu
Press the cursor key (r) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection.
X
You can use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote
control to control playback.
Menu Function
Screen Off
Closes the screen display and shows the background.
Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it.
a
c
b
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
Menu operation keys
Cursor keys
External device
operation keys
En 94
Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone)
The multi-zone function allows you to play back different input sources in the room where the
unit is installed (main zone) and in another room (Zone2).
For example, while you are watching TV in the living room (main zone), another person can
listen to radio in the study room (Zone2).
Multi-zone configuration examples
Since there are many possible ways to use the unit in a multi-zone configuration, we
recommend that you consult with your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center
about the multi-zone connections that best meet your requirements.
Enjoying music in another room
You can enjoy music using speakers placed in another room.
Connections
Speakers (connecting to the unit directly): p.30
Speakers (using an external amplifier): p.95
Enjoying videos/music in another room
You can enjoy videos/music using a TV placed in another room.
Enjoying videos/music using a TV and speakers
Connections
TV: p.96
Speakers (connecting to the unit directly): p.30
Speakers (using an external amplifier): p.95
Enjoying videos/music using only a TV
Connection
TV: p.96
Audio signals that can be output to Zone2 vary depending on how you connect the device in Zone2 to
the unit’s output jacks. For details, see “Multi-zone output” (p.165).
Living room (main zone)
Study room
(Zone2)
Audio (SPEAKERS or ZONE OUT)
Living room (main zone)
Guest room
(Zone2)
Audio (SPEAKERS or ZONE OUT)
Video (HDMI)
Living room (main zone)
Study room
(Zone2)
Video/audio (HDMI)
En 95
Preparing Zone2
Connect the device that will be used in Zone2 to the unit.
Connecting speakers to play back audio
Connect speakers to play back audio in Zone2. The connection method varies depending on
the amplifier being used (the unit or an external amplifier).
Using the unit’s internal amplifier
Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 to the unit with speaker cables. For details, see
“Connecting Zone2 speakers” (p.30).
Using an external amplifier
Connect the external amplifier placed in Zone2 to the unit with a stereo pin cable and connect
speakers to the external amplifier.
X
You can adjust the volume for Zone2 output with the unit. When using an external amplifier with volume control,
set “Volume” (p.135) in the “Setup” menu to “Fixed”.
Caution
Remove the unit’s power cable from the AC wall outlet before connecting speakers or an external
amplifier.
Ensure that the bare wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or come into contact with
the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short
circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front display when the unit is turned on.
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2
)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
43
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
VIDEO
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SURROUN
D
SURROUND
R
5
6
L R
ZONE
AM
PRE OUT
SU
B
FRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA
S
Y
P
RPB
Y
P
RPB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
L
R
L
R
AUDIO
The unit (rear)
ZONE OUT (ZONE2) jacks
Zone2
Main zone
External amplifier
Audio input
(analog stereo)
En 96
Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back
videos/audio
Connect an HDMI-compatible device (such as a TV) to play back videos/audio at Zone2.
Y
To watch videos played back on a video device at Zone2, you need to connect the video device to the unit with
an HDMI cable (p.34).
We recommend that you disable HDMI Control on the playback devices connected to the unit.
On-screen operations are not available for Zone2.
To assign the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack to Zone2, set “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the
“Setup” menu to “Zone2”.
X
When the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is assigned to Zone2, you can enable/disable the audio output from the
HDMI OUT 2 jack by setting “Audio Output” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to “On” or “Off” (default).
You can also use speakers placed in Zone2 to output audio (p.30).
Operating the unit from Zone2 (remote connection)
You can operate the unit or external devices from Zone2 using the remote control supplied
with each device if you connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to the unit’s REMOTE
IN/OUT jacks.
X
(China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
You can operate external devices with the supplied remote control if you register a remote control code for each
device. For details, refer to “Supplement for Remote Control” on the supplied CD-ROM.
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
(1
B
AV 1
R
L
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 AUDIO 3
(2 TV)
(1 BD/DVD)
OPTICAL
4
OPTICAL
3
COAXIAL COAXIAL
2
COAXIAL
1
PHONO
VIDEO
GND
FM
75ȍ
ANTENNA
(
4 RADIO
)
OPTICAL
Z
O
5
6
AM
Y
Y
(HDCP2.2)
R
L
HDMI
HDMI OUT
(ZONE OUT)
2
(HDCP2.2)
HDMI
HDMI
The unit (rear)
HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack
Main zone
(Example: using a TV)
HDMI input
Zone2
Videos/audio interruptions may happen in another zone when any of the following operations is
performed.
Tuning on/off a TV connected to the unit via HDMI or switching the TV input
Enabling/disabling a zone output or selecting its input source
Changing the sound mode or audio settings
HDMI OUT
ARC
(ZONE OUT)
1
2
HDMI
(1 BD/DVD)
AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
(HDCP2.2)
AV 5 AV 6 AV 7
IN OUT
REMOTE
1
AV 2 AV 3 AV 4
D
VD)
A
XIAL
COAXIAL
T
ENNA
RADIO
)
OPTICAL
1
2
ZONE OUT
ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
CENTER
SURROUND BACK
SURROUND
F.PRESENCE
R
5
6
L R RL L
ZONE 2
SINGLE
ZONE 2/BI-AMP
AM
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER
CENTERFRONT
SURROUND SUR. BACK
(SINGLE)
EXTRA SP1EXTRA SP2
TRIGGER
OUT
1
2
12V 0.1A
MAX. TOTAL
NETW
O
Y
P
RPB
Y
P
RPB
COMPONENT VIDEO
AV 2
B
AV 1
A
(HDCP2.2)
IN OUT
REMOTE
The unit (rear)
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
External device
(such as a CD player)
Remote control
(supplied with each device)
Infrared signal
receiver
Zone2
Main zone
Infrared signal
transmitter
En 97
Remote connections between Yamaha products
An infrared signal transmitter is not required if you are using Yamaha products that support
remote connections, as the unit does. You can transmit remote control signals by connecting
the REMOTE IN/OUT jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an infrared signal receiver.
IN
OUT
REMOTE
IN
OUT
REMOTE
Remote control
Infrared signal
receiver
Yamaha products
(up to six, including the unit)
REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE IN/OUT jacks
Zone2
En 98
Controlling Zone2
1
Set MAIN/ZONE2 to “ZONE2”.
2
Press z (receiver power).
Each time you press the key, Zone2 is enabled or disabled.
When Zone2 is enabled, “ZONE2” lights up in the front display.
3
Use the input selection keys to select an input source.
Y
Audio signals that can be output to Zone2 vary depending on how you connect
the device in Zone2 to the unit’s output jacks. For details, see “Multi-zone
output” (p.165).
You cannot select Bluetooth, USB and network sources exclusively for each
zone. For example, if you select “SERVER” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected
for the main zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to
“SERVER”.
4
Start playback on the external device or select a radio
station.
Refer to the instruction manual for the external device.
For details on the following operations, see the corresponding
pages.
Listening to FM/AM radio (except Australia, U.K., Europe and
Russia models) (p.69)
Listening to DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models
only) (p.72)
Listening to FM radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models
only) (p.76)
Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.80)
Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.82)
Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.85)
Listening to Internet radio (p.89)
Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay (p.92)
Y
The on-screen operations are not available for Zone2. Use the front display or
web control (p.101) to control Zone2.
AirPlay is available in Zone2 only when AirPlay playback is ongoing in the main
zone.
X
•The Zone2 input automatically switches in conjunction with the input source
selected in the main zone when “Main Zone Sync” is selected as the Zone2
input with the web control (p.101) or AV CONTROLLER (p.9).
To play back DSD audio in Zone2, select “Main Zone Sync” as the Zone2 input
or use the party mode (p.99).
Caution
To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN/ZONE2
z
Input selection keys
En 99
Other operations for Zone2
The following functions are also available when Zone2 is enabled.
Adjusting the volume
Press VOLUME or MUTE.
Selecting the input source and settings at once (SCENE)
Press SCENE.
X
To register the current settings (input source, volume and tone control) to a scene, hold
down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front display.
Setting the sleep timer
Press SLEEP repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min,
off).
Playing back digitally compressed formats (such as MP3, etc.) with
enriched sound (Compressed Music Enhancer)
Press ENHANCER.
Enjoying the same source in multiple
rooms (party mode)
The party mode allows you to play back in Zone2 the same music that is
being played back in the main zone. During the party mode, stereo
playback is automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this function
when you want to use main zone music as background music for a house
party.
1
Press PARTY.
Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or off.
When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the front
display.
Y
If the party mode does not work on Zone2, set “Party Mode Set” (p.136) in the “Setup
menu to “Enable” (default).
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENHANCER
SLEEP
VOLUME
MUTE
SCENE
PARTY
En 100
Registering favorite items (shortcut)
You can register up to 40 favorite USB and network contents or Bluetooth
input source as shortcuts and access them directly by selecting the
shortcut numbers.
X
You can also use the “Favorites” feature to register Internet radio stations (p.91).
Only the input source will be registered for Bluetooth and AirPlay. Individual
contents cannot be registered.
Registering an item
Select a desired item and register it to a shortcut number.
1
Play back a song or a radio station to be registered.
2
Press MEMORY.
X
To change a shortcut number to which the item will be registered, use numeric
keys to select the shortcut number after Step 2.
3
To confirm the registration, press MEMORY.
Recalling a registered item
Recall a registered item by selecting the shortcut number.
1
Press BLUETOOTH, USB or NET.
2
Use the numeric keys to enter a shortcut number (01 to 40).
You can also use PRESET on the front panel to select a shortcut.
Y
•“No Presets” appears when no items are registered.
•“Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered.
The registered item cannot be recalled in the following cases.
The USB storage device which contains the registered item is not connected to the
unit.
The PC/NAS which contains the registered item is turned off or not connected to the
network.
The registered network content is temporarily unavailable or out of service.
The registered item (file) has been deleted or moved to another location.
A Bluetooth connection cannot be established.
When you register music files stored on a USB storage device or a PC/NAS, the unit
memorizes the relative position of the music files in the folder. If you have added or
deleted any music files to or from the folder, the unit may not recall the music file
correctly. In such cases, register the items again.
The registered content (songs and Internet radio stations) can be displayed as a list
and easily recalled by using MusicCast CONTROLLER (p.59) on your mobile device.
01:Empty
Memory Preset
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
Shortcut number (flashes)
02:Empty
Memory Preset
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
Empty” (not in use) or item currently registered
01:USB
Recall Preset
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
PH
O
N
O
TUNER
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
MEMORY
BLUETOOTH
USB
NET
Numeric keys
En 101
Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control)
You can control the unit with the web control screen displayed in a web browser.
Y
To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router.
Some security software installed on your PC may block the access of the unit to your PC. In these cases,
configure the security software appropriately.
To display the web control screen or turn on the unit from the web control when the unit is in standby mode,
set “Network Standby” (p.103) to “On”.
We recommend using one of the following web browsers.
Internet Explorer 11.x
Safari 9.x
1
Start the web browser.
2
Enter the IP address of the unit in the address bar of the web browser.
(Example)
X
You can check the IP address of the unit in “Network” (p.141) in the “Information” menu.
You can bookmark the unit’s IP address in the browser or create a shortcut link (p.103) to access the web
control screen quickly in the future. However, if you are using a DHCP server, the IP address of the unit may
change each time the unit is turned on.
If you have enabled the MAC Address Filter (p.132), you need to specify the MAC address of your PC to allow the
PC to access the unit. For information on how to check the MAC address of your PC, refer to its instruction
manual.
By using the application for smartphone/tablet “AV CONTROLLER”, you can control the unit from an iPhone,
iPad, iPod touch or Android devices (p.9).
Web browser
Web control
PC
Router The unit
Web control
(wired or wireless) (wired or wireless)
En 102
Top menu screen
a CONTROL
Moves to the control screen for the selected zone.
b STATUS
Turns on/off the power for each zone or displays the input source and volume set for each zone.
c SETTINGS
Moves to the settings screen.
d PARTY MODE
Turns on/off the party mode (p.99).
e SYSTEM POWER
Turns on/off the power for all zones.
f MAIN VOLUME
Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the main zone. You can also select the increments used
for volume adjustment.
g RELOAD
Reloads the current status of the unit.
Control screen
a PLAY INFO
Selects an input source or controls playback for the selected zone.
b TOP MENU
Moves to the top menu screen.
c SCENE
Selects a scene for the selected zone.
d POWER
Turns on/off the power for the selected zone.
e VOLUME
Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the selected zone. You can also select the increments
used for volume adjustment.
f RELOAD
Reloads the current status of the unit.
Y
Multi-zone volume adjustment is not available when an external amplifier is used.
c
d
a
b
e
f
g
b
a
d
c
e
f
En 103
Settings screen
a Rename
Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) (p.133) or the name of each zone (p.134). Click
APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit.
Network
Selects the network connection method (p.131) or configures the network parameters (such as IP
address) (p.131). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit.
AirPlay Password
Sets the password to restrict access to the unit via AirPlay (p.92). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to
the unit.
MAC Filter
Sets the MAC address filter (p.132) to limit access to the unit from the network devices. Click “APPLY” to
apply the changes to the unit.
Auto Reload
Enables/disables automatic reloading. When “Auto Reload” is “On” (enabled), the web control screen
reloads the status of the unit every 5 seconds.
Network Standby
Enables/disables the network standby function (p.132).
Backup/Recovery
Creates a backup of the unit’s settings on the PC or restores the settings from the backup.
Firmware
Updates the firmware of the unit by using the firmware you have downloaded on the PC.
Follow the on-screen instructions to start the firmware update.
Create Link
Creates a shortcut link to the desired control screen.
Tips
Displays tips for use of the web control.
Licenses
Displays the licenses of the software used in the unit.
Google Analytics
Displays an explanation of data collection by Google Analytics. Data collection can be enabled or
disabled at any time.
b BACK
Moves to the top menu screen.
c RELOAD
Reloads the current status of the unit.
b
a
c
Note
If the network settings are changed, you may need to restart the browser or regain access to the unit.
When using the MAC address filter, make sure you specify the MAC addresses of your network devices
correctly. Otherwise, the unit will be inaccessible from your network devices such as PCs and other
external devices.
Do not operate the unit during the recovery process, as this may result in the incorrect recovery of the
settings. When the recovery finishes, click “OK” to set the unit to standby mode.
The backup does not contain user information (such as user account and password) or unit-specific
information (such as MAC address and IP address).
Some characters entered with a PC may not appear correctly on the unit.
En 104
Viewing the current status
You can view the current status (input or DSP program currently
selected) on the front panel display or TV.
Switching information on the front display
1
Press INFO repeatedly to select between the various
display items.
About 3 seconds after a display item is selected, its corresponding
information appears.
X
Available items vary depending on the selected input source. The displayed item can
also be applied separately to each input source.
* The name of the audio decoder currently activated is displayed. If no audio decoder
is activated, “Decoder Off” appears.
Audio Decoder
Info
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
Item name
†‡ Dsur
AV1
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
Information
Currently input
source
Item
AV 1-7
VIDEO AUX
AUDIO 1-3
PHONO
DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder
(decoder name*)
TUNER (FM/AM)
(AM radio feature is not available on the Australia, U.K.,
Europe and Russia models)
DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder
(decoder name*)
* (U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
Radio Data System data is also available when the unit is
tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station
(p.78).
TUNER (DAB)
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
See “Displaying the DAB information” (p.74) for details.
Bluetooth
USB
Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album
name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio
Decoder (decoder name*)
SERVER
AirPlay
Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album
name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio
Decoder (decoder name*), IP Address (IP address),
Ethernet MAC (Ethernet MAC address), Wi-Fi MAC (Wi-Fi
MAC address)
NET RADIO
Song (song title), Album (album name), Station (station
name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio
Decoder (decoder name*), IP Address (IP address),
Ethernet MAC (Ethernet MAC address), Wi-Fi MAC (Wi-Fi
MAC address)
MusicCast Link
DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder
(decoder name*), IP Address (IP address), Ethernet MAC
(Ethernet MAC address), Wi-Fi MAC (Wi-Fi MAC address)
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
INFO
En 105
Viewing the status information on the TV
1
Press DISPLAY.
The following information is displayed on the TV.
2
To close the information display, press DISPLAY.
Input source/
Party mode status
Audio format/
Decoder
Compressed Music
Enhancer status
CINEMA DSP status
Sound mode
Volume/YPAO
Volume status
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
ENTE
R
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
ON
SC
REE
N
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
DISPLAY
En 106
Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu)
You can configure separate playback settings for different playback sources. This menu is
available on the front panel (or on the TV screen), allowing you to easily configure settings
during playback.
1
Press OPTION.
Front display
TV screen
2
Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER.
X
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting.
4
To exit from the menu, press OPTION.
Option menu items
X
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display.
Default settings are underlined.
Tone Control
Option
SBL SBR
SL
SW
SR
CL R
VOL.
Item Function Page
Tone Control
(Tone Control)
Adjusts the level of high-frequency range and
low-frequency range individually.
107
YPAO Volume
(YPAO Volume)
YPAO Volume
(YPAO Vol.)
Enables/disables YPAO Volume. 107
Adaptive DRC
(A.DRC)
Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to
minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume is
adjusted.
107
Dialogue
(Dialog)
Dialogue Level
(Dialog Lvl)
Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. 108
DTS Dialogue
Control
(DTS Dialog)
Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds for DTS:X
contents.
108
Dialogue Lift
(Dialog Lift)
Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. 108
Lipsync Adjustment
(Lipsync Adj.)
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. 108
Subwoofer/Bass
(Subwoofer/Bass)
Subwoofer Trim
(SW.Trim)
Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. 108
Extra Bass
(Extra Bass)
Enables/disables Extra Bass. 108
Enhancer
(Enhancer)
Enhancer
(Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 109
Hi-Res Mode
(Hi
Res Mode)
Enables/disables the high-resolution mode (for
enhancing the quality of uncompressed digital audio).
109
Video Processing
(Video Process.)
Enables/disables the video signal processing settings
configured in the “Setup” menu.
109
En 107
Tone Control (Tone Control)
Adjusts the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) individually.
Choices
Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass)
Setting range
-6.0 dB to 0.0
dB to +6.0 dB, *0.5 dB increments
Y
When both “Treble” and “Bass” are 0.0 dB, “Bypass” appears.
If you set an extreme value, sounds may not match those from other channels.
X
You can also adjust the “Tone Control” setting with the front panel controls by pressing TONE CONTROL
repeatedly to select “Treble” or “Bass”, and PROGRAM to make an adjustment.
YPAO Volume (YPAO Volume)
Enables/disables YPAO Volume or Adaptive DRC.
YPAO Volume (YPAO Vol.)
Enables/disables YPAO Volume. When YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency
levels are automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural
sounds even at low volume.
Settings
X
YPAO Volume works effectively after the measurement results of “Auto Setup” have been already saved (p.43).
We recommend enabling both YPAO Volume and Adaptive DRC when you are listening at lower volumes or at
night.
Adaptive DRC (A.DRC)
Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted when
the volume level is adjusted. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for listening to playback at a low
volume at night.
Settings
If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume and wide at a high
volume.
Input Settings
(Input Settings)
Input Trim
(In.Trim)
Corrects volume differences between input sources. 109
Audio Select
(A.Sel)
Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one
audio connection is made for one input source.
109
Video Out
(V.Out)
Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. 110
FM Mode
(FM Mode)
Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio
reception.
110
Init Scan
(Init Scan)
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
Performs an initial scan for DAB radio reception.
72
Tune AID
(Tune AID)
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
Checks reception strength of each DAB channel label.
74
Shuffle
(Shuffle)
Configures the shuffle setting for the USB storage device
(p.84) or media server (p.88).
-
Repeat
(Repeat)
Configures the repeat setting for the USB storage device
(p.84) or media server (p.88).
-
Item Function Page
Off (Off) Disables YPAO Volume.
On (On)Enables YPAO Volume.
Off
(Off) The dynamic range is not automatically adjusted.
On (On) Automatically adjusts the dynamic range when YPAO Volume is enabled.
Volume: low Volume: high
Input level Input level
On
Off
On
Off
Output level
Output level
En 108
Dialogue (Dialog)
Adjusts the volume or perceive height of dialogue sounds.
Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl)
Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. If dialogue sounds cannot be heard clearly, you can
turn up its volume by increasing this setting.
Setting range
0
to 3
X
This setting is not available when DTS:X content is played back, or when the Dolby Surround or Neural:X decoder
is working.
DTS Dialogue Control (DTS Dialog)
Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds for DTS:X contents.
Setting range
0
to 6
X
This setting is available only when DTS:X content which supports the DTS Dialogue Control feature is played back.
Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift)
Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. If the dialogue sounds as if it is coming from
below the TV screen, you can raise its perceived height by increasing this setting.
X
This setting is available only when one of the following conditions is met.
One of the sound programs (except for 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is selected when front presence speakers are
used.
Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) (p.64) is working.
(You may hear dialogue sounds from the surround speakers depending on the listening position.)
Setting range
0
to 5 (The bigger the value the higher the position)
Lipsync Adjustment (Lipsync Adj.)
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output.
Setting range
0 ms
to 500 ms (1 ms increments)
X
This setting is available only when “Delay Enable” (p.127) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Enable” (default).
Subwoofer/Bass (Subwoofer/Bass)
Adjust the subwoofer volume or bass sound.
Subwoofer Trim (SW.Trim)
Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume.
Setting range
-6.0 dB to 0.0 dB
to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Extra Bass (Extra Bass)
Enables/disables Extra Bass. When Extra Bass is enabled, you can enjoy enhanced bass
sounds, regardless of the size of the front speakers and the presence or absence of the
subwoofer.
Settings
Ideal position
Off (Off) Disables Extra Bass.
On (On)Enables Extra Bass.
En 109
Enhancer (Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer and the high-resolution mode.
Enhancer (Enhancer)
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68).
X
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
•You can also use ENHANCER on the remote control to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68).
Settings
Default
TUNER, Bluetooth, USB, (network sources): On (On)
Others: Off (Off)
Y
Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on the following audio sources.
Signals whose sampling frequency is over 48 kHz
–DSD audio
Hi-Res Mode (HiRes Mode)
Enables/disables the high-resolution mode when “Enhancer” is set to “On”. If this function is
set to “On”, you can enhance the quality of uncompressed digital audio (such as 2-channel
PCM and FLAC) using Compressed Music Enhancer.
Settings
Video Processing (Video Process.)
Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio) settings configured
in “Processing” (p.129) in the “Setup” menu.
Settings
Input Settings (Input Settings)
Configures the input settings.
X
This setting is applied separately to each input source.
Input Trim (In.Trim)
Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume differences
when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it.
Setting range
-6.0 dB to 0.0 dB
to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Audio Select (A.Sel)
Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for one input
source.
Settings
Off (Off)Disables Compressed Music Enhancer.
On (On)Enables Compressed Music Enhancer.
On
(On)
Enables the high-resolution mode.
(The high-resolution mode may not work depending on the audio signal
processing condition.)
Off (Off) Disables the high-resolution mode.
Direct (Direct) Disables the video signal processing.
Processing
(Processing)
Enables the video signal processing.
Auto
(Auto)
Automatically selects the audio input jack in the following priority order.
1. HDMI input
2. Digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL)
3. Analog input (AUDIO)
HDMI (HDMI)
Always selects HDMI input. No sounds are produced when no signals are input
through the HDMI jack.
Coax/Opt (Coax/Opt)
Always selects digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL). No sounds are produced when
no signals are input through the COAXIAL or OPTICAL jack.
Analog (Analog)
Always selects analog input (AUDIO). No sounds are produced when no signals are
input through the AUDIO jacks.
En 110
Video Out (V.Out)
Selects a video to be output with the audio input source.
Settings
FM Mode (FM Mode)
Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception.
Settings
Off
(Off) Does not output video.
AV 1-7 (AV1-7), VIDEO
AUX (V-AUX)
Outputs video input through the corresponding video input jacks.
Stereo
(Stereo) Receives FM radio in stereo sounds.
Mono (Mono) Receives FM radio in monaural sounds.
En 111
CONFIGURATIONS
Configuring input sources (Input menu)
You can change the input source settings using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an input source to be configured and
press the cursor key (q).
The input source of the unit also changes.
X
You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
X
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Input menu items
X
Available items vary depending on the selected input source.
Default settings are underlined.
Item Function Page
Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 112
Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 112
Volume Interlock Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay. 112
DMC Control
Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital Media
Controller (DMC) to control playback.
112
En 112
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
X
Some network input sources (such as “AirPlay”) cannot be renamed or have the icons changed.
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Auto” or “Manual” and press the cursor key (w).
If you select “Auto”, the unit creates a name automatically according to the connected device. In
this case, skip Steps 3 and 4.
X
This step is available only when “AV1-7”, “VIDEO AUX” or “AUDIO1-3” (available only when any audio digital
input jack is assigned) is selected.
2
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w).
3
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
4
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry.
X
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
5
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
X
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Decoder Mode
Sets the format of digital audio playback to “DTS”.
For example, if the unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder Mode” to
DTS”.
Input sources
AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX, AUDIO 1-3 (available only when any audio digital input jack is assigned)
Settings
Volume Interlock
Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay.
Input sources
AirPlay
Settings
DMC Control
Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback.
Input source
SERVER
Settings
X
A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network. When
this function is enabled, you can control playback of the unit from DMCs (such as Windows Media Player 12) on
the same network.
Auto Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal.
DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.)
Off Disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod.
Limited
Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod within the limited range (-80 dB to -20
dB and mute).
Full
Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod in the full range (-80 dB to +16.5 dB
and mute).
Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback.
Enable
Allows DMCs to control playback.
En 113
Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu)
You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.61) using the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a scene to be configured and press the
cursor key (q).
X
You can still switch the scene by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
5
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Scene menu items
Save
Registers the unit’s current settings (such as input source and sound program) in the selected
scene.
X
If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device assigned to the
corresponding SCENE key (p.62).
Item Function Page
Save Registers the current settings in the selected scene. 113
Load
Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. You can also
configure the SCENE link playback setting, select items to be
included as the scene assignments, or view the settings currently
assigned to the selected scene.
114
Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 115
Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 115
En 114
Load
Loads the settings registered for the selected scene.
Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the scene assignments.
Device Control
Recalls a selected scene and starts its playback on an external device connected to the unit via
HDMI. (SCENE link playback)
Settings
Default
SCENE1-2: HDMI Control
SCENE3-12: Off
Y
To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI
Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.165).
Detail
Selects items to be included as the scene assignments. You can also view the settings currently
assigned to the selected scene.
To include items as the scene assignments, use the cursor keys to select an item and press
ENTER to check the box (or uncheck the box to exclude).
For example, if you often adjust the volume while watching TV but listen to radio with low
volume at night, exclude “Volume” from the assignments for SCENE2 and include “Volume” in
the assignments for SCENE4.
X
The scene assignments can include radio stations, or the content on a selected USB storage device and a network
device.
Choices
Default
Input, HDMI Output, Mode: selected
Sound, Surround, Video, Volume, Lipsync, Speaker Setup: not selected
Off Disables the SCENE link playback function.
HDMI Control
Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this if an HDMI
Control-compatible device (such as a BD/DVD player) is connected to the unit via
HDMI. It also turns on the TV if it supports HDMI Control.
Input
Input (p.60), Station
*1
, Listening
*1
, Music Content
*2
, Playback
*2
, Audio Select
(p.109)
*1
Only when “TUNER” is selected
*2
Only when “Bluetooth”, “USB” or “NET” is selected
HDMI Output HDMI Output (p.60)
Mode
DSP Program (p.63), Pure Direct Mode (p.128), Enhancer (p.68), Enhancer Hi-Res
Mode (p.109)
Sound
Tone Control (p.107), YPAO Volume (p.107), Adaptive DRC (p.107), Extra Bass
(p.108)
Surround
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (p.128), Dialogue Lift (p.108), Dialogue Level (p.108),
Subwoofer Trim (p.108)
Video Video Mode (p.129)
Volume Master Volume (p.60)
Lipsync Lipsync (p.127), Delay (p.127)
Speaker Setup Setting Pattern (p.123), PEQ Select (p.126)
Check or uncheck
En 115
Playing a radio station or content included as the scene assignments automatically when
pressing SCENE
Y
Individual contents cannot be registered for “Bluetooth” and “AirPlay”. The content lastly played back on each
device will be recalled.
1
In the “Detail” screen, use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Input” and press the cursor key
(r).
2
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to set “Listening” or “Playback” to “On”.
When “TUNER” is selected, “Listening” is available.
When “Bluetooth”, “USB” or “NET” is selected, “Playback” is available.
3
If “Input” is unchecked, press ENTER to check the box.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Rename/Icon Select
Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w).
2
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
3
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry.
X
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
4
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
X
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
5
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Reset
Restores the default settings (p.61) for the selected scene.
En 116
Configuring sound programs/surround decoders
(DSP Program menu)
You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the TV
screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “DSP Program” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a sound program to be configured and
press the cursor key (q).
X
You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3.
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
X
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
En 117
DSP Program menu items
X
Available items vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder.
Default settings are underlined.
Settings for sound programs
Item Function Settings
Decode Type
Selects a surround decoder to be used in
combination with the selected sound
program.
Auto
, bDsur*, Neural:X, Neo:6
Cinema, Neo:6 Music*
(* Available only when
SURROUND DECODER” is
selected)
DSP Level Adjusts the sound field effect level.
-6 dB to 0
dB to +3 dB
Higher to enhance the sound
field effect, and lower to reduce
it.
Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and presence sound field
generation.
1 ms to 99 ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Surround Initial Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround sound field
generation.
1 ms to 49 ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Surround Back Initial
Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and surround back sound field
generation.
Room Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
presence sound field.
0.1 to 2.0
Higher to enhance the
broadening effect, and lower to
reduce it.
Surround Room Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround sound field.
Surround Back Room Size
Adjusts the broadening effect of the
surround back sound field.
Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the presence sound
field.
0 to 10
Higher to enhance the
reflectivity, and lower to reduce
it.
Surround Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the surround sound
field.
Surround Back Liveness
Adjusts the loss of the surround back
sound field.
Reverb Time
Adjust the decay time of the rear
reverberant sound.
1.0 s to 5.0 s
Higher to enrich the reverberant
sound and lower to have clear
sound.
Reverb Delay
Adjusts the delay between the direct
sound and reverberant sound generation.
0 ms to 250 ms
Higher to enhance the delay
effect, and lower to reduce it.
Reverb Level
Adjusts the volume of the reverberant
sound.
0% to 100%
Higher to strengthen the
reverberant sound, and lower to
weaken it.
Item Function Settings
En 118
The following items are available when you select “7ch Stereo”.
X
Available items in “7ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used.
Settings for decoders
The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “SURROUND DECODER” to
bDsur” or “Neo:6 Music”.
Item Function Settings
Level Adjusts the entire volume. -5 to 0
to +5
Front / Rear Balance
Adjusts the front and rear volume
balance.
-5 to 0
to +5
Higher to enhance the front side, and
lower to enhance the rear side.
Left / Right Balance
Adjusts the left and right volume
balance.
-5 to 0
to +5
Higher to enhance the right side, and
lower to enhance the left side.
Height Balance
Adjust the height volume balance
using the front presence speakers.
0 to 5
to 10
Higher to enhance the upside, and
lower to enhance the downside. (The
front presence speakers do not
produce sounds when “Height
Balance” is set to “0”.)
Monaural Mix
Enables/disables monaural sound
output.
Off
, On
Decode Type Item Function Settings
bDsur Center Spread
Selects whether to spread
the center channel signals
to left and right when
2-channel source is
played.
Off
, On
Select “On” to spread center channel
signals to left and right if you feel the
center sound is too strong when
2-channel source is played.
Neo:6 Music Center Image
Adjusts the center
orientation level
(broadening effect) of the
front sound field.
0.0 to 0.3
to 1.0
Higher to strengthen the center
orientation level (less broadening
effect) and lower to weaken (more
broadening effect).
En 119
Configuring various functions (Setup menu)
You can configure the unit’s various function with the menu displayed on the TV screen.
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a menu.
4
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER.
X
To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN.
5
Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
En 120
Setup menu items
Menu Item Function Page
Speaker
Auto Setup Automatically optimizes the speaker settings (YPAO). 43
Manual Setup
Setting Pattern Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. 123
Setting Data Copy Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. 123
Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. 123
Configuration
Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 124
Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 124
Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their size. 124
Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their size. 124
Front Presence Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected and their size. 125
Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. 125
Layout Selects the layouts of the surround speakers and front presence speakers. 125
Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 125
Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 126
Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. 126
Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. 126
Sound
Lipsync
Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. 127
Auto/Manual Select Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. 127
Adjustment Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually. 127
Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 127
Max Volume Sets the limit value of the volumes. 127
Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 128
Pure Direct Mode Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode. 128
Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level. 128
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Enables/disables CINEMA DSP HD
3
. 128
Virtual Presence Speaker Selects whether to create Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers. 128
Virtual Surround Back Speaker Selects whether to create Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround speakers. 128
Object Decode Mode Enables/disables playback of object-based audio signals such as Dolby Atmos or DTS:X contents. 128
Video Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). 129
En 121
HDMI
HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (such as ARC and TV audio input). 130
Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 130
Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. 131
Network
Network Connection Selects the network connection method. 131
IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). 131
Network Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from other network devices. 132
MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. 132
Network Name Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. 133
MusicCast Link Power Interlock
Selects whether turning on the power of the master device of the MusicCast network (the unit) also turns on the power of
other devices of the network.
133
Bluetooth
Bluetooth Enables/disables the Bluetooth functions. 133
Audio Receive
Disconnect Terminates the Bluetooth connection between the Bluetooth device (such as smartphones) and the unit. 80
Bluetooth Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from Bluetooth devices (Bluetooth standby). 133
Audio Send
Transmitter Enables/disables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function. 134
Device Search Searches available Bluetooth devices (speakers/headphones) when the unit is used as a Bluetooth audio transmitter. 81
Multi Zone
Main Zone Set Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 134
Zone2 Set
Volume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. 135
Max Volume Sets the Zone2 limit value of the volumes. 135
Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. 135
Audio Delay Adjusts the Zone2 audio output timing. 135
Mono Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output. 135
Enhancer Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer for Zone2 output. 135
Tone Control Adjusts the level of high-frequency range and low-frequency range for Zone2 output. 135
Extra Bass Enables/disables Extra Bass for Zone2 output. 136
Balance Adjusts the front speaker balance for Zone2 output. 136
Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 136
HDMI OUT2 Assign Select the zone for which the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is used. 136
Party Mode Set En
ables/disables switching to the party mode. 136
Menu Item Function Page
En 122
Function
Input Assignment Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. 137
Remote PROGRAM Key Assigns the desired function to the PROGRAM keys of the remote control. 137
Display Set
Dimmer (Front Display) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 137
Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated. 137
Wallpaper Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. 138
Trigger Output1
Trigger Output2
Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 138
Target Zone Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. 138
Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 139
ECO
Auto Power Standby Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. 139
ECO Mode Enables/disables the eco mode (power saving mode). 140
Language Select an on-screen menu language. 140
Menu Item Function Page
En 123
Speaker (Manual Setup)
Configures the speaker settings manually.
X
Some speaker settings are not available depending on the selected Power Amp Assign” setting.
Default settings are underlined.
Setting Pattern
Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them.
When you configure the following speaker settings, the settings will be memorized in the
selected pattern.
Measurement results (Auto Setup)
Power Amp Assign
Configuration
Distance
Level
Parametric EQ
Settings
Pattern1
, Pattern2
X
The setting pattern currently selected is shown at the top of the “Manual Setup” screen.
This function is useful when you want to save certain settings according to the varying conditions of your
listening environment. For example, if you want to switch the settings when curtains are open or closed, you
can save the settings suited for each condition and switch between them.
Setting Data Copy
Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction.
Choices
Power Amp Assign
Selects a speaker system.
The unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers (with
built-in amplifier) to create the favorite acoustic space in your room. You can also apply bi-amp
connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone
configurations to enhance your system.
Settings
Pattern1 ▶ 2 Copies thePattern1” parameters to “Pattern2”.
Pattern2 ▶ 1 Copies thePattern2” parameters to “Pattern1”.
Basic
Select this option when you use the basic speaker configuration (up to 7-channel
plus front presence speakers) (p.18).
7.1 +1Zone
Select this option when you use Zone2 speakers in addition to the 7.1 system in
the main zone (p.27).
5.1.2 +1Zone
Select this option when you use Zone2 speakers in addition to the 5.1.2 system in
the main zone (p.28).
5.1 Bi-Amp
Select this option when you use the 5.1 system (including bi-amp front speakers)
(p.28).
7.1 Bi-Amp [ext.SB]
Select this option when you use the 7.1 system (including bi-amp front speakers
and surround back channel expansion using an external amplifier) (p.29).
En 124
Configuration
Configures the output characteristics of the speakers.
X
When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm (6-1/4) or
larger or Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm (6-1/4”) as a guide.
When the speaker size is set to “Small”, you can configure the “Crossover” setting after pressing ENTER.
Frequency sounds lower than the specified value will be output from the subwoofer and higher will be output
from the corresponding speakers.
Front
Selects the size of the front speakers.
Settings
X
Front” is automatically set to “Large” when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”.
Center
Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size.
Settings
Surround
Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their sizes.
Settings
Surround Back
Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their sizes.
Settings
X
This setting is not available when “Surround” is set to “None”, or when “Layout (Surround)” is set to “Front”.
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency components.
Small
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components lower than
the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz).
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency components.
Small
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce center channel low-frequency
components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz).
None
Select this option when no center speaker is connected.
The front speakers will produce center channel audio.
Large
Select this option for large speakers.
The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel frequency
components.
Small
Select this option for small speakers.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround channel low-frequency
components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz).
None
Select this option when no surround speakers are connected.
The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual CINEMA DSP
works when you select a sound program.
Large x1
Select this option when one large speaker is connected.
The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back channel
frequency components.
Large x2
Select this option when two large speakers are connected.
The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back channel
frequency components.
Small x1
Select this option when one small speaker is connected.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel
low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency
(default: 80 Hz).
Small x2
Select this option when two small speakers are connected.
The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel
low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency
(default: 80 Hz).
None
Select this option when no surround back speakers are connected.
The surround speakers will produce surround back channel audio.
En 125
Front Presence
Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected and their size.
Settings
Subwoofer
Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase.
Settings
X
When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase.
Layout
Selects the layouts of the surround speakers and front presence speakers.
Surround
Selects a surround speaker layout when surround speakers are used.
Settings
X
This setting is not available when “Configuration (Surround)” is set to “None”.
Front Presence
Selects a front presence layout when front presence speakers are used. This setting facilitates
the optimization of the sound field effect.
Settings
X
This setting is not available when “Configuration (Front Presence)” is set to “None”.
•To play Dolby Atmos contents using the front presence speakers, see “Presence speaker layout” (p.22).
Distance
Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the
speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance from
Meter” or Feet”.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front
Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
0.30 m to 3.00
m to 24.00 m (1.0 ft to 10.0 ft to 80.0 ft), *0.05 m (0.2 ft) increments
Large Select this option for large speakers.
Small
Select this option for small speakers.
None Select this option when no front presence speakers are connected.
Use
Normal
Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase not reversed). The
subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and
low-frequency components from other channels.
Reverse
Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase reversed). The
subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and
low-frequency components from other channels.
None
Select this option when no subwoofer is connected. The front speakers will
produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency
components from other channels.
Rear
Select this option when surround speakers are placed on the rear side of the
room.
Front
Select this option when surround speakers are placed on the front side of the
room. Virtual CINEMA FRONT (p.66) works in this case.
Front Height
Select this option when front presence speakers are installed on the front side
wall.
Overhead Select this option when front presence speakers are installed to the ceiling.
Dolby Enabled SP
Select this option when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the front presence
speakers.
En 126
Level
Adjusts the volume of each speaker.
Choices
Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front
Presence R, Subwoofer
Setting range
-10.0 dB to 0.0
dB to +10.0 dB (0.5 dB increments)
Parametric EQ
Adjusts the tone with an equalizer.
Settings
X
“YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front”, and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto
Setup” have already been saved (p.43). Press ENTER again to view the measurement results.
Manual equalizer adjustment
1
Set “Parametric EQ” to “Manual” and press ENTER.
2
Press ENTER again to enter the edit screen.
3
Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER.
X
To restore the default settings for all speakers, select “PEQ Data Clear” and then “OK”.
To copy the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.43) to the “Manual” fields for fine
adjustment, select “PEQ Data Copy” and then an equalizer type.
4
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a center frequency from the 7 preset bands (4 for
subwoofer) and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Setting range
Gain: -20.0 dB to +6.0 dB
5
To fine-adjust the center frequency or Q factor (bandwidth), press ENTER repeatedly to select
an item.
Frequency: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the center frequency of the selected band and
the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Q: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and the
cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain.
Setting range
Center frequency: 15.6 Hz to 16.0 kHz (15.6 Hz to 250.0 Hz for subwoofer)
Q factor: 0.500 to 10.080
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Test Tone
Enables/disables the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker
balance or equalizer while confirming its effect.
Settings
Manual
Select this option when you want to adjust the equalizer manually.
For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”.
YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics.
YPAO:Front
Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics as the front
speakers.
YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound.
Through
Does not use the equalizer.
Off Does not output test tones.
On
Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance or
equalizer.
En 127
Sound
Configures the audio output settings.
Lipsync
Adjusts the delay between video and audio by holding up the audio output.
Delay Enable
Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source.
Choices
AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX, AUDIO 1-3
Settings
Auto/Manual Select
Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output.
Setting range
Y
Even if Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”, the automatic adjustment does not work depending on the TV
connected to the unit. In this case, adjust the delay manually in “Adjustment”.
Adjustment
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually when “Auto/Manual Select” is set
to “Manual”. You can fine-adjust the audio output timing when “Auto/Manual Select” is set to
Auto”.
Setting range
0
ms to 500 ms (1 ms increments)
X
•“Offset” shows the difference between automatic adjustment and fine adjustment.
This setting is also available in “Lipsync Adjustment” (p.108) in the “Option” menu.
Dynamic Range
Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS
signals) playback.
Settings
Max Volume
Sets the limit value of the volume.
Setting range
-30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5
dB
Disable Disable the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source.
Enable
Enables the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source.
Auto
Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when a TV that
supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to the unit via HDMI.
If necessary, you can fine-adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”.
Manual
Select this option when you want to adjust the delay between video and audio
output manually.
Adjust the audio output timing in Adjustment”.
Maximum Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range.
Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use.
Minimum/Auto
Sets the dynamic range for clear sound even at night or at low volumes.
When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is automatically
adjusted based on the input signal information.
En 128
Initial Volume
Sets the initial volume when the receiver is turned on.
Settings
Pure Direct Mode
Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode (p.68).
Settings
Adaptive DSP Level
Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level.
Settings
CINEMA DSP 3D Mode
Enables/disables CINEMA DSP HD
3
(p.64). If this function is set to On”, CINEMA DSP HD
3
functions with the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo).
Settings
Virtual Presence Speaker
Selects whether to create Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround
speakers. When VPS is enabled, the unit creates front VPS when no front presence speakers are
connected, and creates rear VPS when front presence speakers are connected (p.64).
Settings
X
Depending on the installation height of the surround speakers, VPS may not be effective. In this case, set “Virtual
Presence Speaker” to “Off”.
Virtual Surround Back Speaker
Selects whether to create Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround speakers.
When VSBS is enabled, the unit creates VSBS when no surround back speakers are connected.
Settings
X
VSBS is effective only when 6.1- or 7.1-channel content is played back.
Object Decode Mode
Enables/disables playback of object-based audio signals such as Dolby Atmos or DTS:X
contents.
Settings
X
If audio output is not available when Dolby Atmos or DTS:X signals are input, set “Object Decode Mode” to
Enable”.
Off Sets the level to the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode.
On
Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments).
(This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.)
Auto
Automatically outputs video signals when any videos are input from the selected
input source or an input source that can be operated with the on-screen display is
selected. When no video signals are input, the wall paper is displayed.
Video Off Does not output video signals including the wall paper.
Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically.
On
Adjusts the effect level automatically according to the YPAO measurement results
and the volume level.
Off Disables CINEMA DSP HD
3
.
On
Enables CINEMA DSP HD
3
.
Off Disables Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS).
On
Enables Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS).
Off Disables Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS).
On
Enables Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS).
Disable
Disables playback of object-based audio signals. Those signals will be played in
normal 5.1-/7.1-channel audio.
Enable
Enables playback of object-based audio signals.
En 129
Video
Configures the video output settings.
Video Mode
Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio).
Settings
X
•WhenVideo Mode” is set to “Direct”, the unit transmits video signals with the least circuitry in order to reduce
video output delay.
•WhenVideo Mode” is set to “Processing” and the resolution is being converted, short messages are not
displayed on the TV screen.
Resolution
Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when Video Mode” is set to “Processing”.
Settings
X
If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MONITOR CHECK” (p.144) in the
ADVANCED SETUPmenu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that the output video may not be displayed on your TV
normally.)
Aspect
Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”.
Settings
X
This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i, 1080p, or 2160p
(4K) signals.
Direct Disables the video signal processing.
Processing
Enables the video signal processing.
Select a resolution and an aspect ratio in “Resolution” and “Aspect”.
Through Does not convert the resolution.
Auto
Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV resolution.
480p/576p, 720p,
1080i, 1080p, 4K
Output video signals with a selected resolution.
(Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.)
Through
Does not convert the aspect ratio.
16:9 Normal
Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side of the
screen.
En 130
HDMI
Configures the HDMI settings.
HDMI Control
Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.165).
Settings
Y
To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.165) after connecting HDMI
Control-compatible devices.
TV Audio Input
Selects an audio input jack of the unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI Control” is set
to “On”. The unit’s input source automatically switches to TV audio when the TV input is
switched to its built-in tuner.
Settings
AUDIO 1-3
Default
AUDIO 1
Y
When using ARC to input TV audio to the unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected here for connecting an
external device because the input will be used for TV audio input.
ARC
Enables/disables ARC (p.167) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
Y
You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected to the
unit because TV audio signals input to the unit via ARC are not supported by the unit, set “ARC” to “Off” and use
the TV’s speakers.
Standby Sync
Select whether to use HDMI control to link the standby behavior of the TV and the unit when
HDMI Control” is set to “On”.
Settings
Audio Output
Selects a device to output audio.
X
•TheHDMI OUT1” setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.
•TheHDMI OUT2” setting is available only when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) is set to “Main”.
HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2
Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT 1 jack or HDMI OUT
2 jack.
Settings
Y
The HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks output 2-channel audio signals when the unit is turned on.
Off Disables HDMI Control.
On
Enables HDMI Control.
Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby Sync”.
Off Disables ARC.
On
Enables ARC.
Off Does not set the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off.
On Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off.
Auto
Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off only when the unit is
receiving TV audio or HDMI signals.
Off
Disables the audio output from the TV.
On Enables the audio output from the TV.
En 131
Standby Through
Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in
standby mode. If this function is set to “On” or “Auto”, you can use the input selection keys (AV
1-7 and V-AUX) to select an HDMI input even when the unit is in standby mode (the standby
indicator on the unit blinks).
Settings
Network
Configures the network settings.
Network Connection
Selects the network connection method.
Settings
IP Address
Configures the network parameters (such as IP address).
DHCP
Select whether to use a DHCP server.
Settings
Off
(This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.)
Does not output videos/audio to the TV.
On
Outputs videos/audio to the TV.
(The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.)
Auto
Outputs videos/audio to the TV. If no signals are detected, the unit is set to the
power saving mode.
Wired
Select this option when you want to connect the unit to a network with a
commercially-available network cable (p.39).
Wireless (Wi-Fi)
Select this option when you want to connect the unit to a network via the wireless
router (access point). For details on settings, see “Connecting the unit to a
wireless network” (p.52).
Wireless Direct
Select this option when you want to connect a mobile device to the unit directly.
For details on settings, see “Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly
(Wireless Direct)” (p.57).
Off
Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters manually. For
details, see “Manual network settings”.
On
Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the unit’s network parameters (such
as IP address).
En 132
Manual network settings
1
Set “DHCP” to “Off”.
2
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a parameter type and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a
value.
4
To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
5
To configure another network parameter, repeat steps 2 to 4.
6
To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
7
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Network Standby
Selects whether the unit can be turned on from other network devices (network standby).
Settings
With an advanced energy saving design, this product achieves a low power consumption of not
more than two watts when in Network Standby mode.
MAC Address Filter
Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices.
Filter
Enables/disables the MAC address filter.
Settings
X
AirPlay (p.92) and DMC (p.112) operations are not subject to the MAC address filter.
MAC Address 1-10
Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted access to
the unit when “Filter” is set to “On”.
Setup procedure
1
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “MAC Address 1-5” or “MAC Address 6-10” and press
ENTER.
2
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an MAC address number and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a
value.
4
To confirm the setting, press ENTER.
5
To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
6
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
IP Address Specifies an IP address.
Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask.
Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway.
DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server.
DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server.
Off Disables the network standby function.
On
Enables the network standby function.
(The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.)
Auto
Enables the network standby function.
(If “Network Connection” is set to “Wired”, the unit is set to the power saving
mode when the network cable is disconnected.)
Off Disables the MAC address filter.
On
Enables the MAC address filter. In “MAC Address 1-10”, specify the MAC addresses
of the network devices that will be permitted access to the unit.
En 133
Network Name
Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices.
Setup procedure
1
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
2
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry.
X
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
X
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
MusicCast Link Power Interlock
Selects whether turning on the power of the master device of the MusicCast network (the unit)
also turns on the power of other devices of the network.
Settings
Bluetooth
Configures the Bluetooth settings.
Bluetooth
Enables/disables the Bluetooth function (p.80).
Settings
Audio Receive
Configures the Bluetooth settings when the unit is used as the Bluetooth audio receiver.
Bluetooth Standby
Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from Bluetooth devices
(Bluetooth standby). If this function is set to “On”, the unit automatically turns on when a
connect operation is performed on the Bluetooth device.
Settings
X
This setting is not available when “Network Standby” (p.132) is set to “Off”.
Off Disables the power interlock from the unit (MusicCast master).
On Enables the power interlock from the unit (MusicCast master).
Off Disables the Bluetooth function.
On
Enables the Bluetooth function.
Off Disables the Bluetooth standby function.
On
Enables the Bluetooth standby function.
(The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.)
En 134
Audio Send
Configures the Bluetooth settings when the unit is used as the Bluetooth audio transmitter.
Transmitter
Enables/disables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function.
When this function is enabled, you can enjoy audio played back on the unit using Bluetooth
speakers/headphones (p.81).
Settings
Multi Zone
Configures the multi zone settings.
Main Zone Set
Configures the main zone setting.
Zone Rename
Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen.
Setup procedure
1
Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen.
2
Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry.
X
To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER.
X
To restore the default setting, select “RESET”.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Off Disables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function.
On Enables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function.
En 135
Zone2 Set
Configures the Zone2 settings.
Volume
Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output.
If you have connected an external amplifier with volume control to the unit, disable volume
adjustments for Zone2.
Settings
X
This setting is not available depending on the “Power Amp Assign” setting.
Max Volume
Sets the Zone2 limit value of the volumes.
Setting range
-30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5
dB
X
This setting is available only when “Volume” is set to “Variable”.
Initial Volume
Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on.
Settings
X
This setting is available only when “Volume” is set to “Variable”.
Audio Delay
Adjusts the Zone2 audio output timing so that the audio is synchronized with the video.
Setting range
0
ms to 100 ms (1 ms increments)
Mono
Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output.
Settings
Enhancer
Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68) for Zone2 output.
Settings
Tone Control
Adjusts the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) for Zone2
output.
Settings
Fixed Disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output.
Variable
Enables volume adjustments for Zone2 output.
Off
Sets the level at the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode.
On
Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments).
(This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.)
Off Produces stereo sounds in Zone2.
On Produces monaural sounds in Zone2.
Off Disables Compressed Music Enhancer.
On
Enables Compressed Music Enhancer.
Auto
Adjusts the levels of the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range
(Bass) automatically in synchronization with the main volume, with correction for
the auditory response of the human ear.
Manual
Adjusts the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass)
manually (-6.0 to +6.0 dB, 0.5 dB increments).
Bypass
Does not adjust the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency
range (Bass).
En 136
Extra Bass
Enables/disables Extra Bass for Zone2 output. When Extra Bass is enabled, you can enjoy
enhanced bass sounds, regardless of the size of speakers.
Settings
Balance
Adjusts the front speaker balance for Zone2 output.
Setting range
-20 to 0
to +20 (negative to the left and positive to the right)
Zone Rename
Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen.
You can change the zone name in the same manner as “Zone Rename” in “Main Zone Set”
(p.134).
HDMI OUT2 Assign
Select the zone for which the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is used.
Settings
Main
, Zone2
X
For details on audio signals that can be output to Zone2, see “Multi-zone output” (p.165).
Zone2 - Audio Output
Enables/disables the audio output from the HDMI OUT 2 jack when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” is set
to “Zone2”.
Party Mode Set
Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.99).
Choice
Target: Zone2
Settings
Off
Disables Extra Bass.
On Enables Extra Bass.
On Enables the audio output.
Off
Disables the audio output (video output only).
Disable Disables switching to the party mode.
Enable
Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party mode by
pressing PARTY on the remote control.
En 137
Function
Configures the functions that make the unit easier to use.
Input Assignment
Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source.
Procedure
Example: assigning the OPTICAL (2) jack to the input source “AV 2
1
Use the cursor keys to select the cell at the intersection of “AV 2” andOptical”, and press ENTER.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “2” and press ENTER.
3
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
X
You cannot assign both COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to the same input source.
Remote PROGRAM Key
Assigns the desired function to the PROGRAM keys of the remote control.
For example, when “INPUT Selection” is selected, the PROGRAM keys will operate as the input
switching keys.
Settings
Display Set
Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display.
Dimmer (Front Display)
Adjusts the brightness of the front display.
Setting range
-4 to 0
(higher to brighten)
Y
The front display may become dark when “ECO Mode” (p.140) is set to “On”.
Short Message
Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as
input selection and volume adjustment).
Settings
DSP Program
Selection
Select a sound program.
INPUT Selection Select an input source for playback.
NET Selection Select a network source.
Preset Selection Select a registered item (shortcut).
Browse Screen -
1Page Up/Down
Move to the previous/next page of the browse screen list.
Subwoofer Trim Adjust the subwoofer volume.
Dialogue Level Adjust the volume of dialogue sounds.
qRepeat / wShuffle Select the repeat/shuffle setting for the USB storage device or media server.
On
Displays short messages on the TV screen.
Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen.
En 138
Wallpaper
Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV.
Settings
Trigger Output1, Trigger Output2
Sets the TRIGGER OUT 1-2 jacks to function in sync with the power status of each zone or input
switching.
Trigger Mode
Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function.
Settings
Source
Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input, switching when
Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”.
Choices
AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX, AUDIO 1-3, PHONO, TUNER, (network sources), Bluetooth, USB
Settings
Manual
Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger Mode” is
set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of the external device
connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack.
Choices
Target Zone
Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized.
Settings
Piano
Displays the piano image on the TV screen when there is no video signal.
Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video signal.
Power
The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the power status of the zone
specified with Target Zone”.
Source
The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the input switching in the zone
specified with Target Zone”.
An electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in “Source.”
Manual
Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission
with “Manual”.
Low
Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input source
specified in this option.
High
Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source specified in
this option.
Low Stops the electronic signal transmission.
High
Transmits the electronic signal.
Main
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with the power status of the main zone.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with the input switching in the main zone.
Zone2
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with the power status of Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with the input switching in Zone2.
All
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with the power status of the main zone or Zone2.
When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is
synchronized with the input switching in the main zone or Zone2.
En 139
Memory Guard
Prevents accidental changes to the settings.
Settings
X
When “Memory Guard” is set to “On”, the lock icon (o) is displayed on the menu screen.
ECO
Configures the power supply settings.
Auto Power Standby
Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. If you do not operate the unit or if no
input signals are detected for the specified time, the unit will automatically go into standby
mode.
Settings
Default
U.K., Europe and Russia models: 20 Minutes
Other models: Off
X
Just before the unit enters standby mode, “AutoPowerStdby” appears and then countdown starts in the front
display.
Off Does not protect the settings.
On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected.
Icon
Off Does not set the unit to standby mode automatically.
20 Minutes
Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit and no input
signals are detected for 20 minutes.
2 Hours, 4 Hours,
8 Hours, 12 Hours
Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit for the
specified time. For example, when “2 Hours” is selected, the unit will switch to
standby mode if you do not operate it for 2 hours.
En 140
ECO Mode
Enables/disables the eco (power saving) mode.
You can reduce the unit’s power consumption by setting “ECO Mode” to “On”. After setting, be
sure to press ENTER to restart the unit.
Settings
Y
•WhenECO Mode” is set to “On”, the front panel display may become dark.
If you want to play audio at high volume, set “ECO Mode” to “Off”.
Language
Select an on-screen menu language.
Settings
English
, Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian, Italian, Chinese
X
The information on the front display is provided in English only.
Viewing information about the unit
(Information menu)
You can view information about the unit using the TV screen.
X
If new firmware is available, (mail icon) appears at the upper right of the “Information”. For details, see
“Updating the unit’s firmware via the network” (p.147).
1
Press ON SCREEN.
2
Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER.
3
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an information type.
4
To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN.
Off Disables the eco mode.
On Enables the eco mode.
En 141
Types of information
You can check the following information in the Information menu.
Audio Signal
Displays information about the current audio signal.
X
Even when the unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on the
specifications and settings of the playback device.
Some information may not be available depending on the signal type.
Video Signal
Displays information about the current video signal.
HDMI Monitor
Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks.
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”.
Network
Displays the network information on the unit.
(When using wired or wireless [Wi-Fi] network connection)
Input
Format Audio format of the input signal
Channel
The number of source channels in the input signal
(front/surround/LFE)
For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total (3 front channels,
2 surround channels, and LFE).
Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal
Dialogue The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal
Output Channel
The number of signal output channels (for example, “5.1.2”
denotes “standard 5.1-channel plus 2 for overhead speaker
channels”) and the speaker terminals from which signals are
output
HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output
HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI)
Analog Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog)
Interface TV interface
Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV
IP Address IP address
Subnet Mask Subnet mask
Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway
DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server
DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server
MAC Address (Ethernet)
MAC address
MAC Address (Wi-Fi)
Network Name Network name (the unit’s name on the network) (p.133)
MusicCast Network The status of the MusicCast network connection
Wired/Wireless The status of the wired or wireless connection
SSID
(When using wireless [Wi-Fi] network connection)
The SSID of the wireless network
En 142
(When using Wireless Direct)
System
Displays the system information on the unit.
X
If the unit detects a newer firmware over the network, (mail icon) appears at the upper right of the
Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You can
update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in “Updating the unit’s
firmware via the network” (p.147).
Multi Zone
Displays information about Zone2.
Configuring the system settings
(ADVANCED SETUP menu)
Configure the system settings of the unit while viewing the front display.
1
Set the unit to standby mode.
2
While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z.
3
Press PROGRAM to select an item.
4
Press STRAIGHT to select a setting.
5
Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on again.
The new settings take effect.
SSID The SSID of the wireless network
Security Security method
Security Key Security key
IP Address IP address
Subnet Mask Subnet mask
MAC Address (Wi-Fi) MAC address
MusicCast Network The status of the MusicCast network connection
Network Connection Wireless Direct” indication
Remote ID The unit’s remote control ID setting (p.144)
TV Format The unit’s video signal type (p.144)
Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of the unit (p.143)
Tuner Freq. Step
(Asia and General models only)
The FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit (p.144)
System ID System ID number
Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on the unit
Input The input source selected for Zone2
Volume The volume for Zone2
MAIN ZONE z STRAIGHT
PROGRAM
En 143
ADVANCED SETUP menu items
X
Default settings are underlined.
Changing the speaker impedance setting
(SPEAKER IMP.)
Change the unit’s speaker impedance settings depending on the impedance of the speakers
connected.
Settings
Turning on/off the remote control sensor
(REMOTE SENSOR)
Turn on/off the remote control sensor on the main unit. While the remote control sensor is
turned off, you cannot control the unit from the remote control.
Settings
Item Function Page
SPEAKER IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. 143
REMOTE SENSOR Turns on/off of the remote control sensor on the main unit. 143
REMOTE ID Selects the unit’s remote control ID. 144
TUNER FRQ STEP
(Brazil, Asia and General models only)
Changes the FM/AM tuning frequency setting.
144
TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 144
MONITOR CHECK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 144
4K MODE Selects the HDMI 4K (60 Hz/50 Hz) signal format. 145
DTS MODE Switches the DTS format notification setting. 145
RECOV./BACKUP
Creates backup of the settings of the unit, or recovers the settings from
the backup.
145
INITIALIZE Restores the default settings. 146
FIRM. UPDATE Updates the firmware. 146
VERSION Checks the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. 146
6 Ω MIN
Select this option when you connect 6-ohm speakers to the unit. You can also use
4-ohm speakers as the front speakers.
8 Ω MIN
Select this option when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to the unit.
ON
Turns on the remote control sensor.
OFF Turns off the remote control sensor.
8¬MIN
SPEAKER¡IMP.
ON
REMOTE SENSOR
En 144
Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID)
Change the unit’s remote control ID so that it matches the remote control’s ID (default: ID1).
When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a unique
remote control ID for its corresponding receiver.
Settings
ID1
, ID2
Changing the remote control ID of the remote control
1
To select ID1, hold down the cursor key (e) and SCENE1 together for 3 seconds.
To select ID2, hold down the cursor key (e) and SCENE2 together for 3 seconds.
Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting
(TUNER FRQ STEP)
(Brazil, Asia and General models only)
Change the FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit depending on your country or region.
Settings
Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT)
Switch the video signal type of the unit so that it matches to the format of your TV.
Settings
NTSC, PAL
Default
U.S.A., Canada, Korea, Brazil and General models: NTSC
Other models: PAL
Removing the limitation on HDMI video output
(MONITOR CHECK)
The unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jack.
Disable the monitor check function if you want to specify a resolution in “Resolution” (p.129)
when the unit cannot detect the TV’s resolution or when you want to specify a different
resolution than the detected resolution.
Settings
Y
Reset to “YES” if the unit becomes inoperable because video from the unit cannot be displayed on the TV after
MONITOR CHECK” has been set to “SKIP”.
FM100/AM10
Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 100-kHz steps and AM by
10-kHz steps.
FM50/AM9
Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 50-kHz steps and AM by
9-kHz steps.
ID1
REMOTE ID
FM50/AM9
TUNER FRQ STEP
YES
Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a resolution
supported by the TV only.)
SKIP
Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a specified
resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.)
NTSC
TV FORMAT
YES
MONITOR CHECK
En 145
Selecting the HDMI 4K signal format (4K MODE)
Selects the format of signals input/output at the unit when HDMI 4K compatible TV and
playback device are connected to the unit.
Settings
Format
Y
•WhenMODE 1” is selected, use a Premium High Speed HDMI Cable or Premium High Speed Cable with
Ethernet.
Regardless of the setting, 4K signals are input as “MODE 2” for the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack.
Switching the DTS format notification setting (DTS MODE)
Switches the DTS format notification setting.
This setting informs the video device (such as BD/DVD player) about the DTS formats that the
unit supports.
Settings
Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP)
Creates backup of the settings of the unit, or recovers the settings from the backup.
Backup/recovery procedure
1
Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “BACKUP” or “RECOVERY” and press INFO to start the
process.
Choices
MODE 1
Inputs/outputs 4K signals shown in the table below.
Depending on the connected device or HDMI cables, video may not be displayed
correctly. In this case, select “MODE 2”.
MODE 2 Inputs/outputs 4K signals shown in the table below.
MODE 1 MODE 2
8 bit 10 bit 12 bit 8 bit 10 bit 12 bit
4K/60, 50 Hz
RGB 4:4:4 ,- -
YCbCr 4:4:4 ,- -
YCbCr 4:2:2 ,-
YCbCr 4:2:0 ,,-
4K/30, 25, 24 Hz
RGB 4:4:4 ,,-
YCbCr 4:4:4 ,,-
YCbCr 4:2:2 ,,
MODE 1
4K MODE
MODE 1
This mode conforms to the DTS:X standard.
Use this setting under normal circumstances.
MODE 2
Use this setting if the video device (such as BD/DVD player) fails to properly
output a DTS signal even when it is playing back DTS-HD or DTS:X content.
BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of the unit in the internal memory.
RECOVERY
Recovers the settings of the unit from the backup (available only when
backup has been created).
Note
Do not turn off the unit during the recovery process. Otherwise, the settings may not be restored
correctly.
The backup does not contain user information (such as user accounts and passwords).
MODE 1
DTS MODE
BACKUP
RECOV./BACKUP
En 146
Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE)
Restores the default settings for the unit.
Choices
Updating the firmware (FIRM. UPDATE)
New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be released as
needed. Updates can be downloaded from the Yamaha website. If the unit is connected to the
Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details, refer to the information
supplied with updates.
Firmware update procedure
Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure you read the
information supplied with updates before updating the firmware.
1
Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to start firmware
update.
Choices
X
If the unit detects newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after
ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the unit’s firmware by following the procedure in
“Updating the unit’s firmware via the network” (p.147).
Checking the firmware version (VERSION)
Check the version of firmware currently installed on the unit.
X
You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.142) in the “Information” menu.
It may take a while until the firmware version is displayed.
VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations.
ALL Restores the default settings for the unit.
CANCEL Does not perform an initialization.
USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device.
NETWORK Update the firmware via the network.
CANCEL
INITIALIZE
USB
FIRM. UPDATE
x.xx
VERSION
En 147
Updating the unit’s firmware via the network
New firmware that provides additional features or product
improvements will be released as needed. If the unit is connected to the
Internet, you can download the firmware via the network and update it.
X
You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the “ADVANCED
SETUP” menu (p.146).
The firmware update indicator (p.12) on the front display lights up when a firmware
update is available via the network.
A firmware update is available if the following message is displayed after
ON SCREEN is pressed.
Updating the unit’s firmware immediately
1
Read the on-screen description.
2
To start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to select
START” and press ENTER.
3
If “UPDATE SUCCESS PLEASE POWER OFF!” appears on
the front display, press MAIN ZONE z on the front panel.
The firmware update is complete.
X
If you want to cancel without doing anything now, select “CLOSE”. (mail icon)
appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and a message will
be displayed in the “System” screen (p.142). You can update the unit’s firmware by
pressing ENTER in the “System” screen.
Note
Do not operate the unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable
during firmware update. Firmware update takes about 20 minutes or more
(depending on your Internet connection speed).
If the unit is connected to the wireless network, network update may not be
possible depending on the condition of the wireless connection. In this case,
update the firmware using the USB memory device (p.146).
For details on update, visit the Yamaha website.
Information icon
Message
System Icon
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
RETURN
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
VO
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
Cursor keys
En 148
Updating the unit’s firmware at power off
1
Read the on-screen description.
2
To set the firmware to update at power off, use the cursor
keys to select “LATER” and press ENTER.
3
Press z (receiver power) to turn off the unit.
The following message is displayed on the front display.
X
The unit turns off automatically without performing the firmware update 2
minutes after Step 3.
4
To start the firmware update, press ENTER.
X
To cancel the firmware update and turn off the unit, press RETURN.
You can also start the firmware update by pressing INFO on the front panel.
The unit turns off without performing the firmware update if you turn off the
unit with AV CONTROLLER or MusicCast CONTROLLER.
If the firmware update is complete, the unit turns off automatically.
UPDATE:ENTER
NETWORK
Firmware update indicator (flashes)
ENTER
RETURN
POP-UP/MENU
TOP MENU
321
AUDIO
2 431
6
V-AUX
75
AV
BLUETOOTH
NET
PHONO
USB
TUNER
4321
8765
9 0
4321
SCENE
MUTE
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
MODE
MOVIE MUSIC
INFO SLEEP
ENT
PRESETTUNING
VOLUME
PROGRAM
HDMI OUTPARTY
BAND
SUR. DECODE
STRAIGHT
ENHANCER PURE DIRECT
MEMORY
MAIN
ZONE 2
P
O
P-
U
P
/
MEN
U
TO
P MEN
U
3
2
1
AUDI
O
2
4
3
1
6
V
-
AUX
7
5
AV
BLUET
OO
TH
NET
PH
O
N
O
USB
TUNER
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
9
0
4
3
2
1
SC
EN
E
MUTE
O
PTI
ON
O
N
SC
REE
N
DI
S
PLA
Y
M
O
D
E
M
O
VI
E
MUS
I
C
INF
O
S
LEE
P
ENT
P
RE
S
ET
TU
NIN
G
V
O
L
U
ME
PR
OG
RAM
HDMI
O
U
T
PARTY
BAND
SU
R. DE
CO
D
E
S
TRAI
G
H
T
ENHAN
C
ER P
U
RE DIRE
C
T
M
EMORY
MAIN
ZO
NE
2
ENTER
RETURN
z
Cursor keys
En 149
APPENDIX
Frequently asked questions
The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound
balance...
If you have changed speakers or have a new speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to optimize the
speaker settings again (p.43). If you want to adjust the speaker settings manually, use “Manual
Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.123).
Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the
volume control...
If a small child accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote control, the
volume may suddenly increase. This may also cause injury or damage the unit or speakers. We
recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum volume level for the
unit in advance (p.127). You can also set the maximum volume for Zone2 (p.127).
I am occasionally startled by a sudden loud sound when turning
on the unit...
By default, the volume level when the unit last entered standby mode is automatically applied.
If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the volume to be
applied when the receiver is turned on (p.128). You can also set the initial volume for Zone2
(p.128).
We are bothered by volume differences when switching
between input sources…
You can correct volume differences between input sources by utilizing Input Trim” in the
Option” menu (p.109).
I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at
all...
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.165). After
connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (such as BD/DVD players) to the unit, enable
HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This setup is required
every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. For information on
how HDMI Control works between your TV and playback devices, refer to the instruction
manuals for each device.
I want to turn off the on-screen messages displayed during
operations...
By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as
input selection and volume adjustment). If the short messages bother you when you are
watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.137) in the “Setup” menu to turn off
the short messages.
I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings...
You can protect the settings configured on the unit (such as speaker settings) by utilizing
Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.139).
The unit’s remote control is simultaneously controlling another
Yamaha product as well as the unit...
When using multiple Yamaha products, the remote control may work on another Yamaha
product or another remote control may work on the unit. If this happens, register different
remote control IDs for the devices that you want to control with each remote control (p.144).
I want to enjoy videos/audio played back on the video device
even when the unit is in standby mode...
If you have connected a video device to the unit with HDMI, you can output videos/audio
played back on the video device to the TV even when the unit is in standby mode. To use this
function, set “Standby Through” (p.131) in the “Setup” menu to “On” or “Auto”. You can also
switch the input source using the remote control of the unit when this function is enabled.
En 150
Troubleshooting
Refer to the table below when the unit does not function properly.
If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instructions below do not help, turn off the unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or
service center.
First, check the following:
1
The power cables of the unit, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are connected to AC wall outlets securely.
2
The unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are turned on.
3
The connectors of each cable are securely inserted in to jacks on each device.
Power, system and remote control
Problem Cause Remedy
The power does not turn on.
The protection circuitry has been activated three times consecutively.
When the unit is in this condition, the standby indicator on the unit blinks
if you try to turn on the power.
As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your nearest
Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair.
The power does not turn off.
The internal microcomputer has frozen, due to an external electric shock
(such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power
supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and
reboot the unit. (If the problem persists, disconnect the power cable from the AC wall
outlet and plug it again.)
The power turns off (standby mode) immediately. The unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted.
Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers
(p.25).
The unit enters standby mode automatically.
The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again.
The auto-standby function activated because the unit was not used for
the specified time.
To disable the auto-standby function, set “Auto Power Standby” in the “Setup” menu to
Off” (p.139).
The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.143).
The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short circuit.
Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers
(p.25).
The protection circuitry has been activated because the volume of the
unit is too high.
Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, set it to “Off
(p.140).
The unit is not reacting.
The internal microcomputer is frozen, due to an external electric shock
(such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power
supply voltage.
Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and
reboot the unit. (If the problem persists, disconnect the power cable from the AC wall
outlet and plug it again.)
En 151
Audio
The unit cannot be controlled using the remote
control.
The unit is out of the operating range. Use the remote control within the operating range (p.6).
The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries.
The unit’s remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight or strong
lighting.
Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition the unit.
(China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
The remote control is set to control external devices.
Press RECEIVER to set the remote control to control the unit (the key lights up in orange).
The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not
identical.
Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.144).
The remote control sensor on the main unit is turned off. Set “REMOTE SENSOR” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “ON” (p.143).
Problem Cause Remedy
No sound.
Another input source is selected. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys.
Signals that the unit cannot reproduce are being input.
Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on the unit. To check the audio format
of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.141).
The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The volume cannot be increased.
The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.127).
A device connected to the output jacks of the unit is not turned on. Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of the unit.
No sound is coming from a specific speaker.
The playback source does not contain a signal for the channel. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.141).
The currently selected sound program/decoder does not use the
speaker.
To check it, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.126).
Audio output of the speaker is disabled.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.43) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change the
speaker settings (p.124).
The volume of the speaker is set too low.
Perform “Auto Setup” (p.43) or use “Level” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the speaker
volume (p.128).
The speaker cable connecting the unit and the speaker is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable.
The speaker is malfunctioning.
To check it, replace with another speaker. If the problem persists, the unit may be
malfunctioning.
No sound is coming from the subwoofer.
The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency signals.
To check if the subwoofer is working properly, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu
(p.126).
Subwoofer output is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.43) or set “Subwoofer” in the “Setup” menu to “Use” (p.125).
The volume of the subwoofer is too low. Adjust the volume on the subwoofer.
The subwoofer has been turned off by its auto-standby function. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level.
Problem Cause Remedy
En 152
No sound from the playback device (connected to the
unit with HDMI).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection).
Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications.
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack exceeds the
limit.
Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
No sound from the playback device (when HDMI
Control is used).
The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers.
Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the playback device audio is output
from the speakers connected to the unit.
TV audio is selected as the input source. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys.
No sound from the TV (when HDMI Control is used).
The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers.
Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the TV audio is output from the
speakers connected to the unit.
A TV that does not support ARC is connected to the unit only with an
HDMI cable.
Use a digital optical cable to make an audio connection (p.32).
(If the TV is connected to the unit with an audio cable)
The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection.
Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack (p.130).
(If you are trying to use ARC)
ARC is disabled on the unit or TV.
Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.130). Also, enable ARC on the TV.
Only the front speakers work on multichannel audio. The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (such as PCM) only.
To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.141). If necessary, change
the digital audio output setting on the playback device.
Noise/hum is heard.
The unit is too close to another digital or radio frequency device. Move the unit further away from the device.
The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
The sound is distorted.
The volume of the unit is too high.
Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, set it to “Off
(p.140).
A device connected to the unit’s output jacks is not turned on. Turn on all devices connected to the unit’s output jacks.
The sound is interrupted.
If the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is assigned to Zone2, HDMI audio
output may be interrupted during some zone operations due to internal
circuitry switching.
For details, see “Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio”
(p.96).
Problem Cause Remedy
En 153
Video
Problem Cause Remedy
No video.
Another input source is selected on the unit. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys.
Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit.
The video signal output from the unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MONITOR CHECK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.144).
The cable connecting the unit and TV (or playback device) is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable.
No video from the playback device (connected to the
unit with HDMI).
The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by the unit.
To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video Signal
in the “Information” menu (p.141). For information about video signals supported by the
unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.167).
The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content
Protection).
Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications.
If you want to play back contents that require HDCP 2.2-compatible devices, both the TV
and playback device must support HDCP 2.2.
The playback device that supports HDCP 2.2 is connected to the VIDEO
AUX (HDMI IN) jack.
To play back contents that require HDCP 2.2-compatible devices, connect the playback
device to the HDMI (AV 1–7) jack (p.34).
The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices.
The menu of the unit is not displayed on the TV. Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack).
The video is interrupted.
(If you are using 2 TVs in the main zone)
Another TV is turned off when “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected.
Select “HDMI OUT 1” or “HDMI OUT 2” to output the signals only to the TV you are using
(p.60).
(If the HDMI OUT 2 jack is assigned to Zone2)
HDMI audio output may be interrupted during some zone operations due
to internal circuitry switching.
For details, see “Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio”
(p.96).
En 154
FM/AM radio (AM radio feature is not available for the Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models)
DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)
Problem Cause Remedy
FM radio reception is weak or noisy.
There is multi-path interference. Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Set “FM Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Mono” to select monaural FM radio reception
(p.110).
Use an outdoor FM antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna.
AM radio reception is weak or noisy.
The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats, or
other electrical equipment.
It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor AM
antenna.
Radio stations cannot be selected automatically.
Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter.
Select the station manually (p.69).
Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna.
The AM radio signal is weak.
Adjust the AM antenna orientation.
Select the station manually (p.69).
Use an outdoor AM antenna. Connect it to the ANTENNA (AM) jack together with the
supplied AM antenna.
AM radio stations cannot be registered as presets. Auto Preset has been used.
Auto Preset is for registering FM radio stations only. Register AM radio stations manually
(p.70).
Problem Cause Remedy
No DAB radio reception. An initial scan has not been performed. Perform an initial scan to receive DAB radio (p.72).
No DAB radio reception even after performing an
initial scan.
Reception strength of DAB radio is poor.
Check reception strength in “Tune AID” in the “Option” menu (p.74), and adjust the
antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location.
There is no DAB coverage in your area.
Check with your dealer or WorldDMB online at “http://www.worlddab.org” for a listing of
the DAB coverage in your area.
DAB radio reception is weak or noisy.
There is multi-path interference.
Check reception strength in “Tune AID” in the “Option” menu (p.74), and adjust the
antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location.
Your area is too far from the DAB station transmitter. Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna.
DAB information is not available or is inaccurate.
The selected DAB radio station may be temporarily out of service or may
not provide information.
Contact the DAB broadcaster.
No DAB radio sound. The selected DAB radio station may be temporarily out of service. Try the station later or select another station.
En 155
Bluetooth
Problem Cause Remedy
A Bluetooth connection cannot be established.
The Bluetooth function of the unit is disabled. Enable the Bluetooth function (p.133).
Another Bluetooth device is already connected to the unit. Terminate the current Bluetooth connection and then establish a new connection (p.80).
The unit and the Bluetooth device are too far apart. Move the Bluetooth device closer to the unit.
There is a device (such as microwave oven and wireless LAN) that
outputs signals in the 2.4 GHz frequency band nearby.
Move the unit away from those devices.
The Bluetooth device does not support A2DP. Use a Bluetooth device that supports A2DP.
The connection information registered on the Bluetooth device is not
working for some reason.
Delete the connection information on the Bluetooth device, and then establish a
connection between the Bluetooth device and the unit again (p.80).
No sound is produced, or the sound is interrupted
during playback.
The volume of the Bluetooth device is set too low. Turn up the volume of the Bluetooth device.
The Bluetooth device is not set to send audio signals to the unit. Switch the audio output of the Bluetooth device to the unit.
The Bluetooth connection has been terminated.
Establish a Bluetooth connection between the Bluetooth device and the unit again
(p.80).
The unit and the Bluetooth device are too far apart. Move the Bluetooth device closer to the unit.
There is a device (such as microwave oven and wireless LAN) that
outputs signals in the 2.4 GHz frequency band nearby.
Move the unit away from those devices.
En 156
USB and network
Problem Cause Remedy
The unit does not detect the USB device.
The USB device is not connected to the USB jack securely. Turn off the unit, reconnect your USB device, and turn the unit on again.
The file system of the USB device is not FAT16 or FAT32. Use a USB device with FAT16 or FAT32 format.
Folders and files in the USB device cannot be viewed. The data in the USB device is protected by the encryption. Use a USB device without an encryption function.
The files in the USB device cannot be played back
continuously.
Files not supported by the unit exist in the selected folder.
If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during
playback, playback stops automatically. Do not store the unsupported files in the
playback folder.
The network feature does not function. The network parameters (IP address) have not been obtained properly.
Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup” menu to
On” on the unit (p.131). If you want to configure the network parameters manually,
check that you are using an IP address which is not used by other network devices in your
network (p.131).
The unit cannot connect to the Internet via a wireless
router (access point).
The wireless router (access point) is turned off. Turn on the wireless router.
The unit and the wireless router (access point) are too far apart. Place the unit and the wireless router (access point) closer to each other.
There is an obstacle between the unit and the wireless router (access
point).
Move the unit and the wireless router (access point) in a location where there are no
obstacles between them.
Wireless network is not found.
Microwave ovens or other wireless devices in your neighborhood might
disturb the wireless communication.
Turn off these devices.
Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of the wireless
router (access point).
Check the firewall setting of the wireless router (access point).
The unit does not detect the PC.
The media sharing setting is not correct.
Configure the sharing setting and select the unit as a device to which music contents are
shared (p.85).
Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access of the
unit to your PC.
Check the settings of security software installed on your PC.
The unit and PC are not in the same network.
Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the unit and
the PC to the same network.
The MAC address filter is enabled on the unit.
In “MAC Address Filter” in the “Setup” menu, disable the MAC address filter or specify the
MAC address of your PC to allow it to access to the unit (p.132).
The files in the PC cannot be viewed or played back. The files are not supported by the unit or the media server.
Use the file format supported by both the unit and the media server. For information
about the file formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media
servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.85).
The files in the PC cannot be played back
continuously.
Files not supported by the unit exist in the selected folder.
If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during
playback, playback stops automatically. Do not store the unsupported files in the
playback folder.
En 157
The Internet radio cannot be played.
The selected Internet radio station is currently not available.
There may be a network problem at the radio station, or the service may have been
stopped. Try the station later or select another station.
The selected Internet radio station is currently broadcasting silence.
Some Internet radio stations broadcast silence at certain of times of the day. Try the
station later or select another station.
Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your
network devices (such as the router).
Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be played
only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station. The port number
varies depending on the radio station.
The iPod does not recognize the unit when using
AirPlay.
The unit is connected to a multiple SSID router.
Access to the unit might be restricted by the network separation function on the router.
Connect the iPod to the SSID which can access the unit.
The application for smartphone/tablet “AV
CONTROLLER” does not detect the unit.
The unit and smartphone/tablet are not in the same network.
Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the unit and
smartphone/tablet to the same network.
The MAC address filter is enabled on the unit.
In “MAC Address Filter” in the “Setup” menu, disable the MAC address filter or specify the
MAC address of your smartphone/tablet to allow it to access to the unit (p.132).
No sound from the MusicCast compatible device.
The MusicCast compatible device is turned off. Turn on the MusicCast compatible device.
The MusicCast compatible device is not connected to the MusicCast
network.
Connect the device with “MusicCast CONTROLLER”.
The MusicCast connection cannot be made on
MusicCast CONTROLLER”.
The mobile device which “MusicCast CONTROLLER” is installed is not
connected to the wireless network at your home.
Connect the mobile device to the wireless router and start “MusicCast CONTROLLER”.
Disable the cellular data transmission.
The MusicCast compatible device is turned off. Turn on the MusicCast compatible device.
MusicCast CONTROLLER” does not detect a
MusicCast compatible device.
The mobile device which “MusicCast CONTROLLER” is installed is not
connected to the wireless network at your home.
Connect the mobile device to the wireless router and set the MusicCast compatible
device with MusicCast CONTROLLER”.
The MusicCast compatible device is turned off.
Turn on the MusicCast compatible device.
Enable the network standby function on the MusicCast compatible device.
Firmware update via the network is failed. It may not be possible depending on the condition of the network. Update the firmware via the network again or use a USB memory device (p.146).
Problem Cause Remedy
En 158
Error indications on the front display
Message Cause Remedy
Access denied Access to the PC is denied. Configure the sharing settings and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.85).
Access error
The unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
There is a problem with the signal path from the network to the unit.
Make sure your router and modem are turned on.
Check the connection between the unit and your router (or hub) (p.39).
Check SP Wires The speaker cables short circuit. Twist the bare wires of the cables firmly and connect to the unit and speakers properly.
Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center.
No content There are no playable files in the selected folder. Select a folder that contains files supported by the unit.
No device The unit cannot detect the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
Please wait The unit is preparing for connecting to the network.
Wait until the message disappears. If the message stays more than 3 minutes, turn off the unit and turn it on
again.
RemID Mismatch
The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not
identical.
Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.144).
Remote Off
The unit cannot be operated from remote control because the remote
control sensor on the main unit is turned off.
Use the controls on the front panel. To use the remote control, set “REMOTE SENSOR” in the “ADVANCED SETUP
menu to “ON” (p.143).
Unable to play
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the USB device for some
reasons.
Check the song data. If it cannot be played on another device, the song data may be defective.
The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some reason.
Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by the unit. For information about the formats
supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.85). If the unit supports
the file format, but still cannot play back any files, the network may be overloaded with heavy traffic.
Update failed. Firmware update is failed. Update the firmware again.
USB Overloaded An overcurrent is flowing through the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device.
Version error Firmware update is failed. Update the firmware again.
En 159
Glossary
This section explains the technical terms used in this manual.
Audio information (audio decoding format)
Dolby Atmos
Introduced first in the cinema, Dolby Atmos brings a revolutionary sense of dimension and immersion to the Home
Theater experience. Dolby Atmos is an adaptable and scalable object based format that reproduces audio as
independent sounds (or objects) that can be accurately positioned and move dynamically throughout the 3
dimensional listening space during playback. A key ingredient of Dolby Atmos is the introduction of a height plane of
sound above the listener.
Dolby Atmos Stream
Dolby Atmos content will be delivered to your Dolby Atmos enabled AV receiver via Dolby Digital Plus or Dolby
TrueHD on Blu-ray Disc, downloadable files and streaming media. A Dolby Atmos stream contains special metadata
that describes the positioning of sounds within the room. This object audio data is decoded by a Dolby Atmos AV
receiver and scaled for optimum playback through Home Theater speaker systems of every size and configuration.
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel
audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports
7.1-channel audio. Dolby Digital Plus remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that
support Dolby Digital. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
Dolby Enabled Speaker
A convenient alternative to speakers built into the ceiling, products utilizing Dolby speaker technology employ the
ceiling above you as a reflective surface for reproducing audio in the height plane above the listener. Dolby enabled
speakers feature a unique upward firing driver and special signal processing that can be built into a conventional
speaker, or a standalone speaker module, minimally impacting the overall speaker system footprint while providing
an immersive listening experience during Dolby Atmos and Dolby surround playback.
Dolby Surround
Dolby surround is a next generation surround technology that intelligently up mixes stereo; 5.1 and 7.1 content for
playback through your surround speaker system. Dolby surround is compatible with traditional speaker layouts, as
well as Dolby Atmos enabled playback systems that employ in-ceiling speakers or products with Dolby speaker
technology.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. to offer a high-definition
home theater experience with the quality of the studio master. Dolby TrueHD can carry up to eight channels of 96
kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on BD
(Blu-ray discs).
DSD (Direct Stream Digital)
DSD (Direct Stream Digital) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as SACD (Super Audio
CDs). The signals are stored at a high-frequency sampling rate (such as 2.8224 MHz and 5.6448 MHz). The highest
frequency response is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This technology offers better
audio quality than that used for CDs.
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. This format
remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This
technology is used for music DVDs, etc.
DTS Dialog Control
DTS Dialog Control allows you to boost the dialog. This can be useful in noisy environments to help make the dialog
more intelligible. People with impaired hearing may also benefit. Note that the content creator may disable the use
of this feature in the mix, so that DTS Dialog Control may not always be available. Note that updates to your AVR may
add more functionality to DTS Dialog Control or increase the range of the feature.
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel audio.
This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs.
DTS-ES
DTS-ES creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with DTS-ES. This decoder adds
a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. In the DTS-ES Matrix 6.1 format, a surround back sound is
recorded in the surround channels, and in the DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 format, a discrete surround back channel is
recorded.
DTS Express
DTS Express is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel audio and allows a higher compression
rate than the DTS Digital Surround format developed by DTS, Inc. This technology is developed for audio streaming
services on the Internet and secondary audio on BD (Blu-ray discs).
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports
7.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio remains fully compatible with the existing
multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray
discs).
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio format developed to offer a high-definition home theater
experience with the quality of the studio master by DTS, Inc. DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to eight channels of
96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on
BD (Blu-ray discs).
En 160
DTS Neo:6
DTS Neo:6 enables 6-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are two modes available: “Music mode” for
music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. This technology provides discrete full-bandwidth matrix
channels of surround sound.
DTS:X
DTS:X is the next generation object-based, multi-dimensional audio technology from DTS. Unbound from channels,
DTS:X conveys the fluid movement of sound to create an incredibly rich, realistic and immersive soundscape - in
front of, behind, beside and above the audience - more accurately than ever before. DTS:X offers the ability to
automatically adapt the audio to the speaker layout that best fits the space, from a television’s built-in speakers to
a home surround theater system to a dozen or more speakers in a commercial cinema. Immerse yourself at
www.dts.com/dtsx
FLAC
FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compressed audio formats in
compression rate but provides higher audio quality.
MP3
One of the compressed digital audio format used by MPEG. With psychoacoustic technologies, this compression
method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data quantity by about 1/10
maintaining a certain level of audio quality.
MPEG-4 AAC
An MPEG-4 audio standard. It is used for mobile telephones, portable audio players, and audio streaming services on
Internet because it allows a high compression rate of data while maintaining better audio quality than MP3.
Neural:X
Neural:X is the latest downmixing/upmixing and spatial remapping technology from DTS. It is built in to DTS:X to
provide upmix of Neural:X-encoded and non-encoded (PCM) data. In DTS:X for AVRs and Sound Bars, Neural:X can
produce up to 11.x channels.
PCM (Pulse Code Modulation)
PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded, and transmitted. This technology is
the basis of all other audio format. This technology is used as a lossless audio format called Linear PCM for audio on
a variety of media, including CDs and BD (Blu-ray discs).
Sampling frequency/Quantization bit
Sampling frequency and quantization bits indicate the quantity of information when an analog audio signal is
digitized. These values are noted as in the following example: “48 kHz/24-bit”.
Sampling frequency
Sampling frequency (the number of times the signal is sampled per second) is called the sampling rate. When the
sampling frequency is higher, the range of frequencies that can be played back are wider.
Quantization bit
The number of quantization bits indicate the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric
value. When the number of quantized bits is higher, the expression of the sound level is more accurate.
WAV
Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by converting
audio signals. By default, the PCM method (no compression) is used, but you can also use other compression
methods.
WMA (Windows Media Audio)
One of the compressed digital audio formats developed by Microsoft Corporation. With psychoacoustic
technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing
data quantity by about 1/20 maintaining a certain level of audio quality.
En 161
Audio Information (Others)
Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp)
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. When you use the bi-amplification connection, the
unit drives the tweeter and woofer in a speaker with the discrete amplifiers. As a consequence, the tweeter and
woofer provide clear audio signal without the interference.
LFE (Low Frequency Effects) 0.1 channel
This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is
added to the channels for all bands with Dolby Digital or DTS to enhance low frequency audio effects. This channel
is labeled 0.1 because it is limited to only low frequency audio.
Lip sync
Video output sometimes lags behind audio output due to the complexity of signal processing caused by an increase
in video signal capacity. Lip sync is a technique for automatically correcting the timing lag between audio and video
output.
HDMI and video information
Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and the Pb and
Pr signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals
is independent.
Composite video signal
With the composite video signal system, color, brightness, and synchronization data signals are combined and
transmitted with a single cable.
Deep Color
Deep Color is a technology that HDMI specification supports. Deep Color increases the number of available colors
within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. Conventional color systems process the color using
8 bits. Deep Color processes the color with 10, 12, or 16 bits. This technology allows HDTVs and other displays to
increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal
transitions and subtle gradations between colors.
HDCP
HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) is a digital copy protection form that prevents copying of digital
contents as it travels across connections (such as HDMI).
HDMI
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the world-wide standard interface for digital audio/video signal
transmission. This interface transmits both digital audio and digital video signals using a single cable without any
loss. HDMI complies with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) and provides a secure audio/video
interface. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://www.hdmi.org/”.
x.v.Color
x.v.Color” is a technology that the HDMI specification supports. It is a more extensive color space than sRGB and
allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color gamut of
sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and thus can produce more vivid, natural images.
En 162
Network information
SSID
SSID (Service Set Identifier) is a name that identifies a particular wireless LAN access point.
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi (Wireless Fidelity) is a technology that allows an electronic device to exchange data or connect to the Internet
wirelessly using radio waves. Wi-Fi offers the advantage of eliminating the complexity of making connections with
network cables by using wireless connection. Only products that complete Wi-Fi Alliance interoperability tests can
carry the “Wi-Fi Certified” trademark.
WPS
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) is a standard established by the Wi-Fi Alliance, which allows easy establishment of a
wireless home network.
Yamaha technologies
CINEMA DSP (Digital Sound Field Processor)
Since the surround sound systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best experienced
in a theater that has many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions (such as room size, wall
material, and number of speakers) can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that you
hear. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, CINEMA DSP, Yamaha’s original DSP technology provides the
audiovisual experience of a movie theater in your own home.
CINEMA DSP HD
3
The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP HD
3
feature achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and
intensive stereoscopic sound fields in a listening room.
Compressed Music Enhancer
The Compressed Music Enhancer feature compensates for missing harmonics in compression music formats (such
as MP3). As a result, this technology provides improved performance for the overall sound system.
SILENT CINEMA
Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones
have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be enjoyed
on headphones.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
Virtual CINEMA DSP allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with front left
and right speakers. Even if the surround speakers are not connected, the unit creates the realistic sound field in a
listening room.
Virtual CINEMA FRONT
Virtual CINEMA FRONT allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with front
surround speakers. Even if the surround speakers placed in the front, the unit creates the realistic sound field in a
listening room.
Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS)
Virtual Presence Speaker allows the system to virtually reproduce the height of the 3D sound field without presence
speakers. Even if the presence speakers are not connected, the unit creates the 3D sound field in your room.
Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS)
Virtual Surround Back Speaker allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround back
speakers. Even if the surround back speakers are not connected, the unit adds a sense of depth to the rear sound filed
of CINEMA DSP.
En 163
Supported devices and file formats
This section explains the devices and file formats supported by the unit.
Supported devices
For information about specifications of each device, refer to the instruction manual of it.
Bluetooth device
The unit supports Bluetooth devices that support A2DP or AVRCP.
A Bluetooth device may not be detected by the unit or some feature may not be compatible,
depending on the model.
USB devices
The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (e.g., flash memories or portable audio
players) using FAT16 or FAT32 format.
Do not connect devices other than USB mass storage class devices (such as USB chargers or
USB hubs), PCs, card readers, an external HDD, etc.
USB devices with encryption cannot be used.
Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or manufacturer of the USB
storage device.
AirPlay
AirPlay works with iPhone, iPad, and iPod touch with iOS 4.3.3 or later, Mac with OS X Mountain
Lion or later, and PC with iTunes 10.2.2 or later.
Made for.
iPhone 7 Plus, iPhone 7, iPhone SE, iPhone 6s Plus, iPhone 6s, iPhone 6 Plus, iPhone 6, iPhone
5s, iPhone 5c, iPhone 5, iPhone 4s
iPad Pro (9.7″ and 12.9″), iPad mini 4, iPad Air 2, iPad mini 3, iPad Air, iPad mini 2, iPad mini,
iPad (3rd and 4th generation), iPad 2
iPod touch (5th and 6th generation)
(as of March 2017)
File formats
For information about specifications of each file, refer to the instruction manual of your
recording device or consult file's help.
USB/PC (NAS)
* Linear PCM format only
Y
To play back FLAC files stored on a PC or NAS, you need to install server software that supports sharing of FLAC
files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files.
Digital Rights Management (DRM) contents cannot be played back.
File
Sampling frequency
(kHz)
Quantization
bitrate (bit)
Bitrate
The number
of channels
Gapless
playback
WAV *
32/44.1/48/88.2/96/
176.4/192
16/24 - 2 ,
MP3 32/44.1/48 - 8 to 320 2 -
WMA 32/44.1/48 - 8 to 320 2 -
MPEG-4 AAC 32/44.1/48 - 8 to 320 2 -
FLAC
32/44.1/48/88.2/96/
176.4/192
16/24 - 2 ,
ALAC 32/44.1/48/88.2/96 16/24 - 2 ,
AIFF
32/44.1/48/88.2/96/
176.4/192
16/24 - 2 ,
DSD 2.8 MHz/5.6 MHz 1 - 2 -
En 164
Video signal flow
Video signals input from a video device to the unit are output
to a TV as shown below.
HDMI HDMI HDMIHDMI
VIDEOVIDEO
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
PR
PB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO
Video device The unit TV
HDMI outHDMI in
COMPONENT
VIDEO in
VIDEO in
Video conversion table
X
You can select the resolution and the aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing in “Video Mode” (p.129) in the “Setup” menu.
The unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably.
m: Available
HDMI out
Resolution 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i 1080p 4K
HDMI in
480i/576i mmmmmm
480p/576p mmmmm
720p mmmm
1080i mmmm
1080p/50, 60 Hz mmmm
1080p/24 Hz mm
4K m
COMPONENT VIDEO in
480i/576i mmmmmm
480p/576p mmmmm
720p mmmm
1080i mmmm
VIDEO in 480i/576i mmmmmm
En 165
Multi-zone output
Audio signals that can be output to Zone2 vary depending on how you connect the device in
Zone 2 to the unit's output jacks.
m: Available
*1 Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2” (Audio
Output: On)
*2 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input (stereo output [down mixed to 2-channels]
when the input source selected in the main zone is selected)
Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2
*3 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input (stereo output [down mixed to 2-channels]
when the input source selected in the main zone is selected)
*4 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input
*5 To play back DSD audio in Zone2, select “Main Zone Sync” as the Zone2 input with the web
control (p.101) or use the party mode (p.99).
Information on HDMI
This section explains the functions related to HDMI and its signal compatibility.
HDMI Control
HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that
supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit (such as power
and volume) with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback devices (such
as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players) connected to the unit with an HDMI cable.
For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV and playback devices” (p.32) and
“Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players)” (p.34).
Operations available from the TV’s remote control
Standby synchronization
Volume control including mute
Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner
Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device
Switching between audio output devices (the unit or TV speaker)
(Example)
Operations available from the unit’s remote control
Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV with a scene selection (p.61)
Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed)
Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) using the external device
operation keys
Using the unit’s
internal amplifier
(p.30)
Using an external amplifier (p.95)
In \ Zone2 Out EXTRA SP jacks ZONE OUT jacks
HDMI OUT 2
(ZONE OUT) jack (*1)
Digital audio (HDMI) m (*2) m (*2) m (*3)
Digital audio
(COAXIAL/OPTICAL)
m(*4) m (*4)
Analog audio (AUDIO) mm
USB (*5) mm
Network sources (*5) mm
TUNER mm
HDMI Control
Turn off the TV
The unit turns off
(standby)
HDMI Control
Playback device
also turns off
En 166
(Example)
To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after
connecting the TV and playback devices.
For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV.
Y
This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system.
1
Turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices.
2
Configure the settings of the unit.
1
Switch the TV input to display video from the unit.
2
Press ON SCREEN.
3
Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER.
4
Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”.
5
Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER.
6
Use the cursor keys to select “On”.
7
Press ON SCREEN.
3
Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as HDMI
Control-compatible BD/DVD players).
4
Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off the unit and playback
devices.
5
Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV.
6
Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit.
7
Check the followings.
On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select
the input source manually.
On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed.
8
Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV
or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control.
HDMI Control
Press SCENE 1
Turns on and displays
video from the playback
device
HDMI Control
Playback starts
ENTER
RETURN
OPTION
ON
SCREEN
DISPLAY
RETURN
O
PTI
ON
DI
S
PLA
Y
ON SCREEN
Cursor keys
ENTER
En 167
Y
If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in Step 3 and plugging in the TV again in Step 4.
It may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices exceeds the
limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use.
If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on
the TV.
We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works more
effectively.
We do not assure the operation of all HDMI Control-compatible devices.
Audio Return Channel (ARC)
ARC allows you to input TV audio to the unit with the HDMI cable which transmits video signal
to the TV.
Check the following after the HDMI Control settings.
1
Select a TV program with the TV remote control.
2
Check that the input source of the unit will be automatically switched to
“AUDIO 1” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit.
If you cannot hear the TV audio, check the following:
“ARC” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”.
The HDMI cable is connected to the ARC-compatible HDMI jack (HDMI jack marked
“ARC”) on the TV.
Some HDMI jack on the TV is not compatible with ARC. For details, refer to the instruction
manual for the TV.
Y
If the audio is interrupted while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to “Off” and use an
audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable) to input TV audio to the unit (p.33).
When using ARC, connect a TV with an HDMI cable that supports ARC.
X
AUDIO 1” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO
1 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use
the SCENE function (p.62), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE 2.
HDMI signal compatibility
When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be
output, depending on the type of the DVD player.
The unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to
the instruction manual for each device.
To decode audio bitstream signals on the unit, set the input source device appropriately so
that the device outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream
signals on the playback device). For details, refer to the instruction manual for the playback
device.
En 168
Trademarks
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Dolby Atmos,
Dolby Surround, and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories.
For DTS patents, see http://patents.dts.com. Manufactured under license
from DTS, Inc. DTS, the Symbol, DTS in combination with the Symbol,
DTS:X, and the DTS:X logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of DTS,
Inc. in the United States and/or other countries. © DTS, Inc. All Rights
Reserved.
Supports iOS 7 or later for setup using Wireless Accessory Configuration.
“Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an
electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod,
iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to
meet Apple performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance
with safety and regulatory standards.
Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod, iPhone, or iPad may
affect wireless performance.
iTunes, AirPlay, iPad, iPhone, iPod, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple
Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
iPad Air and iPad mini are trademarks of Apple Inc.
App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc.
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by Yamaha Corporation is
under license.
Bluetooth protocol stack (Blue SDK)
Copyright 1999-2014 OpenSynergy GmbH
All rights reserved. All unpublished rights reserved.
(Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models)
The unit supports DAB/DAB+ tuning.
The terms HDMI, the HDMI Logo, and High-Definition Multimedia Interface
are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the
United States and other countries.
x.v.Color™
x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation.
DLNA™ and DLNA CERTIFIED™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Digital Living Network Alliance. All rights reserved. Unauthorized use is
strictly prohibited.
Windows™
Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United
States and other countries.
Internet Explorer, Windows Media Audio and Windows Media Player are
either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and/or other countries.
Android™ Google Play™
Android and Google Play are trademarks of Google Inc.
Blu-ray is a trademark of the Blu-ray Disc Association.
The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ Logo is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance®.
The Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ Identifier Mark is a certification mark of Wi-Fi
Alliance®.
MusicCast is a trademark or registered trademark of Yamaha Corporation.
Yamaha Eco-Label is a mark that certifies products of high environmental
performance.
SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation.
Google Noto Fonts (Version 1.001)
Copyright © 2012 Google Inc. All rights reserved.
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the “License”);
you may not use this file except in compliance with the License.
You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software
distributed under the License is distributed on an “AS IS” BASIS, WITHOUT
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied.
See the License for the specific language governing permissions and
limitations under the License.
Explanations regarding GPL
This product utilizes GPL/LGPL open-source software in some
sections. You have the right to obtain, duplicate, modify, and
redistribute this open-source code only. For information on
GPL/LGPL open source software, how to obtain it, and the
GPL/LGPL license, refer to the Yamaha Corporation website
(http://download.yamaha.com/sourcecodes/musiccast/).
En 169
Specifications
Input jacks
Analog Audio
Audio x 9 (AV 1-4, AUDIO 1-3, PHONO, VIDEO AUX)
Digital Audio
Optical x 3 (AV 3, AUDIO 1–2)
(Supported sampling frequencies: 32 kHz to 96 kHz)
Coaxial x 3 (AV 1-2, AUDIO 3)
(Supported sampling frequencies: 32 kHz to 192 kHz)
Video
Composite x 4 (AV 1-4)
Component x 2 (AV 1-2)
HDMI Input
HDMI x 8 (AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX)
•Others
USB x 1 (USB2.0)
NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX/10Base-T)
Output jacks
Analog Audio
Speaker Out x 9 (7 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R,
SURROUND BACK L/R, EXTRA SP 1 L/R *1, EXTRA SP 2 L/R *2)
*1 Note: Assignment is possible
[F.PRESENCE, ZONE2, BI-AMP]
*2 Note: Assignment is possible
[SURROUND BACK, ZONE2]
–Pre Out x 7
(FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R)
Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1-2, mono)
ZONE OUT x 1 (ZONE 2)
–Headphone x 1
•HDMI Output
HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1-2*)
* barter to ZONE OUT (ZONE2)
Other jacks
YPAO MIC x 1
REMOTE IN x 1
REMOTE OUT x 1
TRIGGER OUT x 2
RS-232C x 1
HDMI
•HDMI Features
4K UltraHD Video (include 4K/60,50Hz 10/12bit)
–3D Video
ARC (Audio Return Channel)
–HDMI Control (CEC)
–Auto Lip Sync
21:9 Aspect Ratio
Deep Color
x.v.Color
BT.2020 Colorimetry
HDR (High Dynamic Range)
HD audio playback
Selectable HDMI input in HDMI standby mode
–HDMI Zone Output
Video Format (Repeater Mode)
–VGA
480i/60 Hz
576i/50 Hz
480p/60 Hz
576p/50 Hz
720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz
1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz
1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz
4K/60 Hz, 50Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz
Supported Audio Formats
Dolby Atmos
DTS:X
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution
DTS Express
–DTS
DSD 2.8 MHz 2-ch to 6-ch
PCM 2-ch to 8-ch (Max. 192 kHz/24 bit)
Content Protection: HDCP compatible
(HDMI [AV 1–7]: HDCP 2.2 compatible)
TUNER
Analog Tuner
[Australia model]
DAB/FM x 1 (TUNER)
[U.K., Europe and Russia models]
DAB/FM with Radio Data System x 1 (TUNER)
[Other models]
FM/AM x 1 (TUNER)
USB
Capable of Mass Storage Class USB Memory
Current Supply Capacity: 1 A
En 170
Bluetooth
•Sink Function
Source Device to AVR (ex. Smartphone/Tablet)
Source Function
AVR to Sink Device (ex. Bluetooth Headphone)
Source Device to AVR (ex. Smartphone/Tablet)
Capable of Play/Stop Operation from Sink Device
Bluetooth Version........................................................... Ver. 2.1+EDR
Supported Profile
Sink Function .................................................................A2DP, AVRCP
Source Function .............................................................A2DP, AVRCP
Supported Codec
Sink Function ....................................................................... SBC, AAC
Source Function ............................................................................SBC
Wireless Output ...................................................... Bluetooth Class 2
Radio Frequency (Operational Frequency)... 2402 MHz to 2480 MHz
Maximum Output Power (E.I.R.P) .......................... 4.0 dBm (2.5 mW)
Maximum Communication Distance ................................10 m (33 ft)
MusicCast
Controlled by MusicCast Application (iOS, Android)
MusicCast Link Client ..................................................... Main, Zone2
MusicCast Link Master (Input Source) .................................................
NET/USB/Bluetooth, Analog External Input, Digital External Input,
Zone2
Network Connectivity ....................................Extend Mode, Connect
Network
PC Client Function
Compatible with DLNA ver. 1.5
AirPlay supported
Internet Radio
Wi-Fi function
Capable of WPS by PIN Method and Push-Button-Method
Capable of sharing with iOS devices by wireless connection and
USB connection
Capable of Direct Connection with Mobile Device
Available Security Method: WEP, WPA2-PSK (AES), Mixed Mode
Radio Frequency Band: 2.4 GHz
Wireless LAN Standards: IEEE 802.11 b/g/n
Radio Frequency (Operational Frequency): 2412 MHz to 2472 MHz
Maximum Output Power (E.I.R.P): 17.5 dBm (56.2 mW)
Compatible Decoding Formats
Decoding Format
Dolby Atmos
Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital
DTS:X
DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio,
DTS Express
DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1
DTS Digital Surround
•Post Decoding Format
Dolby Surround
–Neural:X
DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema
Audio Section
Rated Output Power (2-channel driven)
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 6 Ω)
Front L/R ..................................................................... 120 W+120 W
Center...................................................................................... 120 W
Surround L/R............................................................... 120 W+120 W
Surround Back L/R...................................................... 120 W+120 W
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R ..................................................................... 110 W+110 W
Center...................................................................................... 110 W
Surround L/R............................................................... 110 W+110 W
Surround Back L/R...................................................... 110 W+110 W
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R ..................................................................... 120 W+120 W
Center...................................................................................... 120 W
Surround L/R............................................................... 120 W+120 W
Surround Back L/R...................................................... 120 W+120 W
Rated Output Power (1-channel driven)
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 6 Ω)
Front L/R ............................................................................140 W/ch
Center.................................................................................140 W/ch
Surround L/R......................................................................140 W/ch
Surround Back L/R.............................................................140 W/ch
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R............................................................................ 135 W/ch
Center ............................................................................... 135 W/ch
Surround L/R ..................................................................... 135 W/ch
Surround Back L/R ............................................................ 135 W/ch
(1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 Ω)
Front L/R [U.K., Europe and Russia models].................... 170 W/ch
Maximum Effective Output Power (1-channel driven)
(1 kHz, 10% THD, 6 Ω)
Front L/R............................................................................ 170 W/ch
Center ................................................................................ 170 W/ch
Surround L/R ..................................................................... 170 W/ch
Surround Back L/R ............................................................ 170 W/ch
(1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 Ω)
Front L/R............................................................................ 165 W/ch
Center ................................................................................ 165 W/ch
Surround L/R ..................................................................... 165 W/ch
Surround Back L/R ............................................................ 165 W/ch
•Dynamic Power (IHF)
Front L/R (8/6/4/2 Ω) ............................................135/165/210/280 W
•Damping Factor
Front L/R, 1 kHz, 8 Ω.........................................................150 or more
Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance
PHONO (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω).............................................3.5 mV/47 kΩ
AUDIO 2 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω)....................................200 mV/47 kΩ
Maximum Input Signal
PHONO (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) .......................................... 45 mV or more
AUDIO 2 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) .....................................2.4 V or more
Rated Output Level / Output Impedance
PRE OUT
SUBWOOFER (50 Hz) ...................................................... 1.0 V/470 Ω
Except SUBWOOFER (1 kHz)..........................................1.0 V/470 Ω
ZONE OUT..........................................................................1.0 V/470 Ω
Maximum Output Level
PRE OUT/ZONE OUT ......................................................2.0 V or more
Headphone Impedance ................................................. 16 Ω or more
Frequency Response
AUDIO 2 etc. (10 Hz to 100 kHz) .............................................+0/-3 dB
En 171
•RIAA Equalization Deviation
PHONO (20 Hz to 20 kHz) ...................................................... 0±0.5 dB
Total Harmonic Distortion
PHONO to PreOut (1 kHz, 1 V) ........................................0.04% or less
AUDIO 2 etc. to Speaker Out (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 55 W/ 8 Ω)
.........................................................................................0.04% or less
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
(Pure Direct, Input 1 kΩ Shorted, Speaker Out)
PHONO .......................................................................... 95 dB or more
AUDIO 2 etc ................................................................. 110 dB or more
Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Speaker Out ...................................................................150 μV or less
•Channel Separation
(Input 1 kΩ Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz)
PHONO ............................................................... 75 dB/60 dB or more
AUDIO 2 etc ........................................................ 75 dB/60 dB or more
•Volume Control
Main Zone .............................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB (0.5 dB Step)
Zone2 ....................................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB (0.5 dB Step)
Tone Control Characteristics
Main Zone
Bass Boost/Cut .................................... ±6.0 dB/50 Hz (0.5 dB Step)
Bass Turnover........................................................................ 350 Hz
Treble Boost/Cut ............................... ±6.0 dB/20 kHz (0.5 dB Step)
Treble Turnover.................................................................... 3.5 kHz
Zone2
Bass Boost/Cut .................................... ±6.0 dB/50 Hz (0.5 dB Step)
Bass Turnover........................................................................ 350 Hz
Treble Boost/Cut ............................... ±6.0 dB/20 kHz (0.5 dB Step)
Treble Turnover.................................................................... 3.5 kHz
Filter Characteristics
(fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)
H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back: Small)
............................................................................................. 12 dB/oct.
L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .............................................................. 24 dB/oct.
Video Section
Video Signal Type .................................................. NTSC/PAL/SECAM
Video Signal Level
Composite .........................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω
Component
Y ......................................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω
Pb/Pr ...........................................................................0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω
Video Maximum Input Level.................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more
FM Section
Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models]...........................87.5 MHz to 107.9 MHz
[Brazil, Asia and General models]
.................................................. 87.5/87.50 MHz to 108.0/108.00 MHz
[U.K., Europe and Russia models]..............87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz
[Other models]............................................87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz
50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.)
Mono............................................................................. 3 μV (20.8 dBf)
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
Mono/Stereo ....................................................................69 dB/68 dB
•Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz)
Mono/Stereo ...................................................................... 0.5%/0.6%
Antenna Input ..........................................................75 Ω unbalanced
AM section (except Australia, U.K., Europe
and Russia models)
Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models]...............................530 kHz to 1710 kHz
[Brazil, Asia and General models] ..... 530/531 kHz to 1710/1611 kHz
[Other models]....................................................531 kHz to 1611 kHz
DAB section (Australia, U.K., Europe and
Russia models only)
Tuning Range ......................................174 MHz to 240 MHz (Band III)
Support Audio Format............... MPEG 1 Layer II/MPEG-4 HE-AAC v2
Antenna ....................................................................75 Ω unbalanced
General
•Power Supply
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .......................................AC 120 V, 60 Hz
[Brazil and General models] ....AC 110 to 120/220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz
[China model]..............................................................AC 220 V, 50 Hz
[Korea model]..............................................................AC 220 V, 60 Hz
[Australia model].........................................................AC 240 V, 50 Hz
[U.K., Europe and Russia models] ..............................AC 230 V, 50 Hz
[Asia model]................................................ AC 220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz
Power Consumption
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ......................................................450 W
[Other models] ...........................................................................420 W
Standby Power Consumption
HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off, Network Standby Off
......................................................................................................0.1 W
HDMI Control On, Standby Through On (No Signals),
Network Standby Off...................................................................1.5 W
HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off, Network Standby On,
Bluetooth Standby Off
Wired.........................................................................................1.8 W
Wireless (Wi-Fi).........................................................................1.8 W
Wireless Direct..........................................................................1.9 W
HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off,
Network Standby On (Wired), Bluetooth Standby On...............1.7 W
HDMI Control On, Standby Through On, Network Standby On
(Wireless Direct), Bluetooth Standby On ...................................2.7 W
Maximum Power Consumption
[Brazil, Asia and General models]............................................1190 W
Dimensions (W x H x D)
................................. 435 x 182 x 439 mm (17-1/8” x 7-1/8” x 17-1/4”)
* Including legs and protrusions
Reference Dimensions (W x H x D) (with wireless antenna upright)
................................. 435 x 247 x 439 mm (17-1/8” x 9-3/4” x 17-1/4”)
Weight....................................................................... 14.9 kg (32.8 lbs)
* The contents of this manual apply to the latest specifications as of the
publishing date. To obtain the latest manual, access the Yamaha
website then download the manual file.
Manual Development Group
© 2017 Yamaha Corporation
Published 04/2017 AM-A0
Yamaha Global Site
https://www.yamaha.com/
Yamaha Downloads
http://download.yamaha.com/
YJ290A0/EN1

Documenttranscriptie

AV Receiver Owner’s Manual • This unit is a product for enjoying video and music at home. • This manual explains preparations and operations for everyday users of the unit. • Read the supplied booklet “Quick Start Guide” before using the unit. EN CONTENTS Introduction 5 3 Connecting the radio antennas....................................................38 FM/AM antennas (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) ......................................................38 Accessories................................................................................... 5 DAB/FM antenna (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) ..........................................................38 About this book ............................................................................ 5 4 Connecting a network cable or preparing the wireless antenna .....39 About remote control .................................................................... 6 Connecting the network cable.....................................................................................................................39 Preparing the wireless antenna ...................................................................................................................39 Batteries ......................................................................................................................................................... 6 5 Connecting other devices............................................................40 Operating range of the remote control......................................................................................................... 6 Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function ........................................................................40 FEATURES 6 Connecting the power cable ........................................................40 7 7 Selecting an on-screen menu language ........................................41 What you can do with the unit ........................................................ 7 8 Configuring the necessary speaker settings..................................42 AV CONTROLLER............................................................................................................................................. 9 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) ..................43 AV SETUP GUIDE (for tablet) .......................................................................................................................... 9 Measuring at one listening position (single measure) ................................................................................45 Application for smartphone / tablets “MusicCast CONTROLLER”............................................................... 9 Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)........................................................................46 Part names and functions .............................................................10 Checking the measurement results .............................................................................................................47 Front panel ................................................................................................................................................... 10 Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments.................................................................................................48 Front display (indicators) ............................................................................................................................ 12 Error messages .............................................................................................................................................49 Rear panel..................................................................................................................................................... 13 Warning messages ........................................................................................................................................50 Remote control ............................................................................................................................................ 15 10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly .................................51 Selecting the connection method ...............................................................................................................51 PREPARATIONS Connecting the unit to a wireless network..................................................................................................52 16 Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct) .............................................................57 11 Connecting to the MusicCast network ........................................59 General setup procedure ..............................................................16 MusicCast CONTROLLER ..............................................................................................................................59 1 Connecting speakers ..................................................................17 Adding the unit to the MusicCast network ..................................................................................................59 Basic speaker configuration ........................................................................................................................ 18 Advanced speaker configuration ................................................................................................................ 26 PLAYBACK 2 Connecting a TV and playback devices .........................................32 60 Input/output jacks and cables .................................................................................................................... 32 Connecting a TV ........................................................................................................................................... 33 Basic playback procedure .............................................................60 Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) ................................................................................. 34 Selecting an HDMI output jack.....................................................................................................................60 Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) ......................................................................................... 36 Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) ......................................................................................61 Connecting to the jacks on the front panel ................................................................................................ 37 En 2 Registering a scene ...................................................................................................................................... 62 Playback of Internet radio............................................................................................................................89 Selecting setting items to be included as scene assignments................................................................... 62 Registering favorite Internet radio stations (Favorites) .............................................................................91 Selecting the sound mode.............................................................63 Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay..................................92 Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP HD3) ............................................................................. 64 Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents ....................................................................................................92 Enjoying unprocessed playback.................................................................................................................. 67 Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) ..............94 Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct).......................................................................................... 68 Multi-zone configuration examples .............................................................................................................94 Playing back digitally compressed formats (such as MP3, etc.) with enriched sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) .................................................................................................................... 68 Preparing Zone2 ...........................................................................................................................................95 Listening to FM/AM radio (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) ........................69 Registering favorite items (shortcut) ........................................... 100 Controlling Zone2 .........................................................................................................................................98 Registering an item.....................................................................................................................................100 Setting the frequency steps......................................................................................................................... 69 Recalling a registered item.........................................................................................................................100 Selecting a frequency for reception ............................................................................................................ 69 Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) ................. 101 Registering favorite radio stations (presets) .............................................................................................. 70 Top menu screen ........................................................................................................................................102 Operating the radio on the TV ..................................................................................................................... 71 Control screen.............................................................................................................................................102 Listening to DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)............................72 Settings screen............................................................................................................................................103 Viewing the current status.......................................................... 104 Preparing the DAB tuning ............................................................................................................................ 72 Switching information on the front display ..............................................................................................104 Selecting a DAB radio station for reception................................................................................................ 72 Viewing the status information on the TV .................................................................................................105 Registering favorite DAB radio stations (presets)....................................................................................... 73 Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu)........................................................................... 106 Displaying the DAB information .................................................................................................................. 74 Checking reception strength of each DAB channel label ........................................................................... 74 Option menu items.....................................................................................................................................106 Listening to FM radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only)............................76 CONFIGURATIONS Selecting a frequency for reception ............................................................................................................ 76 111 Registering favorite FM radio stations (presets)......................................................................................... 76 Radio Data System tuning ........................................................................................................................... 78 Configuring input sources (Input menu)....................................... 111 Operating the radio on the TV ..................................................................................................................... 79 Input menu items .......................................................................................................................................111 Playing back music via Bluetooth ..................................................80 Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) ............................. 113 Playing back Bluetooth device music on the unit ...................................................................................... 80 Scene menu items ......................................................................................................................................113 Enjoying audio using Bluetooth speakers/headphones ............................................................................ 81 Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (DSP Program menu) ................................................................. 116 Playing back music stored on a USB storage device.........................82 Connecting a USB storage device ............................................................................................................... 82 DSP Program menu items ..........................................................................................................................117 Playback of USB storage device contents .................................................................................................. 82 Configuring various functions (Setup menu) ................................ 119 Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) ...................85 Setup menu items.......................................................................................................................................120 Media sharing setup..................................................................................................................................... 85 Speaker (Manual Setup) .............................................................................................................................123 Playback of PC music contents ................................................................................................................... 86 Sound ..........................................................................................................................................................127 Listening to Internet radio ............................................................89 En Video............................................................................................................................................................129 3 Bluetooth ....................................................................................................................................................155 HDMI ........................................................................................................................................................... 130 Network ...................................................................................................................................................... 131 USB and network ........................................................................................................................................156 Bluetooth.................................................................................................................................................... 133 Error indications on the front display .......................................... 158 Multi Zone................................................................................................................................................... 134 Glossary .................................................................................... 159 Function...................................................................................................................................................... 137 Audio information (audio decoding format) .............................................................................................159 ECO ............................................................................................................................................................. 139 Audio Information (Others) ........................................................................................................................161 Language .................................................................................................................................................... 140 HDMI and video information ......................................................................................................................161 Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) ............... 140 Network information ..................................................................................................................................162 Types of information.................................................................................................................................. 141 Yamaha technologies .................................................................................................................................162 Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu)............ 142 Supported devices and file formats ............................................. 163 ADVANCED SETUP menu items ................................................................................................................. 143 Supported devices......................................................................................................................................163 Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) ..................................................................... 143 File formats .................................................................................................................................................163 Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR)................................................................ 143 Video signal flow........................................................................ 164 Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID)........................................................................................... 144 Video conversion table ...............................................................................................................................164 Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TUNER FRQ STEP) ........................................................ 144 Multi-zone output .......................................................................................................................................165 Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) .......................................................................................... 144 Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK)....................................................... 144 Information on HDMI.................................................................. 165 Selecting the HDMI 4K signal format (4K MODE) ...................................................................................... 145 HDMI Control...............................................................................................................................................165 Switching the DTS format notification setting (DTS MODE) .................................................................... 145 Audio Return Channel (ARC) ......................................................................................................................167 Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) ........................................................................... 145 HDMI signal compatibility ..........................................................................................................................167 Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE)............................................................................................... 146 Trademarks............................................................................... 168 Updating the firmware (FIRM. UPDATE).................................................................................................... 146 Specifications............................................................................ 169 Checking the firmware version (VERSION) ............................................................................................... 146 Updating the unit’s firmware via the network .............................. 147 Updating the unit’s firmware immediately .............................................................................................. 147 Updating the unit’s firmware at power off ............................................................................................... 148 APPENDIX 149 Frequently asked questions ........................................................ 149 Troubleshooting ........................................................................ 150 First, check the following:.......................................................................................................................... 150 Power, system and remote control........................................................................................................... 150 Audio........................................................................................................................................................... 151 Video ........................................................................................................................................................... 153 FM/AM radio (AM radio feature is not available on the Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models)..... 154 DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) ................................................................... 154 En 4 Introduction Accessories About this book Check that the following accessories are supplied with the product. # AM antenna (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) The illustrations of the main unit and remote control used in this manual are of the U.S.A. model, unless otherwise specified. # DAB/FM antenna In this manual, illustrations of English menu screens are used as examples. (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) (China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) For information on how to control external devices with the remote control, refer to “Supplement for Remote Control” on the supplied CD-ROM. Some features are not available in certain regions. Due to product improvements, specifications and appearance are subject to change without notice. # FM antenna (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) This manual explains operations using the supplied remote control. # YPAO microphone This manual describes all the “iPod touch”, “iPhone” and “iPad” as the “iPod”. “iPod” refers to “iPod touch”, “iPhone” and “iPad”, unless otherwise specified. Icons used in this manual Y indicates precautions for use of the unit and its feature limitations. # Power cable X # Remote control indicates supplementary explanations for better use. # Batteries (AAA, R03, UM-4) (x2) # CD-ROM (Owner’s Manual) # Quick Start Guide * (Except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) One of the above FM antennas is supplied depending on the region of purchase. * The supplied power cable varies depending on the region of purchase. En 5 About remote control This section explains how to use the supplied remote control. Batteries Insert the batteries the right way round. Operating range of the remote control Point the remote control at the remote control sensor on the unit and remain within the operating range shown below. Within 6 m (20 ft) 30° 30° En 6 FEATURES What you can do with the unit The unit is equipped with the various useful features. More advanced ENTERTAINMENT sound programs (p.65) Various wireless connection methods (p.51) Connecting various devices (p.32) By processing front left and front right sound fields The unit supports the Wi-Fi feature that allows the unit to A number of HDMI jacks and various input/output jacks on individually, the ENTERTAINMENT sound programs are connect to your wireless router (access point) without a the unit allow you to connect video devices (such as BD/DVD further improved in acoustic positioning and sound network cable connection. In addition, Wireless Direct players), audio devices (such as CD players), game consoles, transition. These programs allow you to enjoy clearer vocal enables connecting a mobile device to the unit directly camcorders, and other devices. and instrumental sounds, distinct narrations, and more without router. dynamic sound effects. Playing back TV audio in surround sound with a single HDMI cable connection (Audio Return Channel: ARC) (p.32) Surround playback with 5 speakers placed in front (p.66) PL Presence L Sound field PR Presence R Sound field If you have surround speakers but there is no space to place them in the rear of your room, you can place them in the front and enjoy multichannel surround sound with the 5 When using an ARC-compatible TV, you only need one HDMI speakers placed in the front (Virtual CINEMA FRONT). cable to enable video output to the TV, audio input from the TV, and the transmission of HDMI Control signals. Home Audio Network with MusicCast (p.59) HDMI Control TV audio Video from external device SL Surround L Sound field SR Surround R Sound field The unit supports the MusicCast feature that allows you to link a MusicCast compatible device to another device in a different room and play them back simultaneously, or control all MusicCast compatible devices with the dedicated application “MusicCast CONTROLLER”. Image of sound field processing Low power consumption (p.140) The ECO mode (power saving function) reduces the unit’s power consumption. En 7 CINEMA DSP The excitement of a concert hall and the powerful sense of being inside a movie - we all want to enjoy these experiences in our own living room. Yamaha has pursued the fulfillment of these desires for more than 30 years, and this fulfillment has now taken shape as the Yamaha AV receivers. What is a sound field? CINEMA DSP We perceive sound from a voice or an instrument not only as the sounds that are heard directly Yamaha has accumulated a massive amount of acoustical data by analyzing the actual sound but also as the “reflected” or “reverberant” sound that has been reflected by the walls or fields of concert halls and performance spaces around the world. “CINEMA DSP” allows this ceiling of the building. The character of the reflected and reverberant sound is affected by the data to be applied to create sound fields. This unit contains a wide variety of sound programs shape, size, and material of the building, and all of these sounds taken together are what give using CINEMA DSP. us the auditory sensation of being in that specific place. By selecting a sound program that is appropriate to the content of the playback source such as This unique acoustical character of a specific space is what we call the “sound field”. movies, music, or games, you can maximize the acoustical effectiveness of that specific content. (For example, a sound program designed for movies can give you the sensation of Conceptual diagram of a concert hall’s sound field actually being in that scene.) CINEMA DSP HD3 “CINEMA DSP HD3” is Yamaha’s flagship 3D sound field playback technology that takes full advantage of the massive amount of acoustic reflection data included in the sound field data. It delivers more than twice as much capability for generating acoustic reflections as conventional CINEMA DSP 3D, in addition to high-frequency playback capability, delivering an utterly natural and powerful spatial sound field. Conceptual diagram of a sound field created by the unit Capability for reproducing reflections Level (when the sound program “Hall in Munich” is selected) CINEMA DSP HD3 CINEMA DSP 3D Time En 8 Useful applications The following applications provide you the flexibility to control the unit or assist you with the cable connections. AV CONTROLLER AV SETUP GUIDE (for tablet) MusicCast CONTROLLER “AV CONTROLLER” will turn your smartphone/tablet into a “AV SETUP GUIDE” is an application that assists you with MusicCast CONTROLLER is an application that allows you to Wi-Fi enabled remote control for your Yamaha network cable connections between AV receiver and source devices link a MusicCast compatible device to other MusicCast products. This application provides you the flexibility to as well as AV receiver setup. This application guides you compatible devices in other rooms and play them back control the available inputs, volume, mute, power through the various settings such as speaker connections, simultaneously. This app lets you use your smartphone or commands and playback source. TV and video/audio device connections and selecting the other mobile device instead of the remote control to easily speaker system. select music to play back as well as configure the unit and Functions MusicCast compatible devices. • Power on/off and volume adjustment Functions • Input, scene and sound mode selection • Connection guide (speakers, TV and video/audio devices) Functions • DSP Parameter adjustment • Setup guide (YPAO settings and various setup assistance • Selecting and playing back various content • Playback control (including music selection for some with illustrations) – Play back music from your mobile device • Viewing owner’s manual – Select an Internet radio station X X – Play back music files stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) For details, search for “AV CONTROLLER” on the App Store or Google For details, search for “AV SETUP GUIDE” on the App Store or Google – Play back music files stored on a USB storage device Play. Play. sources) • Operating and configuring the unit – Select the input source, adjust the volume and mute the audio output – Select from a wide variety of sound processing features X For details, search for “MusicCast CONTROLLER” on the App Store or Google Play. En 9 Part names and functions This section explains the functions of the parts of the unit. Front panel a b c d e MAIN ZONE PURE DIRECT INPUT f a MAIN ZONE z key Turns on/off (standby) the unit. b Standby indicator Lights up when the unit is in standby mode under any of the following conditions. • HDMI Control is enabled (p.130) VOLUME g h f INPUT knob Opening the front panel door Selects an input source. To use controls or jacks behind the front panel door, gently g Front panel door press the bottom of the door to open it. Keep the door closed For protecting controls and jacks (p.11). h VOLUME knob when not using controls or jacks behind the front panel door. (Be careful not to trap your fingers.) Adjusts the volume. • Standby Through is enabled (p.131) • Network Standby is enabled (p.132) • Bluetooth Standby is enabled (p.133) c Front display Displays information (p.12). d Remote control sensor Receives remote control signals (p.6). e PURE DIRECT key Enables/disables Pure Direct (p.68). En 10 ■ Inside of the front panel door a b cd e ON SCREEN OPTION fg h ij SCENE TONE CONTROL STRAIGHT 1 2 3 kl m INFO(WPS) MEMORY PRESET FM AM TUNING n 4 (CONNECT) MULTI ZONE PROGRAM ENTER ZONE 2 RETURN ZONE CONTROL DISPLAY VIDEO AUX PHONES USB 5V o a ON SCREEN key Displays the on-screen menu on the TV. b Menu operations keys Cursor keys: Select a menu or a parameter. ENTER: Confirms a selected item. RETURN: Returns to the previous screen. c OPTION key Displays the option menu (p.106). d DISPLAY key Displays status information on the TV (p.105). e TONE CONTROL key Adjusts the high-frequency range and low-frequency range of output sounds (p.107). f STRAIGHT (CONNECT) key Enables/disables the straight decode mode (p.67). Enters MusicCast CONTROLLER registration by holding down for 5 seconds (p.59). 1A YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA p q L AUDIO R HDMI IN r h SCENE keys Select the assigned input source (including the selected radio station or content when it is assigned), sound program, and various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is in standby mode (p.61). i MULTI ZONE keys (U.S.A. model) l FM and AM keys (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) Switch between FM and AM (p.69). FM and DAB keys (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) Switch between FM and DAB (p.72, p.69). ZONE 2: Enables/disables the audio output to Zone2 (p.98). ZONE CONTROL: Changes the zone (main zone or Zone2) that is controlled by the keys and knobs on the front panel (p.98). j INFO (WPS) key Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.104). Enters the wireless network connection setup (WPS push button configuration) by holding down for 3 seconds (p.53). k MEMORY key Registers FM/AM/DAB radio stations as preset stations (p.70, p.73, p.76). Registers USB/network contents or Bluetooth input source as shortcuts (p.100). g PROGRAM keys m PRESET keys Select a preset FM/DAB radio station (p.73, p.77) (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) or a preset FM/AM radio station (p.70) (other models). Selects a USB/network content from shortcuts (p.100). n TUNING keys Select the radio frequency (p.69). o USB jack For connecting a USB storage device (p.82). p YPAO MIC jack For connecting the supplied YPAO microphone (p.43). q PHONES jack Select a sound program or a surround decoder (p.63). For connecting headphones. r VIDEO AUX jacks For connecting a device, such as a camcorder and a game console (p.37). En 11 Front display (indicators) a bc de h g f j i k ECO VOL. MUTE A-DRC VIRTUAL YPAO VOL. ZONE PARTY 2 IN OUT 1 2 LINK MASTER STEREO TUNED Hi-Res ENHANCER SLEEP HD 3 lmn o p q r a HDMI Lights up when HDMI signals are being input or output. IN Lights up when HDMI signals are being input. OUT1/OUT2 Indicates the HDMI OUT jacks currently outputting an HDMI signal. b ECO Lights up when the unit is in the eco mode (p.140). c Firmware update indicator Lights up when a firmware update is available via the network (p.147) d LINK MASTER Lights up when the unit is the master device of the MusicCast network. e ZONE2 Lights up when Zone2 is enabled (p.98). f STEREO Lights up when the unit is receiving a stereo FM radio signal. TUNED Lights up when the unit is receiving an FM radio station signal (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) or an FM/AM radio station signal (other models). g PARTY Lights up when the unit is in the party mode (p.99). FPL L C R FPR SL SW SR SBL SB SBR rs h Information display t u s VIRTUAL Displays the current status (such as input name and sound mode name). You can switch the information by pressing INFO (p.104). i Volume indicator Indicates the current volume. Lights up when the Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) or Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) (p.64), or the virtual surround processing (p.66) is working. t Speaker indicators Indicate speaker terminals from which signals are output. j MUTE Blinks when audio is temporarily muted. A Front speaker (L) S Front speaker (R) k A-DRC Lights up when Adaptive DRC (p.107) is working. l Signal strength indicator Indicates the strength of the wireless network signal (p.51). m Bluetooth indicator D Center speaker F Surround speaker (L) G Surround speaker (R) H Surround back speaker (L) J Surround back speaker (R) Lights up when the unit is connecting to a Bluetooth device (p.80). n Hi-Res K Surround back speaker B Front presence speaker (L) Lights up when the high-resolution mode (p.109) is working. “CINEMA DSP HD” lights up when CINEMA DSP (p.64) is working. “CINEMA DSP !” lights up when CINEMA DSP HD3 is activated. p ENHANCER Lights up when Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68) is working. q SLEEP Lights up when the sleep timer is on. r Cursor indicators Indicate the remote control cursor keys currently operational. En N Front presence speaker (R) L Subwoofer o CINEMA DSP indicator 12 u YPAO VOL. Lights up when YPAO Volume is enabled (p.107). Rear panel a b c d e f (HDCP2.2) 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) h HDMI (HDCP2.2) HDMI OUT 2 g AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 i NETWORK AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 j k l m ( 3 NET ) AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) AC IN AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) AV 3 AV 4 TRIGGER OUT COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PR PB A 1 REMOTE 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL VIDEO IN RS-232C OUT 2 B PHONO L AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) PR PB AV 2 PRE OUT ZONE OUT L (SINGLE) 1 R R GND 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 2 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL 6 OPTICAL ZONE 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L R CENTER FRONT L ANTENNA (4 RADIO) 75ȍ FM AM SINGLE ZONE 2 n ZONE 2/BI-AMP o p (U.S.A. model) * The area around the video/audio output jacks is marked in white on the actual product to prevent improper connections. En 13 q a PHONO jacks q PRE OUT jacks For connecting to a turntable (p.36). For connecting to a subwoofer with built-in amplifier (p.23) or to an external power amplifier (p.31). b AUDIO 1-3 jacks For connecting to audio playback devices and inputting audio signals (p.36). c AV 1-4 jacks For connecting to video/audio playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.34). d HDMI OUT 1 jack For connecting to an HDMI-compatible TV and outputting video/audio signals (p.32). When using ARC, TV audio signal can also be input through the HDMI OUT 1 jack. HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack For connecting to an HDMI-compatible TV and outputting video/audio signals (p.33), or for connecting to an HDMI-compatible device used in Zone2 (p.96). e COMPONENT VIDEO (AV 1-2) jacks For connecting to video playback devices that support component video and inputting video signals (p.34). f HDMI (AV 1-7) jacks For connecting to HDMI-compatible playback devices and inputting video/audio signals (p.34). g TRIGGER OUT 1-2 jacks For connecting to devices that support the trigger function (p.40). h REMOTE IN/OUT jacks For connecting to an infrared signal receiver/emitter that allows you to operate the unit and other devices from another room (p.96). i NETWORK jack For connecting to a network with a network cable (p.39). j Wireless antenna For a wireless (Wi-Fi) connection to a network (p.51) and a Bluetooth connection (p.80). k RS-232C terminal This is a control expansion terminal for custom installation. Consult your dealer for details. l VOLTAGE SELECTOR (Brazil and General models only) Selects the switch position according to your local voltage (p.40). m AC IN jack For connecting the supplied power cable (p.40). n ANTENNA jacks For connecting to radio antennas (p.38). o ZONE OUT jacks For connecting to the external amplifier used in Zone2 and for outputting audio (p.95). p SPEAKERS terminals For connecting to speakers (p.17). En 14 Remote control a Remote control signal transmitter a Transmits infrared signals. b z (receiver power) key b Turns on/off (standby) the unit. AV c d 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX c Input selection keys AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 o p SCENE e 1 2 f PROGRAM g TOP MENU h 3 MUTE 4 VOLUME r POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION i DISPLAY MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 d MAIN/ZONE2 switch Changes the zone (main zone or Zone2) that is controlled by the remote control (p.98). 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT t Operate the FM/AM/DAB radio when “TUNER” is selected as the input source (p.69). BAND: Switches between FM and DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models), or FM and AM radio (other models). PRESET: Select a preset station. TUNING: Select the radio frequency. External device operation keys Let you perform playback operations when “USB” or “NET” is selected as the input source, or control playback of the HDMI Control-compatible playback device (p.165). k Sound mode keys Select a sound mode (p.63). l INFO key Selects the information displayed on the front display (p.104). m SLEEP key Pressing this key repeatedly will specify the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, off), in which the unit switches to the standby mode. n Numeric keys Let you enter numerical values, such as radio frequencies. e SCENE keys Select the registered input source, sound program, and various settings with one touch. Also, turns on the unit when it is in standby mode (p.61). BAND k l m n s ENTER RETURN j q Select an input source for playback. AV 1-7: AV 1-7 jacks V-AUX: VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel) AUDIO 1-3: AUDIO 1-3 jacks PHONO: PHONO jacks TUNER: FM/AM/DAB radio BLUETOOTH: Bluetooth connection (the unit as a Bluetooth receiver) USB: USB jack (on the front panel) NET: NETWORK sources (press repeatedly to select a desired network source) j Radio keys f PROGRAM keys Select a sound program, a surround decoder, an input source, a network source, a registered item (shortcut), a browse screen page, the volume of dialogue sounds or shuffle/repeat settings (p.137). g External device operation keys Displays menus for the HDMI Control-compatible playback device (p.165). h ON SCREEN key MEMORY key Registers FM/AM/DAB radio stations as presets (p.70, p.73, p.76). Registers USB/network contents or Bluetooth input source as shortcuts (p.100). o HDMI OUT key Selects HDMI OUT jacks to be used for video/audio output (p.60). p PARTY key Turns on/off the party mode (p.99). q VOLUME keys Adjust the volume. r MUTE key Mutes the audio output. Displays the on-screen menu on the TV. i Menu operation keys s OPTION key Displays the option menu (p.106). Cursor keys: Select a menu or the parameter. ENTER: Confirms a selected item. RETURN: Returns to the previous screen. t DISPLAY key Displays status information on the TV (p.105). X (China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) (U.S.A. model) For information on the keys other than those above, refer to “Supplement for Remote Control” on the supplied CD-ROM. En 15 PREPARATIONS General setup procedure 1 Connecting speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.17) 2 Connecting a TV and playback devices. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.32) 3 Connecting the radio antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.38) 4 Connecting a network cable or preparing the wireless antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.39) 5 Connecting other devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.40) 6 Connecting the power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.40) 7 Selecting an on-screen menu language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.41) 8 Configuring the necessary speaker settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.42) 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.43) 10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.51) 11 Connecting to the MusicCast network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (p.59) This completes all the preparations. Enjoy playing movies, music, radio and other content with the unit! En 16 1 Connecting speakers The unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers to create the favorite acoustic space in your room. You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system (p.26). Caution Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When connecting 6-ohm speakers, set the unit’s speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. For details, see “Setting the speaker impedance” (p.23). Ideal speaker layout Functions of each speaker E 0.5 to 1 m (1.6 to 3.3 ft) 1.8 m (5.9 ft) 0.5 to 1 m (1.6 to 3.3 ft) 1 9 1.8 m (5.9 ft) 2 3 Speaker type R Function Front (L/R) 12 Produce front left/right channel sounds (stereo sounds). Center 3 Produces center channel sounds (such as movie dialogues and vocals). Surround (L/R) 45 Produce surround left/right channel sounds. Surround speakers also produce surround back channel sounds when no surround back speakers are connected. Surround back (L/R) 67 Produce surround back left/right channel sounds. Front presence (L/R) ER Produce CINEMA DSP effect sounds or heights channel sounds of Dolby Atmos and DTS:X contents. 9 Subwoofer 9 Produces LFE (low-frequency effect) channel sounds and reinforces bass parts of other channels. This channel is counted as “0.1”. You can connect 2 subwoofers to the unit and place them on the left/right (or front/rear) sides of the room. X • We recommend using front presence speakers to have a full effect of the 3-dimensional sound fields. However, the unit creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and surround speakers to produce 4 3-dimensional sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected (p.64). 5 • Use “Ideal speaker layout” (diagram on the right) as reference. You do not need to exactly adjust the speaker 10°~30° 10°~30° layout to this diagram since the YPAO function of the unit will automatically optimize the speaker settings (such as distances) to suit the speaker layout. 6 7 • When using only one surround back speaker, place it straight behind the listening position (middle of “SBL” and “SBR” in the diagram). 0.3 m (1 ft) or more En 17 Basic speaker configuration If you do not apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external amplifier) or multi-zone configurations, follow the procedure below to place the speakers in your room and connect them to the unit. ■ Placing speakers in your room 7.1/5.1.2 system [S] Depending on the number of speakers, place the speakers and subwoofer in your room. This (using both surround back and front presence speakers) section describes the representative speaker layout examples. This speaker system brings out the full performance of the unit and allows you to enjoy a X highly-natural 3-dimensional sound field with any contents. • To have a full effect of Dolby Atmos contents, we recommend using a speaker system with a S mark. However, you can also play back Dolby Atmos contents with the 7.1 system (using surround back speakers). • To have a full effect of DTS:X contents, we recommend using a speaker system with a S mark. • (About the number of channels) For example, “5.1.2” denotes “standard 5.1-channel plus 2 for overhead speaker channels”. For details on how to place overhead speakers (presence speakers), see “Presence speaker layout” (p.22). X • The surround back speakers and front presence speakers do not produce sounds simultaneously. The unit automatically changes the speakers to be used, depending on the input signal and CINEMA DSP (p.64). • When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling or when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the presence speakers, configure the “Layout (Front Presence)” setting in the “Setup” menu before performing YPAO (p.42). En 18 5.1.2 system [S] (using front presence speakers) 7.1 system (using surround back speakers) This speaker system uses the front presence speakers to produce a natural 3-dimensional This speaker system creates Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center and sound field, and also creates Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround surround speakers to produce a 3-dimensional sound field, and also allows you to enjoy speakers to add a sense of depth to the rear sound field. This system is suited for enjoying not extended surround sounds using the surround back speakers. only 5.1-channel but also for 7.1-channel contents. X When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling or when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the presence speakers, configure the “Layout (Front Presence)” setting in the “Setup” menu before performing YPAO (p.42). En 19 5.1 system 5.1 system (front 5.1-channel) (using surround speakers) We recommend using this speaker system when you cannot place speakers in the rear side of the room. 1 2 4 9 5 3 X You can enjoy surround sound even without the center speaker (4.1 system). X When placing surround speakers in the front side, set “Layout (Surround)” in the “Setup” menu to “Front” before performing YPAO (p.42). En 20 5.1 system (front 5.1-channel) (using front presence speakers) 2.1 system We recommend using this speaker system when you cannot place speakers in the rear side of the room. E R 1 9 2 3 X Add the center speaker to configure a 3.1 system. X When using front presence speakers installed to the ceiling or when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the presence speakers, configure the “Layout (Front Presence)” setting in the “Setup” menu before performing YPAO (p.42). En 21 Presence speaker layout Dolby Enabled SP Use the Dolby Enabled speakers as the presence speakers. The unit provides three layout patterns for presence speakers (Front Height, Overhead and Dolby Enabled SP). Choose a layout pattern that suits your listening environment. It utilizes sounds reflected from ceiling and lets you enjoy overhead sounds only from speakers X that are placed at the same level as traditional speakers. You can enjoy Dolby Atmos, DTS:X or Cinema DSP HD3 with any layout pattern. Front Height Install the presence speakers on the front side wall. It delivers a natural sound field with excellent linkage of left, right, top and bottom sound spaces, and sound extensity effectively. X Place the Dolby Enabled speakers on top of or near the traditional front speakers. A Dolby Enabled speaker unit may be integrated into a traditional speaker. For details, refer to the instruction manual of the Dolby Enabled speakers. Notes on installation of ceiling speakers When installing presence speakers to a ceiling, install them just above the listening position, or the ceiling between the extensions of the front speakers and listening position. Overhead Install the presence speakers to the ceiling above the listening position. It delivers realistic overhead sound effects and sound field with excellent linkage of front and rear sound spaces effectively. Caution Y Be sure to use speakers that are made for ceiling use and take anti-drop measures. Ask a qualified contractor or dealer personnel for installation works. For details on the installation position of ceiling speakers, see “Notes on installation of ceiling speakers” (p.22). En 22 ■ Setting the speaker impedance ■ Connecting speakers Under its default settings, the unit is configured for 8-ohm speakers. When using a 6-ohm Connect the speakers placed in your room to the unit. speaker for any channel, set the speaker impedance to “6 Ω MIN”. In this case, you can also use Precaution for connecting of the speaker cables 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. 1 2 Prepare speaker cables in a place away from the unit, to avoid accidentally dropping wire Before connecting speakers, connect the power cable to an AC wall outlet. strands into the unit's interior which could result in a short circuit or malfunction of the unit. Improper connecting of the speaker cables may cause short circuit and also damage the unit While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. or the speakers. MAIN ZONE z • Remove the unit’s power cable from an AC wall outlet and turn off the subwoofer before STRAIGHT connecting the speakers. • Twist the bare wires of the speaker cables firmly together. 3 Check that “SPEAKER IMP.” is displayed on the front display. SPEAKER¡IMP. ¡¡¡¡¡¡¡¡¡8¬MIN 4 5 • Do not let the bare wires of the speaker cable touch one another. Press STRAIGHT to select “6 Ω MIN”. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and remove the power cable from the AC wall outlet. • Do not let the bare wires of the speaker cable come into contact with the unit's metal parts You are now ready to connect the speakers. (rear panel and screws). If “Check SP Wires” appear on the front display when the unit is turned on, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker cables short circuit. En 23 Connection diagram Speakers to be connected Refer to the following diagram and connect the speakers to the unit. Speaker system (the number of channels) Speaker type 7.1/5.1.2 5.1 Front (L/R) 1 2 ( ( Center 3 ( ( Surround (L/R) 4 5 ( )*3 PRE OUT ZONE OUT (SINGLE) 1 2.1 2 The unit (rear) ZONE 2 ( FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L CENTER R FRONT L SINGLE Surround back (L/R) 6 7 )*1 Front presence (L/R) E R )*2 )*4 ( ( Subwoofer 9 ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP ( If you have nine speakers, you can connect the both surround back speakers and front E presence speakers. In this case, the unit automatically changes the speakers to be used, R depending on the input signal and CINEMA DSP. 1 2 If you have seven speakers, use two of them as surround back speakers (*1) or front presence speakers (*2). 9 3 9 If you have five speakers, use two of them as surround speakers (*3) or front presence speakers (*4). X 4 5 • You can also connect up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to the unit. 6 • When apply this speaker configuration, set “Power Amp Assign” (p.123) to “Basic” (default). 7 • To use an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, etc.) to enhance speaker output, see “Connecting an external power amplifier” (p.31). Cables necessary for connection (commercially available) Speaker cables (x the number of speakers) + – Y + – When using only one surround back speaker, connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Audio pin cable (two for connecting two subwoofers) En 24 Connecting speaker cables Connecting the subwoofer (with built-in amplifier) Speaker cables have two wires. One is for connecting the negative (-) terminal of the unit and Use an audio pin cable to connect the subwoofer. the speaker, and the other is for the positive (+) terminal. If the wires are colored to prevent Audio pin cable confusion, connect the black wire to the negative and the other wire to the positive terminal. PRE OUT (SING LE) 1 (FR ONT) 1 Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from the ends of the speaker cable, and twist the bare wires of the cable firmly together. 2 SURR UND SUR. BACK SUBW OOFE R 2 3 Loosen the speaker terminal. 4 Tighten the terminal. SURR OUN + 2 3 FR ON T 1 4 – (black) Using a banana plug (U.S.A., Canada, China, Brazil and General models only) 1 Tighten the speaker terminal. 2 Insert a banana plug into the end of the terminal. 1 + ER L Insert the bare wires of the cable into the gap on the side (upper right or bottom left) of the terminal. + (red) CENT D BA CK FR ON T Banana plug 2 En 25 Advanced speaker configuration In addition to the basic speaker configuration (p.18), the unit also allows you to apply the following speaker configurations to enhance your system. Using the four internal amplifiers for front speakers to have more high-quality sounds Bi-amp connection Combining with an external power amplifier (Hi-Fi amplifier, etc.) to build an extended system Using the excess internal amplifiers for stereo speakers in another room Power-amp channel expansion (Example) Multi-zone configuration (Example) (Example) External power amplifier Bi-amp connection Zone2 Main zone En 26 ■ Available speaker configurations 7.1 +1Zone Main zone Output channel (max) Bi-amp 7 7 5 ) 7 ) Multi-zone Power Amp Assign (p.123) Page Surround back +1 (Zone2) 7.1 +1Zone 27 Front presence +1 (Zone2) 5.1.2 +1Zone 28 5.1 Bi-Amp 28 7.1 Bi-Amp [ext.SB] 29 Surround back/ Front presence Surround back External power amplifier (required) Surround back 1 9 2 1 2 9 3 5 4 Y 6 When applying one of these configurations, you need to configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting in the “Setup” 7 menu (p.42). Zone2 Main zone Speaker Connect to 12 FRONT 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 67 SURROUND BACK ER (not used) 9 SUBWOOFER 1-2 Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP1 X When Zone2 output is enabled (p.98), the surround back speakers in the main zone do not output sound. En 27 5.1.2 +1Zone 5.1 Bi-Amp Bi-amp E R 1 9 2 3 1 2 1 9 4 9 5 4 2 3 9 5 Zone2 Main zone Speaker Connect to Speaker Connect to 12 FRONT 12 FRONT and EXTRA SP 1 (bi-amp connection) 3 CENTER 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 45 SURROUND 67 (not used) 67 (not used) ER EXTRA SP1 ER (not used) 9 SUBWOOFER 1-2 9 SUBWOOFER 1-2 Zone2 speakers EXTRA SP2 X When Zone2 output is enabled (p.98), the front presence speakers in the main zone do not output sound. En 28 ■ Connecting front speakers that support bi-amp connections 7.1 Bi-Amp [ext.SB] Bi-amp When using front speakers that support bi-amp connections, connect them to the FRONT terminals and EXTRA SP1 terminals. 1 To enable the bi-amp function, configure the “Power Amp Assign” setting in the “Setup” menu 2 after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet (p.42). 3 9 9 The unit (rear) SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L R CENTER FRONT L SINGLE 4 5 6 ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP 7 1 2 via external amp 3 Speaker Connect to 12 FRONT and EXTRA SP 1 (bi-amp connection) 3 CENTER 45 SURROUND 67 SUR.BACK (PRE OUT) via external power amplifier ER (not used) 9 SUBWOOFER 1-2 9 9 4 5 X The FRONT terminals and EXTRA SP1 terminals output the same signals. Caution Before making bi-amp connections, remove any brackets or cables that connect a woofer with a tweeter. Refer to the instruction manual of the speakers for details. If you are not making bi-amp connections, make sure that the brackets or cables are connected before connecting the speaker cables. En 29 ■ Connecting Zone2 speakers (when using front presence speakers in the main zone) When using Zone2 speakers, connect them to the EXTRA SP1 or EXTRA SP2 terminals. The unit (rear) SPEAKERS R To utilize the EXTRA SP terminals for Zone2 speakers, configure the “Power Amp Assign” SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK setting in the “Setup” menu after connecting the power cable to an AC wall outlet (p.42). L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L CENTER R FRONT L SINGLE X ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP You can also connect Zone2 speakers using an external amplifier (p.95). (when using surround back speakers in the main zone) E The unit (rear) R SURROUND L EXTRA SP1 R F.PRESENCE L L CENTER R FRONT 2 FL FR L 9 SINGLE ZONE 2 R 1 SPEAKERS EXTRA SP2 R SURROUND BACK 3 9 ZONE 2/BI-AMP 4 5 Zone2 1 9 2 3 FL FR Main zone 9 4 5 6 7 Zone2 Main zone En 30 ■ Connecting an external power amplifier (Example) When connecting an external power amplifier to enhance speaker output, connect the input Connecting front speakers via an external power amplifier jacks of the power amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks of the unit. The same channel signals are PRE OUT (FRONT) jacks output from the PRE OUT jacks as from their corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. HDMI (HDCP2.2) V2 AV 3 NETWORK AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 ( 3 NET ) AV 7 Main input jack TRIGGER OUT NT VIDEO PB Caution PR 1 REMOTE 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL • To prevent the generation of loud noises or abnormal sounds, make sure the followings before making connections. IN RS-232C MAIN IN OUT PR 2 PR PB PRE OUT (SINGLE) 1 L L 2 – Remove the power cable of the unit and turn off the external power amplifier before connecting them. FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER CENTER R SPEAKERS – When using the PRE OUT jacks, do not connect speakers to the corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. ROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L CENTER FRONT – When using a pre-main amplifier that does not have the volume control bypass, turn up the volume of the pre-main amplifier enough and fix it. In this case, do not connect other devices (except the unit) to the pre-main amplifier. R R FRONT L SUR SINGLE ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP The unit (rear) The unit (rear) HDMI (HDCP2.2) AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 NETWORK AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 ( 3 NET ) AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) AC IN TRIGGER OUT COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PR PB A 1 REMOTE 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL IN RS-232C OUT 2 B Y PR PB AV 2 PRE OUT ZONE OUT (SINGLE) 1 2 ZONE 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L CENTER R FRONT L SINGLE ZONE 2 a bc ZONE 2/BI-AMP d a FRONT jacks About external power amplifiers Output front channel sounds. We recommend using power amplifiers that meet the following conditions. b SURROUND jacks • With unbalanced inputs Output surround channel sounds. c SUR. BACK jacks • With volume control bypass (or without volume control circuit) Output surround back channel sounds. When using only one surround back speaker, connect the external amplifier to the SINGLE jack (L side). • Output power: 100 W or more (6 to 8 Ω) d CENTER jack Outputs center channel sounds. En 31 Amplifier with volume control bypass (such as A-S3000) 2 Connecting a TV and playback devices Connect a TV and playback devices (video and audio devices) to the unit. For information on how to connect a USB storage device, see “Connecting a USB storage device” (p.82). Input/output jacks and cables The unit is equipped with the following input/output jacks. Prepare the cables that match the jacks on your devices. ■ Video/audio jacks ■ Video jacks ■ Audio jacks To input/output video and audio signals, use the following To input only video signals, use the following jacks. To input/output only audio signals, use the following jacks. jacks. COMPONENT VIDEO jacks HDMI jacks OPTICAL jacks Transmit video signals separated into three components: Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital optical cable. Transmit digital video and digital sound through a single luminance (Y), chrominance blue (Pb), and chrominance red Remove the tip protector (if available) before using the cable. jack. Use an HDMI cable. (Pr). Use a component video cable with three plugs. Digital optical cable AV 1 Component video cable HDMI cable O T VIDE ONEN COMVP 1 PB A Y PR A COAXIAL jacks Y Use a 19-pin HDMI cable with the HDMI logo. We recommend using a cable less than 5.0 m (16.4 ft) long to prevent signal quality degradation. X Transmit digital audio signals. Use a digital coaxial cable. VIDEO jacks Digital coaxial cable Transmit analog video signals. Use a video pin cable. • The unit’s HDMI jacks support the HDMI Control, Audio Return Channel (ARC), and 3D and 4K Ultra HD video transmission features. AV 1 Video pin cable • Use high speed HDMI cables to enjoy 3D or 4K Ultra HD videos. VIDEO AUDIO jacks Transmit analog stereo audio signals. Use a stereo pin cable (RCA cable). AUDIO3 En 32 Stereo pin cable Connecting a TV About Audio Return Channel (ARC) Connect a TV to the unit so that video input to the unit can be output to the TV. • ARC allows audio signals to travel both ways. If you connect a TV that supports ARC to the unit with a single HDMI cable, you can output video/audio to the TV or input TV audio to the unit. You can also enjoy playback of TV audio on the unit. • When using ARC, connect a TV with an HDMI cable that supports ARC. ■ HDMI connection ■ Connecting another TV or a projector Connect the TV to the unit with an HDMI cable and an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin The unit has two HDMI output jacks. If you connect another TV or a projector to the unit with cable). an HDMI cable, you can switch the TV (or projector) to be used for watching videos with the Y remote control (p.60). You can connect another TV or a projector by using the HDMI OUT 2 jack (p.33). HDMI HDMI OUT jack HDMI OUT (HDCP2.2) 2 The unit (rear) HDMI OUT 2 jack HDMI OUT ARC HDMI (HDCP2.2) 2 The unit (rear) 1 (ZONE OUT) 1 (ZONE OUT) ARC TV HDMI OUT (HDCP2.2) AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) (HDCP2.2) 2 HDMI OUT 2 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) AV 3 AV 1 AV 2 AV 4 AV 1 COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PB A AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) HDMI input (1 BD/DVD) AV 3 AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) AV 4 COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 A PR HDMI VIDEO PB PR PB PR VIDEO B B PHONO L AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) PHONO PR PB AV 2 HDMI ZONE OUT L L AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) R AV 2 ZONE OUT L R HDMI R R AUDIO 1 AUDIO (2 TV) GND 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL ZONE 2 6 OPTICAL R GND 3 COAXIAL 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL 6 OPTICAL ZONE 2 L L R R R HDMI input FRONT SURROUND HDMI L ANTENNA (4 RADIO) 75ȍ (4 RADIO) FM 2 OPTICAL L L ANTENNA 75ȍ 1 OPTICAL FRONT SURROUND FM AM AM R TV 1 OPTICAL Projector OPTICAL O AUDIO 1 (OPTICAL or AUDIO) jacks TV (already connected) O Y Audio output (digital optical or analog stereo) • HDMI Control is not available on the HDMI OUT 2 jack. X • If you set “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2”, you can connect a video monitor for Zone2 to the HDMI OUT 2 jack and enjoy videos and audio using the video monitor (p.96). • You do not make an audio cable connection between the TV and the unit in the following cases: – If your TV supports Audio Return Channel (ARC) – If you will receive TV broadcasts only from the set-top box • If you connect a TV that supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit’s power and volume with the TV’s remote control. To use HDMI Control and ARC, you need to configure the HDMI settings on the unit. For details on the settings, see “Information on HDMI” (p.165). En 33 Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players) ■ Component video connection Connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and an audio cable (digital Connect video devices such as BD/DVD players, set-top boxes (STBs) and game consoles to the coaxial or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the audio unit. Depending on the video/audio output jacks available on your video device, choose one of output jacks available on your video device. the following connections. We recommend using an HDMI connection if the video device has an HDMI output jack. Output jacks on video device Input jacks on the unit Y Video Audio The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting Digital coaxial AV 1-2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + COAXIAL) Analog stereo AV 1-2 (COMPONENT VIDEO + AUDIO) Component video (p.137) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COMPONENT VIDEO (A, B), COAXIAL (3, 4, 5) and OPTICAL (1, 2, 6) jacks to another input source. X AV 1-2 (COMPONENT VIDEO) jacks If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on the unit will be determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.109) in the “Option” menu. Y The unit (rear) (HDCP2.2) 2 AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) PR HDMI (HDCP2.2) HDMI OUT ■ HDMI connection PB AV 3 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 (1 BD/DVD) AV 4 TRIGG OUT COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PR PB A 1 VIDEO PR Y PB Connect a video device to the unit with an HDMI cable. Video output (component video) 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL 2 B PHONO L HDMI (AV 1-7) jacks The unit (rear) AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) AV 2 PRE OUT ZONE OUT L R PR PB (SINGLE) 1 R 2 PR HDMI (HDCP2.2) I OUT CP2.2) 1 ARC AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 GND NE AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL ZONE 2 6 OPTICAL FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER R (1 BD/DVD) SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK Y PB PR CENTER SPEAKERS AV 7 L R PB EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENC Y AV 3 AV 4 TRIGGER OUT COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PR PB A ANTENNA (4 RADIO) 1 75ȍ REMOTE 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL IN FM AM SINGLE HDMI output OUT 2 B Y PR PB AV 2 C HDMI PRE OUT ZONE OUT (SINGLE) C ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AM 1 COAXIAL HDMI 2 6 OPTICAL ZONE 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER L HDMI CENTER Video device SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L CENTER L L R R R SINGLE ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP Video device AV 1-2 (COAXIAL) or AV 1-2 (AUDIO) jacks If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-7 on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. Audio output (digital or analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-2 on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. X To connect a video device to the unit with a component video cable and a digital optical cable, use “Input Assignment” (p.137) in the “Setup” menu to assign the COMPONENT VIDEO and OPTICAL jacks to the same input source. En 34 ■ Composite video connection Connect a video device to the unit with a video pin cable and an audio cable (digital coaxial, digital optical, or stereo pin cable). Choose a set of input jacks (on the unit) depending on the audio output jacks available on your video device. Output jacks on video device Input jacks on the unit Video Audio Composite video Digital coaxial AV 1-2 (VIDEO + COAXIAL) Digital optical AV 3 (VIDEO + OPTICAL) Analog stereo AV 1-4 (VIDEO + AUDIO) The unit (rear) HDMI OUT (HDCP2.2) 2 AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) 1 AV 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) AV 3 (1 BD/DVD AV 4 AV 1-4 (VIDEO) jacks COM Y AV A Video output (composite video) VIDEO V B PHONO L AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) R AV ZON L VIDEO R GND 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL V ZONE 2 6 OPTICAL R ANTENNA (4 RADIO) 75ȍ FM AM C C COAXIAL O Video device O L L L R R OPTICAL R Any of AV 1-2 (COAXIAL), AV 3 (OPTICAL), AV 1-4 (AUDIO) jacks Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-4 on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the video device will be output from the unit. En 35 Connecting audio devices (such as CD players) PHONO jacks Audio output (PHONO) PHONO Connect audio devices such as CD players and a turntable to the unit. Depending on the audio PHONO L L output jacks available on your audio device, choose one of the following connections. Y L L R R R R The following explanation is based on the assumption that you have not changed the “Input Assignment” setting (p.137) in the “Setup” menu. As necessary, you can assign the COAXIAL (3, 4, 5) and OPTICAL (1, 2, 6) jacks Ground lead GND GND to another input source. HDMI OUT (HDCP2.2) 2 X AV 2 If you make more than one audio connection for one input source, an audio signal played back on the unit will be AV 3 AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) AV 4 AV 1 A PHONO L AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) PR Audio input jacks on the unit AV 2 PB PR ZONE OUT L R GND 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL ZONE 2 6 OPTICAL R Digital optical PB B R Digital coaxial FRONT SURROUND Turntable (PHONO) L AV 1-2 (COAXIAL) ANTENNA (4 RADIO) AUDIO 3 (COAXIAL) 75ȍ FM AM C AV 3 (OPTICAL) C COAXIAL AUDIO 1-2 (OPTICAL) O Analog stereo Turntable COMPONENT VIDEO Y VIDEO determined according to the “Audio Select” setting (p.109) in the “Option” menu. Audio output jacks on audio device 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 1-4 (AUDIO) The unit (rear) AUDIO 1-3 (AUDIO) Audio device O L L L R R PHONO OPTICAL R Any of AV 1-4, AUDIO 1-3 (COAXIAL, OPTICAL, AUDIO) jacks Audio output (any of digital coaxial, digital optical, analog stereo) If you select the input source by pressing AV 1-4, AUDIO 1-3 or PHONO on the remote control, the audio played back on the audio device will be output from the unit. When connecting a turntable • The PHONO jack of the unit is compatible with an MM cartridge. To connect a turntable with a low-output MC cartridge, use a boosting transformer. • Connecting the turntable to the GND terminal of the unit may reduce noise in the signal. En 36 Connecting to the jacks on the front panel ■ Analog stereo connection Connect an audio playback device (such as CD players) to the unit with a stereo pin cable. Use the VIDEO AUX jack to temporarily connect a playback device to the unit. ENTER Use the USB jack to connect a USB storage device. For details, see “Connecting a USB storage ZONE 2 RETURN device” (p.82). ZONE CONTROL DISPLAY VIDEO AUX PHONES USB Before making a connection, stop playback on the device and turn down the volume on the 5V 1A YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA L L unit. AUDIO R HDMI IN R The unit (front) ■ HDMI connection Connect an HDMI-compatible device (such as game consoles and camcorders) to the unit with an HDMI cable. ENTER ZONE 2 RETURN ZONE CONTROL DISPLAY VIDEO AUX PHONES USB 5V 1A YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA L AUDIO R HDMI IN HDMI Audio device The unit (front) If you select “VIDEO AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX, the audio played back on the device will be output from the unit. Game console X • If you connect devices to both the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack and VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks, the unit outputs audio input through the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack. • If you connect video devices to both the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack and VIDEO AUX (AUDIO) jacks, the unit Camcorder outputs video/audio input through the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack. If you select “VIDEO AUX” as the input source by pressing V-AUX on the remote control, the video/audio played back on the device will be output from the unit. Y • You need to prepare an HDMI cable that matches the output jacks on your device. • The VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack does not support HDCP 2.2. En 37 3 Connecting the radio antennas Connect the supplied radio antenna to the unit. Connecting the AM antenna Hold down Insert Release FM/AM antennas (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) X Connect the supplied FM/AM antennas to the unit. • Unwind only the length of cable needed from the AM antenna unit. Fix the end of the FM antenna to a wall, and place the AM antenna on a flat surface. • The wires of the AM antenna have no polarity. FM antenna AM antenna DAB/FM antenna (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) (HDCP2.2) AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) Connect the supplied DAB/FM antenna to the unit and fix the antenna ends to a wall. HDMI (HDCP2.2) HDMI OUT 2 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) AV 3 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) AV 4 TRIGGER OUT COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PB A PR 1 DAB/FM antenna R 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL VIDEO IN 2 B PHONO L AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) L R PR PB AV 2 ZONE OUT PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK 1 R GND 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 2 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL 6 OPTICAL ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L EXTRA SP2 R SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L The unit (rear) ANTENNA (4 RADIO) 75ȍ FM AV 1 AM (1 BD/DVD) SINGLE AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 TRIGGER OUT COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PR PB A 1 RE 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL VIDEO IN 2 ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP B PHONO L The unit (rear) AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) ZONE OUT L R PR PB AV 2 PRE OUT (SINGLE) SURROUND SUR. BACK 1 R GND 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 2 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL 6 OPTICAL ZONE 2 FRONT SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R Assembling the AM antenna SURROUND L EXTRA SP2 R SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L DAB/FM ANTENNA (4 RADIO) (4 RADIO) 7575ȍ FM AM SINGLE ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP Y • The antenna should be stretched out horizontally. • If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the height, direction or placement of the DAB/FM antenna. En 38 4 Connecting a network cable or preparing the wireless antenna Connect the unit to a router (access point) with a network cable, or prepare the wireless Y antenna for establishing a wireless network connection. • Some security software installed on your PC or the firewall settings of network devices (such as a router) may block the access of the unit to the network devices or the Internet. In these cases, configure the security You can enjoy Internet radio or music files stored on media servers, such as PCs and Network software or firewall settings appropriately. Attached Storage (NAS), on the unit. • Each server must be connected to the same subnet as the unit. • To use the service via the Internet, broadband connection is strongly recommended. Connecting the network cable Preparing the wireless antenna Connect the unit to your router with a commercially-available STP network cable (CAT-5 or higher straight cable). If you want to establish a wireless network connection, stand the wireless antenna up straight. Network Attached Storage (NAS) Internet For information on how to connect the unit to a network device wirelessly, see “Connecting to a network device wirelessly” (p.51). WAN LAN Modem PC Network cable Router The unit (rear) NETWORK AV 6 ( 3 NET ) AV 7 AC IN Mobile device TRIGGER OUT 1 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL REMOTE IN RS-232C Y OUT 2 Do not apply excessive force on the antenna. Doing so may damage it. X • If you want to use a wired (network cable) connection when a wireless connection has been made, set “Network Connection” (p.131) in the “Setup” menu to “Wired”. • If you are using a router that supports DHCP, you do not need to configure any network settings for the unit, as the network parameters (such as the IP address) will be assigned automatically to it. You only need to configure the network settings if your router does not support DHCP or if you want to configure the network parameters manually (p.131). • You can check whether the network parameters (such as IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.141) in the “Information” menu. En 39 5 Connecting other devices 6 Connecting the power cable Connect a device compatible with the trigger function. Before connecting the power cable (Brazil and General models only) Set the switch position of VOLTAGE SELECTOR according to your local voltage. Voltages are AC 110–120/220–240 V, 50/60 Hz. Connecting a device compatible with the trigger function Y Make sure you set VOLTAGE SELECTOR of the unit BEFORE plugging the power cable into an AC wall outlet. Improper setting of VOLTAGE SELECTOR may cause damage to the unit and create a potential fire hazard. The trigger function can control an external device in conjunction with operating the unit (such as powering on/off and input selection). If you have a Yamaha subwoofer that supports a The unit (rear) system connection or a device with a trigger input jack, you can use the trigger function by NETWORK ( 3 NET ) AV 7 connecting the external device to one of the TRIGGER OUT jacks with a monaural mini-plug AC IN GGER OUT REMOTE cable. .1A TAL IN RS-232C VOLTAGE SELECTOR OUT VOLTAGE SELECTOR 220V240V TRIGGER OUT 1-2 jacks The unit (rear) HDMI (HDCP2.2) 3 NETWORK AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 REMOTE IN OUT 2 ROUND SUR. BACK SP1 NCE R CENTER FRONT L RS-232C 2 -AMP 1 System connector jack 2 SUBWOOFER CENTER After all the connections are complete, connect the supplied power cable to the unit and then SPEAKERS R L ( 3 NET ) 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL 1 (SINGLE) ERS 1 TRIGGER OUT 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL E OUT 110V120V TRIGGER OUT EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L CENTER R FRONT L to an AC wall outlet. SINGLE ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP The unit (rear) NETWORK Yamaha subwoofer that supports a system connection ( 3 NET ) AC IN OTE RS-232C To an AC wall outlet OUT X You can configure the trigger function settings in “Trigger Output1” and “Trigger Output2” (p.138) in the “Setup” menu. CENTER En 40 R FRONT L 7 Selecting an on-screen menu language z AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian, Italian and Chinese. 1 2 AUDIO TUNER Select the desired on-screen menu language from English (default), 2 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Language” and the cursor keys (q/w) to select the desired language. Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). X SCENE 1 5 4 If you turn on the unit for the first time, the message regarding the network setup appears. For now, press RETURN and proceed to Step 3. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 3 4 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. The information on the front display is provided in English only. PRESET MOVIE To confirm the setting, press ENTER. X BAND MODE TUNING 6 7 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 En 41 8 Configuring the necessary speaker settings z AV 1 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX If you use any of the following speaker configurations, follow the procedure below to configure the corresponding speaker settings 6 manually before performing YPAO. 5 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET • When using bi-amp connection or Zone2 speakers, select “Power Amp Assign” (p.123), then select your speaker system. • Advanced speaker configuration (p.26) AUDIO • When using the surround speakers for front 5.1-channel system • Using the surround speakers for front 5.1-channel system (Virtual (Virtual CINEMA FRONT), select “Configuration” ! “Layout” ! CINEMA FRONT) (p.20) MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT “Surround” (p.124), then select “Front”. • Using the presence speakers for Dolby Atmos or DTS:X playback (p.22) • When using the presence speakers for Dolby Atmos or DTS:X SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU Configure the corresponding speaker settings. 4 1 2 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 4 Presence” (p.125), then select your front presence speaker If you turn on the unit for the first time, the message regarding the network setup appears. For now, press RETURN and proceed to Step 3. 3 4 5 layout. 7 X Cursor keys ENTER RETURN playback, select “Configuration” ! “Layout” ! “Front Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to select “Speaker” and then “Manual Setup”. En 42 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. 9 Optimizing the speaker settings automatically (YPAO) z AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT The Yamaha Parametric room Acoustic Optimizer (YPAO) function detects speaker connections, measures the distances from them to your ZONE 2 connect it to the YPAO MIC jack on the front panel. settings, such as volume balance and acoustic parameters, to suit your X Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position (same height as your X ears). We recommend the use of a tripod as a microphone stand. You can use the The YPAO function of the unit adopts the YPAO-R.S.C. (Reflected Sound Control) 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE tripod screws to stabilize the microphone. technology that enables to create natural sound fields like a room specifically designed SCENE 1 Place the YPAO microphone at your listening position and listening position(s), and then automatically optimizes the speaker room. MAIN 4 4 YPAO MIC jack for acoustic perfection. Y VOLUME YPAO MIC Note the following regarding YPAO measurement. TOP MENU – Test tones are output at high volume and may surprise or frighten small children. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN – Test tone volume cannot be adjusted. OPTION 1 – Keep the room as quiet as possible. ENTER – Stay in a corner of the room behind the listening position so that you do not become an obstacle between speakers and the YPAO microphone. RETURN DISPLAY The unit (front) RETURN 9 – Do not connect headphones. 2 3 BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 1 2 Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. 4 Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video YPAO 5 microphone from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). X Ear height If you turn on the unit for the first time, the message regarding the network setup appears. For now, press RETURN and proceed to Step 3. 3 The following screen appears on the TV. Turn on the subwoofer and set the volume to half. If the crossover frequency is adjustable, set it to maximum. VOLUME MIN MAX CROSSOVER/ HIGH CUT MIN 9 MAX X To cancel the operation, disconnect the YPAO microphone before starting the measurement. En 43 5 If desired, change the measuring method (multi/single). 1 Use the cursor keys to select “Multi Position” and press ENTER. 2 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and then press ENTER. Single measure Multi measure (5 listening positions) AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET a d e bac MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 4 VOLUME Settings TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Yes Select this option if you will have several listening positions or if you want others to enjoy surround sound. You can take measurements at up to 8 different positions in the room. The speaker settings will be optimized to suit the area defined by those positions (multi measure). No (default) Select this option if your listening position will always be fixed. Take the measurements at only one position. The speaker settings will be optimized to suit that position (single measure). OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Multi measure (1 listening position + front/back/left/right) Multi measure (2 listening positions + front/back) b c a e d c a b d X • If you perform the multi measure, the speaker settings will be optimized for you to enjoy surround sound in a wider space. This completes the preparations. See the following page to start the • If you perform the multi measure, first place the YPAO microphone at the measurement. listening position you will be seated most frequently. When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”: “Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure)” (p.46) When “Multi Position” is set to “No”: “Measuring at one listening position (single measure)” (p.45) En 44 Measuring at one listening position (single measure) 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX To save the measurement results, use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. When “Multi Position” is set to “No”, follow the procedure below for AV 1 3 measurement. It takes about 3 minutes to perform the measurement. AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT 1 To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Measure” and press ENTER. MAIN ZONE 2 The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to SCENE 1 2 3 start the measurement immediately. 4 X PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN The adjusted speaker settings are applied. To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN. X The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. finishes. 4 OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “YES” or “NO” to enable/disable YPAO Volume and press ENTER. Cursor keys ENTER RETURN BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 Y If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error messages” (p.49) or “Warning messages” (p.50). X X • If YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency levels are automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking sounds even at low volume. the measurement results” (p.47). • You can also enable/disable YPAO Volume in “YPAO Volume” (p.107) in the 2 “Option” menu. Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press 5 ENTER. Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit. This completes optimization of the speaker settings. Caution The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on top of AV equipment). En 45 Measuring at multiple listening positions (multi measure) AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT 3 When the measurements at the positions you want to When “Multi Position” is set to “Yes”, follow the procedure below for measure are completed, use the cursor keys to select “CANCEL” and press ENTER. measurement. It takes about 10 minutes to measure 8 listening When you have taken measurements at 8 listening positions, the positions. following screen appears automatically. Y If any error message (such as E-1) or warning message (such as W-1) appears, see “Error MAIN ZONE 2 messages” (p.49) or “Warning messages” (p.50). SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 1 4 To start the measurement, use the cursor keys to select “Measure” and press ENTER. VOLUME The measurement will start in 10 seconds. Press ENTER again to TOP MENU start the measurement immediately. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Cursor keys ENTER RETURN To check the measurement results, select “Result”. For details, see “Checking the measurement results” (p.47). To cancel the measurement temporarily, press RETURN. The following screen appears on the TV when the measurement at the first position finishes. BAND MODE TUNING X X 4 PRESET Use the cursor keys to select “Save/Cancel” and press ENTER. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 5 4 To save the measurement result, use the cursor keys to select “SAVE” and press ENTER. 2 Move the YPAO microphone to the next listening position and press ENTER. Repeat step 2 until measurements at all listening positions (up to 8) have been taken. The adjusted speaker settings are applied. X To finish the measurement without saving the result, select “CANCEL”. En 46 6 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “YES” or “NO” to enable/disable YPAO Volume and press ENTER. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX Checking the measurement results You can check the YPAO measurement results. 1 “Result” and press ENTER. AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT After the measurement, use the cursor keys to select X You can also select “Result” from “Auto Setup” (p.120) in the “Setup” menu, MAIN ZONE 2 which displays the previous measurement results. The following screen appears. SCENE 1 2 3 4 X PROGRAM MUTE • If YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency levels are VOLUME automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural TOP MENU a sounds even at low volume. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN b • You can also enable/disable YPAO Volume in “YPAO Volume” (p.107) in the OPTION “Option” menu. ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 7 c Disconnect the YPAO microphone from the unit. a Measurement result items BAND This completes optimization of the speaker settings. MODE TUNING PRESET b Measurement result details SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT 4 Caution The YPAO microphone is sensitive to heat, so should not be placed anywhere where it could be exposed to direct sunlight or high temperatures (such as on top of AV equipment). c The number of measured positions (when multi measure is performed) 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item. Polarity of each speaker Wiring Reverse: The speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity (+/-). Size of each speaker (cross-over frequency of the subwoofer) Size Large: The speaker can reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. Small: The speaker cannot reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. 3 Distance Distance from the listening position to each speaker Level Output level adjustment for each speaker To finish checking the results and return to the previous screen, press RETURN. En 47 Reloading the previous YPAO adjustments When the speaker settings you have configured manually are not suitable, follow the procedure below to discard the manual settings and AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX reload the previous YPAO adjustments. AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 1 and then “Result” (p.119). 2 SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU In the “Setup” menu, select “Speaker”, “Auto Setup”, 4 Use the cursor keys to select “Setup Reload” and press ENTER. VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC 3 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT 4 En 48 Error messages If any error message is displayed during the measurement, resolve the problem and perform YPAO again. Error message Cause Remedy E-1: No Front SP Front speakers are not detected. E-2: No Sur. SP One of the surround speakers cannot be detected. E-3: No F.PRNS SP One of the front presence speakers cannot be detected. E-4: SBR → SBL A surround back speaker is connected to the R side only. When using only one surround back speaker, you need to connect it to the SINGLE jack (L side). Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speaker. E-5: Noisy The noise is too loud. Keep the room quiet and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If you select “PROCEED”, YPAO takes the measurement again and ignores any noise detected. E-6: Check Sur. Surround back speakers are connected, but no surround speakers are connected. Surround speakers need to be connected in order to use surround back speakers. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then reconnect the speakers. E-7: No MIC The YPAO microphone has been removed. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. E-8: No Signal The YPAO microphone cannot detect test tones. Connect the YPAO microphone to the YPAO MIC jack firmly and follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. E-9: User Cancel The measurement has been canceled. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the measurement again. To cancel the measurement, select “EXIT”. E-10: Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off and on the unit. If this error occurs repeatedly, contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. Follow the on-screen instructions to exit YPAO, turn off the unit, and then check the speaker connections. En 49 Warning messages If a warning message is displayed after the measurement, you can still save the measurement results by following on-screen instructions. However, we recommend you perform YPAO again in order to use the unit with the optimal speaker settings. Warning message Cause Remedy Select “Wiring” in “Result” (p.47) and check the cable connections (+/-) of the speaker identified by “Reverse”. If the speaker is connected incorrectly: W-1: Out of Phase A speaker cable may be connected with the reverse polarity (+/-). Turn off the unit and then reconnect the speaker cable. If the speaker is connected correctly: Depending on the type of speakers or room environment, this message may appear even if the speakers are connected correctly. In this case, you can ignore the message. W-2: Over Distance A speaker is placed more than 24 m (80 ft) from the listening position. Select “Distance” in “Result” (p.47) and move the speaker identified by “>24.00m (>80.0ft)” within 24 m (80 ft) of the listening position. W-3: Level Error There are significant volume differences between the speakers. Select “Level” in “Result” (p.47) and check the speaker identified by “Over ±10.0dB”, then check the usage environment and cable connections (+/-) of each speaker, and the volume of the subwoofer. We recommend using the same speakers or speakers with specifications that are as similar as possible. En 50 10 Connecting to a network device wirelessly ■ Connecting without a wireless router (access point) Connect the unit to a wireless router (access point) or a mobile device by establishing a wireless connection. Connect a mobile device to the unit directly. You can use the application for smartphone / tablet “AV CONTROLLER” (p.9) to control the unit Selecting the connection method from mobiles devices or enjoy music files stored on mobiles devices on the unit. Select a connection method according to your network environment. ■ Connecting with a wireless router (access point) Connect the unit to a wireless router (access point). You can enjoy Internet radio, AirPlay, or music files stored on media servers (PC/NAS) on the Mobile device (such as iPhone) unit. The unit For details on connection, see “Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Internet Direct)” (p.57). Wireless router Y • You cannot use Wireless Direct simultaneously with the wired (network cable) connection (p.39) or the wireless network connection (p.52). Modem • When Wireless Direct is enabled, the both the unit and mobile device cannot be connected to the Internet. In this case, you cannot use the Internet services such as Internet radio. To use the Internet services, terminate the Wireless Direct connection on the mobile device. Mobile device (such as iPhone) The unit For details on connection, see “Connecting the unit to a wireless network” (p.52). Y You cannot use the wireless network connection simultaneously with Wireless Direct (p.57). En 51 Connecting the unit to a wireless network There are several methods to connect the unit to a wireless network. z AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX • Using MusicCast CONTROLLER (p.59) AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT Select a connection method according to your environment. • Sharing the iOS device setting (p.52) ZONE 2 2 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network Connection” and press ENTER. 7 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless (Wi-Fi)” and select “OK”. SCENE 1 Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. • Using the WPS push button configuration (p.53) • Using other connection methods (p.54) MAIN 4 5 6 3 ■ Sharing the iOS device setting 4 You can easily set up a wireless connection by applying the connection PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN settings on iOS devices (iPhone/iPad/iPod touch). ON SCREEN wireless router. OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Before proceeding, confirm that your iOS device is connected to a Y If you set up a wireless connection with this method, the following settings will be initialized. X BAND – Network settings MODE TUNING The checkmark indicates the current setting. PRESET – Bluetooth settings SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 9 0 – USB and network items registered as shortcuts 8 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT – Internet radio stations register to “Favorites” 4 – Account information for the network services 7 8 MEMORY ENT X 3 • You need iOS device with iOS 7 or later. (The following procedure is a setup example for iOS 8.) • This configuration does not work if the security method of your wireless router (access point) is WEP. In this case, use other connection method. 1 2 Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). Y Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the unit via HDMI. 3 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Share Wi-Fi Settings (iOS)” and select “NEXT”. Press ON SCREEN. En 52 9 After checking the on-screen message, use the cursor keys (e/r) and ENTER to select “NEXT”. z AV ■ Using the WPS push button configuration You can easily set up a wireless connection with one push of the WPS button. Y 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX This configuration does not work if the security method of your wireless router (access point) is WEP. In this case, use other connection method. AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 1 2 SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 4 10 On the iOS device, select the unit as the AirPlay speaker in VOLUME the Wi-Fi screen. TOP MENU OPTION RETURN 3 Push the WPS button on the wireless router (access the front display. If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another DISPLAY connection method. BAND MODE TUNING “Press WPS button on Access Point” appears on the front display. When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on Cursor keys ENTER ENTER Hold down INFO (WPS) on the front panel for 3 seconds. point). POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 4 The name of the unit 11 Check the network currently selected and tap “Next”. Tap here to start setup The network currently selected When the sharing process finishes, the unit is automatically connected to the selected network (access point). En 53 About WPS WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) is a standard established by the Wi-Fi Alliance, which allows easy establishment of a wireless home network. ■ Using other connection methods If your wireless router (access point) does not support WPS push button z 5 2 3 6 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT 1 2 AUDIO MAIN ZONE 2 2 3 Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video Y 4 Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU Cursor keys ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER MUSIC 3 4 5 6 SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT 3 4 WPS Button You can set up a wireless connection with the WPS button while viewing the TV screen. Follow the instructions displayed on the TV screen. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Share Wi-Fi Settings (iOS) See “Sharing the iOS device setting” (p.52). Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”. Access Point Scan You can set up a wireless connection by searching for an access point. For details on settings, see “Searching for an access point” (p.55). Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network Connection” and press ENTER. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO The following connection methods are available. unit via HDMI. VOLUME ON SCREEN desired connection method and select “NEXT”. from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). SCENE 1 Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to select the wireless network settings. AV 1 configuration method, follow the procedure below to configure the 8 7 Manual Setting Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless (Wi-Fi)” and select “OK”. PIN Code X The checkmark indicates the current setting. En 54 You can set up a wireless connection by entering the required information (such as SSID) manually. For details on settings, see “Setting up the wireless connection manually” (p.55). You can set up a wireless connection by entering the unit’s PIN code into the wireless router (access point). The method is available if the wireless router (access point) supports the WPS PIN code method. For details on settings, see “Using the PIN code” (p.56). Searching for an access point AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET If you select “Access Point Scan” as the connection method, the unit If you select “Manual Setting” as the connection method, the wireless starts searching for access points. After a while, the list of available connection setting screen appears on the TV. access points appears on the TV screen. You need to setup the SSID (network name), encryption method and 1 AUDIO 1 Setting up the wireless connection manually security key for your network. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired 1 access point and select “NEXT”. The wireless connection setting screen appears on the TV. MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT 2 SCENE 1 2 3 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the SSID of the access point and select “NEXT”. 4 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key and select “NEXT”. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN 2 DISPLAY TUNING Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check the security method of the access point and select “NEXT”. BAND MODE PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and press ENTER to start the connection process. When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on the TV screen. If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another connection method. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. En 55 Settings None, WEP, WPA2-PSK (AES), Mixed Mode 3 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key If you select “PIN Code” as the connection method, the list of available and select “NEXT”. 5 access points appears on the TV screen. If you select “None” in Step 2, this setting is not available. Proceed AV 1 Using the PIN code 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX to Step 4. If you select “WEP”, enter either 5 or 13 character string, or 10 or 26 AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET 1 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired access point and select “NEXT”. hexadecimal digits. The PIN code of the unit appears on the TV screen. If you select other method, enter either 8 to 63 character string, or MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 64 hexadecimal digits. HDMI OUT SCENE 1 2 3 Enter the unit’s PIN code into the wireless router (access point). 4 For details on settings, refer to the instruction manual of the PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU wireless router (access point). VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN 3 ON SCREEN OPTION press ENTER to start the connection process. Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on 4 the TV screen. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “CONNECT” and If “Not connected” appears, repeat from Step 1 or try another press ENTER to start the connection process. PRESET connection method. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT When the connection process finishes, “Completed” appears on ENHANCER PURE DIRECT the TV screen. 3 4 If “Not connected” appears, check that all the information is entered correctly, and repeat from Step 1. 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. En 56 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct) z AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check “Wireless Direct” and select “OK”. Follow the procedure below to connect a mobile device to the unit directly. AUDIO TUNER 7 Y Wireless Direct connection may be insecure since the communication is not strongly encrypted. The unit may operate by playback operation on wireless devices connected MAIN ZONE 2 to the unit without permission. SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 1 2 4 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN The checkmark indicates the current setting. 8 Y Use the cursor keys (q/w) and ENTER to check the desired security method and select “NEXT”. Operations with TV screen are available only when your TV is connected to the Cursor keys ENTER RETURN X Turn on the TV and switch the TV input to display video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. unit via HDMI. DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 3 4 5 6 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Network”. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Network Settings None, WPA2-PSK (AES) Connection” and press ENTER. Y If you select “None”, the connection may be insecure since the communication is not encrypted. En 57 9 AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT 11 Configure the Wi-Fi settings of a mobile device. and select “NEXT”. For details on settings of your mobile device, refer to the If you select “None” in Step 8, this setting is not available. Proceed instruction manual of the mobile device. to Step 10. 1 Enable the Wi-Fi function on the mobile device. 2 Select the SSID displayed in Step 10 from the list of available Otherwise, either 8 to 63 character string, or 64 hexadecimal digits. AUDIO 1 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to enter the security key access points. MAIN ZONE 2 3 SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 12 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN 10 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “OK” and press OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY ENTER to save the setting. The settings made appear on the TV screen. BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT When you are prompted for a password, enter the security key displayed in Step 10. 4 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 The SSID and security key information is required for setup of a mobile device. En 58 11 Connecting to the MusicCast network z AV 1 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX MusicCast is a brand new wireless musical solution from Yamaha, allowing you to share music among all of your rooms with a variety of devices. You can enjoy music from your smartphone, PC, NAS drive and 5 music streaming service anywhere in your house with one easy-to-use AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT 2 3 your mobile device and tap “Setup”. X • Seamlessly control all MusicCast compatible devices with the If you have already connected other MusicCast compatible devices to the network, tap “Settings” and then “Add New Device”. 4 room and play them back simultaneously. MUTE 3 • Play back music from music streaming services. (The compatible music TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU Operate the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application following the on screen instructions, then hold down CONNECT on the front panel of the unit for 5 seconds. VOLUME ON SCREEN Tap the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application icon on products, visit the Yamaha website. • Link a MusicCast compatible device to another device in a different PROGRAM Press z (receiver power) to turn on the unit. application. For more details and a lineup of MusicCast compatible dedicated application “MusicCast CONTROLLER”. SCENE 1 1 2 streaming services may differ depending on your region and product.) OPTION MusicCast CONTROLLER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND CONNECT MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT 4 ENHANCER PURE DIRECT following the onscreen instructions to set up the network. To use the network features on the MusicCast compatible device, you need the dedicated application “MusicCast CONTROLLER” for the operation. Search for the free application “MusicCast CONTROLLER” on Operate the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application 5 Operate the “MusicCast CONTROLLER” application to playback. the App Store or Google Play and install it to your device. Y Adding the unit to the MusicCast network Follow the procedure below to add the unit to the MusicCast network. You can also configure the unit's wireless settings at once. Y • AirPlay and DSD audio cannot be delivered. • When Pure Direct is enabled, input sources other than the network sources and USB cannot be delivered. • If you configure the unit's wireless settings with this method, the signal strength indicator of the front display lights up when the unit is connecting to a network (even if a wired connection is used). • You can interlock the power of MusicCast devices with the power of the unit • The SSID and security key for your network will be needed. (MusicCast master). For details, see “MusicCast Link Power Interlock” (p.133) in the • If your router supports multiple SSID’s (network names), connect the mobile device to the first access point (“SSID 1”, etc.). En 59 “Setup” menu. PLAYBACK AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX Basic playback procedure AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT Input selection keys 1 On-screen input selection Turn on the external devices (such as a TV or BD/DVD a Press ON SCREEN. player) connected to the unit. MAIN ZONE 2 b Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. HDMI OUT SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 4 VOLUME MUTE VOLUME 2 3 Use the input selection keys to select an input source. ENTER. Start playback on the external device or select a radio station. TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN Selecting an HDMI output jack Refer to the instruction manual for the external device. OPTION For details on the following operations, see the corresponding Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN pages. Press HDMI OUT to select an HDMI OUT jack. Each time you press the key, the HDMI OUT jack to be used for signal output changes. Russia models) (p.69) MODE TUNING 1 • Listening to FM/AM radio (except Australia, U.K., Europe and DISPLAY BAND PRESET • Listening to DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE c Use the cursor keys to select the desired input source and press MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT HDMI OUT Sel. OUT 1+2 only) (p.72) ENHANCER PURE DIRECT • Listening to FM radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) (p.76) OUT 1+2 • Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.80) VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL Outputs the same signal at both the HDMI OUT 1 and HDMI OUT 2 jacks. OUT 1 • Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.82) Output the signals at the selected HDMI OUT jack. OUT 2 • Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.85) Off Does not output the signals at the HDMI OUT jacks. • Listening to Internet radio (p.89) • Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay (p.92) X • You can also select an HDMI output jack by selecting a scene (p.61). 4 Press VOLUME to adjust the volume. • When “OUT 1+2” is selected, the unit outputs video signals at the highest resolution X supported by both TVs (or projectors) connected to the unit. (For example, if you have • To mute the audio output, press MUTE. Press MUTE again to unmute. the unit outputs 720p video signals.) connected a 1080p TV to the HDMI OUT 1 jack and a 720p TV to the HDMI OUT 2 jack, • To adjust the treble/bass settings, use the “Option” menu or TONE CONTROL on the front panel (p.107). • If the HDMI OUT 2 jack is assigned to Zone2 (p.136), you can turn on/off each zone by pressing HDMI OUT repeatedly. En 60 Selecting the input source and favorite settings with one touch (SCENE) The SCENE function allows you to select the assigned input source, sound program, HDMI output and various settings with just one touch. You can use up to 12 scenes to register your favorite settings and switch them depending on a playback source. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 Press SCENE. The input source and settings registered to the corresponding scene are selected. The unit turns on automatically when it is in standby mode. By default, the following settings are registered for each scene. SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 4 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN 1 SCENE (SCENE key) SCENE HDMI Output 4 Input (p.60) AV 1 AUDIO 1 NET RADIO TUNER Audio Select (p.109) Auto Auto - - HDMI Output (p.60) OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 OUT 1+2 DSP Program (p.63) Sci-Fi STRAIGHT 7ch Stereo 7ch Stereo Input ON SCREEN 3 2 OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN BAND MODE TUNING Pure Direct Mode (p.128) Auto Auto Auto Auto Enhancer (p.68) Off On On On Enhancer Hi-Res Mode (p.109) On On On On Mode DISPLAY PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT X You can select SCENE 1-4 by pressing SCENE on the remote control. Additionally, you can create 8 scenes (SCENE 5-12) and select those scenes from the “Scene” menu (p.113). 3 4 On-screen scene selection a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER. c Use the cursor keys to select a desired scene and press ENTER. En 61 Registering a scene 1 AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE VOLUME In addition to the default scene assignments (Input, HDMI Output and Mode), you can also include the following setting items as the scene assignments in “Detail” (p.114) in the “Scene” menu. Sound Tone Control, YPAO Volume, Adaptive DRC, Extra Bass Surround CINEMA DSP 3D Mode, Dialogue Lift, Dialogue Level, Subwoofer Trim Video Video Mode X Volume Master Volume • The SCENE link playback function allows you to start playback of an external device Lipsync Lipsync, Delay Speaker Setup Setting Pattern, PEQ Select HDMI OUT 4 Hold down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front display. SCENE1 SET Complete SCENE 1 Set the unit to the condition (such as input source and sound program) that you want to assign to a scene. AUDIO 1 Selecting setting items to be included as scene assignments SCENE VOL. L C R SL SW SR SBL SBR connected to the unit via HDMI. To enable SCENE link playback, specify the device TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION type in “Device Control” (p.114) in the “Scene” menu. • (China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) To control your playback device after selecting a scene with the remote control of the ENTER unit, change the external device assigned to the SCENE keys. For details, refer to RETURN DISPLAY MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 En When the input source is TUNER, USB or NET, the selected radio station or content is assigned. “Supplement for Remote Control” in the supplied CD-ROM. BAND MOVIE X 62 Selecting the sound mode The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs and surround decoders that allow you to enjoy playback sources with your favorite AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX sound mode (such as sound field effect or stereo playback). 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET Selecting a sound program suitable for movies c Use the cursor keys to select a sound program/surround decoder and press ENTER. • Press MOVIE repeatedly. MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 This mode lets you enjoy sound field effects optimized for viewing HDMI OUT video sources, such as movies, TV programs, and games (p.64). SCENE 1 2 3 a Press ON SCREEN. b Use the cursor keys to select “DSP Program” and press ENTER. AUDIO 1 On-screen sound program/surround decoder selection X • You can also switch the sound programs and surround decoder by pressing 4 PROGRAM. Selecting a sound program suitable for music or stereo playback PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN PROGRAM ON SCREEN OPTION • Press MUSIC repeatedly. • You can change the settings of the surround programs and surround decoders in the “DSP Program” menu (p.116). This mode lets you enjoy sound field effects optimized for listening • The sound mode can be applied separately to each input source. music sources or stereo playback (p.65). • You can check which speakers are currently outputting sound by looking at the speaker indicators on the unit’s front panel (p.12) or at the “Audio Signal” screen in Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN • Press SUR. DECODE repeatedly. DISPLAY BAND PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Precaution for enjoying Dolby Atmos® This mode lets you enjoy unprocessed multichannel playback from MODE TUNING the “Information” menu (p.140). Selecting a surround decoder MOVIE MUSIC SUR.DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 2-channel sources (p.67). • Dolby Atmos contents are decoded as Dolby TrueHD or Dolby Digital Plus in the following situations. (Dolby Atmos PCM format is always decoded as Dolby Atmos.) – Neither surround back nor presence speakers are used. Switching to the straight decode mode – Headphones are used (2-channel playback). • Press STRAIGHT. This mode lets you enjoy unprocessed sounds in original channels • When the Dolby Atmos decoder is working, virtual surround processing (such as Virtual CINEMA FRONT) (p.66) does not work. (p.67). Switching to the Pure Direct mode Precaution for enjoying DTS:X™ • Press PURE DIRECT. • When DTS:X contents are played back, you can adjust the volume of dialogue sounds in “DTS Dialogue Control” (p.108) in the “Option” menu. This mode lets you enjoy pure high fidelity sound by reducing the electrical noise from other circuitry (p.68). Enabling Compressed Music Enhancer • Press ENHANCER. This mode lets you enjoy compressed music with additional depth and breadth (p.68). En 63 • When the DTS:X decoder is working, virtual surround processing (such as Virtual CINEMA FRONT) (p.64) does not work. ■ Sound programs suitable for movies (MOVIE) Enjoying stereoscopic sound fields (CINEMA DSP HD3) The following sound programs are optimized for viewing video sources, such as movies, TV programs, and games. MOVIE THEATER The unit is equipped with a variety of sound programs that utilize Yamaha’s original DSP technology (CINEMA DSP HD3). It allows you to easily create sound fields like actual movie Standard This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the surround feeling without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multichannel audio. Its design is based on the concept of the ideal movie theater, in which the audience is surrounded by beautiful reverberations from the left, right, and rear. Spectacle This program delivers the scale and grandeur of spectacular movie productions. It delivers an expansive sound space to match the cinemascope wide-screen, and boasts a broad dynamic range, providing everything from small delicate sounds to powerful loud booms. Sci-Fi This program clearly reproduces the finely elaborated sound design of the latest Sci-Fi and SFX movies. You can enjoy a variety of cinematographically created virtual spaces reproduced with clear separation between dialogue, sound effects, and background music. Adventure This program is ideal for reproducing the sound design of action and adventure movies precisely. The sound field restrains reverberations, but puts emphasis on reproducing a sensation of expansiveness on both sides, powerful space expanded widely to the left and right. The restrained depth creates a clear and powerful space, while also maintaining the articulation of the sounds and the separation of the channels. Drama This program features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres, from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The reverberations are modest, but suitably stereophonic. The sound effects and background music are reproduced with a gentle echo that does not impinge on the articulation of the dialogue. You’ll never get tired listening for long periods. Mono Movie This program reproduces monaural video sources, such as classic movies, in an atmosphere of a good old movie theater. The program creates a pleasant space with depth, by adding breadth and the appropriate reverberation to the original audio. Enhanced This program creates a sound field that emphasizes the dynamic sound transition of 3D object audio. Its design is based on the concept of a movie theater with multi-top speakers, in which the audience is overwhelmed by the natural and powerful sound effects. theaters or concert halls in your room and enjoy natural stereoscopic sound fields. Sound program category MUSIC HD 3 CLASSICAL Hall in Vienna VOL. FPL L C R FPR SL SW SR “CINEMA DSP !” lights up Sound program X • To use the conventional CINEMA DSP, set “CINEMA DSP 3D Mode” (p.128) in the “Setup” menu to “Off”. • The unit creates front Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce 3-dimensional sound fields even when no front presence speakers are connected. However, we recommend using front presence speakers in order to experience the full effect of the sound fields. • The unit creates rear Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers to produce natural 3-dimensional sound fields when front presence speakers are connected. • If a multichannel source (6.1 channels or more) is input when no surround back speakers are connected, the unit creates Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround speakers to add a sense of depth to the rear sound field. • When VPS or VSBS is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display. En 64 ■ Sound programs suitable for music/stereo playback (MUSIC) ENTERTAINMENT Sports This program allows listeners to enjoy the rich vividness of sport broadcasts and light entertainment programs. In sports broadcasts, the commentators’ voices are positioned clearly at the center, while the atmosphere inside the stadium is realistically conveyed by the peripheral delivery of the sounds of the fans in a suitable space. Action Game This program is suitable for action games, such as car racing and fighting games. The reality of, and emphasis on, various effects makes the player feel like they are right in the middle of the action, allowing for greater concentration. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a more dynamic and strong sound field. Roleplaying Game This program is suitable for role-playing and adventure games. This program adds depth to the sound field for natural and realistic reproduction of background music, special effects, and dialogue from a wide variety of scenes. Use this program in combination with Compressed Music Enhancer for a clearer and more spatial sound field. Music Video This program allows you to enjoy videos of pop, rock, and jazz concerts, as if you were there yourself. Immerse yourself in the hot concert atmosphere thanks to the vividness of the singers and solos on stage, a presence sound field that emphasizes the beat of rhythm instruments, and a surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall. Recital/Opera This program controls the amount of reverberations at an optimum level and emphasizes the depth and clarity of human voices to offer the reverberations of an orchestra box in front the listener at the same time as providing the acoustic positioning and feeling of presence on the stage. The surround sound field is relatively moderate, but the data for concert hall effects are used to represent the inherent beauty of music. The listener will not be fatigued even after long hours of opera entertainment. En The following sound programs are optimized for listening to music sources. You can also select stereo playback. CLASSICAL 65 Hall in Munich This program simulates a Munich concert hall with approximately 2,500 seats that uses stylish wood for the interior finishing. Fine, beautiful reverberations spread richly, creating a calming atmosphere. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the arena. Hall in Vienna This program simulates a 1,700-seat, middle-sized concert hall with a shoebox shape that is traditional in Vienna. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reverberations from all around the audience, producing a very full, rich sound. Hall in Amsterdam The large, shoe box shaped hall seats about 2,200 around the circle stage. Reflections are rich and pleasing while the sound travels freely. Church in Freiburg Located in the south of Germany, this grand, stone-built church has a pointed tower at 120 meters in height. Its long and narrow shape and the high ceiling enable the elongated reverberation time and limited initial reflection time. Thus, the rich reverberation rather than the sound itself reproduces the atmosphere of the church. Church in Royaumont This program features the sound field created by the refectory (dining hall) of a beautiful medieval Gothic monastery located in Royaumont on the outskirts of Paris. Chamber This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling, like an audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are suitable for courtly music and chamber music. ■ Enjoying sound field effects without surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA DSP) LIVE/CLUB Village Vanguard The Jazz club is on 7th Avenue, New York. This small club with the low ceiling makes the powerful reflections converge toward the stage located in the center. Warehouse Loft The warehouse resembles some lofts in Soho. Sound reflects off the concrete walls clearly with a lot of energy. Cellar Club This program simulates an intimate concert venue with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field delivers powerful sounds that make you feel as if you are sitting in the front row in front of a small stage. The Roxy Theatre This program creates the sound field of a 460-seat rock music concert venue in Los Angeles. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center left of the hall. The Bottom Line This program creates the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club once. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering real and vibrant sound. If you select one of the sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) when no surround speakers are connected, the unit utilizes Yamaha’s original virtual surround technology to reproduce up to 7-channel surround sound and enable you to enjoy the well-oriented sound field only with the front-side speakers. We recommend using presence speakers in order to enjoy more effective stereoscopic sound field. X When Virtual CINEMA DSP is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display. ■ Enjoying surround sound with 5 speakers placed in front (Virtual CINEMA FRONT) If you have surround speakers but there is no space to place them in the rear of your room, you STEREO can place them in the front (p.20) and enjoy multichannel surround sound using Virtual 2ch Stereo Use this program to mix down multichannel sources to 2 channels. When multichannel signals are input, they are down mixed to 2 channels and output from the front speakers (this program does not utilize CINEMA DSP). 7ch Stereo Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back multichannel sources, the unit mixes down the source to 2 channels, and then outputs the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties. CINEMA FRONT. When “Layout (Surround)” (p.125) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Front”, the unit creates the virtual surround speakers in the rear side to allow you to enjoy multichannel surround sound with the 5 speakers placed in the front. X When Virtual CINEMA FRONT is working, “VIRTUAL” lights up in the front display. Y ■ Enjoying surround sound with headphones (SILENT CINEMA) CINEMA DSP HD3 (p.64) and Virtual CINEMA DSP (p.66) do not work when “2ch Stereo” or “7ch Stereo” is selected. You can enjoy surround or sound field effects, like a multichannel speaker system, with stereo headphones by connecting the headphones to the PHONES jack and selecting a sound program or a surround decoder. En 66 Enjoying unprocessed playback 1 Each time you press the key, the surround decoder changes. You can play back input sources without any sound field effect processing. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET SUR. DECODE †‡ Dsur ■ Playing back in original channels (straight decode) AUDIO When the straight decode mode is enabled, the unit produces stereo MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 1 VOLUME Press STRAIGHT. bDsur Neural:X Uses the DTS Neural:X decoder suitable for your speaker layout. A real acoustic space (including overhead) will be created especially when object-based audio (such as DTS:X content) is played. Neo:6 Cinema Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder (or DTS-ES Matrix decoder) suitable for movies. Sounds will be output from the surround/surround back speakers. Neo:6 Music Uses the DTS Neo:6 decoder (or DTS-ES Matrix decoder) suitable for music. Sounds will be output from the surround/surround back speakers. or disabled. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION STRAIGHT ENTER VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL RETURN DISPLAY Y BAND MODE TUNING SUR.DECODE PRESET speakers are used, select a surround decoder (p.67). SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE STRAIGHT MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO • To enable 6.1/7.1-channel playback from 5.1-channel sources when surround back SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 4 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT • If “Layout (Surround)” (p.125) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Front”, Virtual CINEMA FRONT (p.66) works when multichannel source is played back. ■ Playing back in extended multichannel (surround decoder) The surround decoder enables unprocessed multichannel playback from 2-channel or multichannel sources. L C R SW SR SBR SBL Uses the Dolby Surround decoder suitable for your speaker layout. A real acoustic space (including overhead) will be created especially when object-based audio (such as Dolby Atmos content) is played. Each time you press the key, the straight decode mode is enabled TOP MENU SL Uses the decoder automatically selected by input source. The DTS Neural:X decoder is selected for DTS sources and the Dolby Surround decoder is selected for other sources. produces unprocessed multichannel sounds for multichannel sources. 4 VOL. Auto sound from the front speakers for 2-channel sources such as CDs, and SCENE 1 Press SUR. DECODE to select a surround decoder. Y • When the Dolby Surround decoder is selected, virtual surround processing (such as Virtual CINEMA FRONT) (p.66) does not work. • If the Dolby Surround decoder is selected when only one surround back speaker is used, no sound is output from the surround back speaker (except when a Dolby X Atmos content or a DTS:X content is played). • Speakers that produce sounds will change depending on your speaker system and • When the Neural:X decoder is selected, virtual surround processing (such as Virtual CINEMA FRONT) (p.64) does not work. the selected decode type (p.117). • For details on each decoder, see “Glossary” (p.159). En 67 Enjoying pure high fidelity sound (Pure Direct) When Pure Direct is enabled, the unit plays back the selected source with AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX the least circuitry in order to reduce the electrical noise from other circuitry (such as the front display). It allows you to enjoy Hi-Fi sound AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 quality. 1 2 Compressed Music Enhancer adds depth and breadth to the sound, 3 MUTE TOP MENU it was compressed. This function can be used along with any other sound 4 PURE DIRECT PROGRAM allowing you to enjoy a dynamic sound close to the original sound before Press PURE DIRECT. Each time you press the key, Pure Direct is enabled or disabled. SCENE 1 In addition, Compressed Music Enhancer enhances the quality of uncompressed digital audio (such as 2-channel PCM and FLAC) when R “Hi-Res Mode” (p.109) in the “Option” menu is set to “On” (default). Y POP-UP/MENU When Pure Direct is enabled, the following functions are not available. OPTION – Some settings for the speakers or sound programs ENTER modes. VOL. L VOLUME ON SCREEN Playing back digitally compressed formats (such as MP3, etc.) with enriched sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) 1 Each time you press the key, Compressed Music Enhancer is – Operating the on-screen menu and “Option” menu RETURN TUNING enabled or disabled. DISPLAY – Using the multi-zone function BAND – Viewing information on the front display (when not in operation) MODE Press ENHANCER. Enhancer On PRESET Hi-Res ENHANCER SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL ENHANCER PURE DIRECT “ENHANCER” lights up PURE DIRECT 3 4 ENHANCER Y Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on the following audio sources. – Signals whose sampling frequency is over 48 kHz – DSD audio X You can also use “Enhancer” (p.109) in the “Option” menu to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer. En 68 Listening to FM/AM radio (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or selecting 1 2 3 6 4 7 V-AUX Y 1 2 3 PHONO • The radio frequencies differ depending on the country or region where the unit is TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET 5 AUDIO TUNER being used. The explanation of this section uses a display with frequencies used in U.S.A. model. MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 2 MUTE Press BAND to select a band (FM or AM). FM 87.50MHz 3 VOLUME about a second to search stations automatically. for AM. Depending on your country or region, set the frequency steps to OPTION Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to select 100 kHz for FM and 10 kHz for AM. ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND BAND MODE TUNING PRESET TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT 1 2 3 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT). Set the unit to standby mode. FM 98.50MHz SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL When holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z 4 VOL. STEREO TUNED “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. MAIN ZONE z. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Use the following keys to set a frequency. TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the key for At the factory, the frequency step setting is set to 50 kHz for FM and 9 kHz POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN VOL. 4 (Brazil, Asia and General models only) TOP MENU Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. antennas. 3 Setting the frequency steps PROGRAM 1 2 • If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the FM/AM HDMI OUT SCENE 1 Selecting a frequency for reception from registered radio stations. AV “STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received. STRAIGHT Y Numeric keys “Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of reception range. X You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio reception in “FM Mode” (p.110) in the “Option” menu. When the signal reception for an PROGRAM 3 FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may improve it. Press PROGRAM repeatedly to select “TUNER FRQ STEP”. TUNER FRQ STEP FM50/AM9 4 5 Press STRAIGHT to select “FM100/AM10”. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on again. En 69 Registering favorite radio stations (presets) You can register up to 40 radio stations as presets. Once you have AV 1 2 5 3 6 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their preset numbers. AUDIO MAIN ZONE 2 TUNER ■ Selecting a preset station Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number. 1 2 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio X station. You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals by using You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the “Auto Preset” (p.79). numeric keys after pressing PRESET once. SCENE 1 2 3 Preset 4 ■ Registering a radio station 01:FM 98.50MHz VOL. STEREO TUNED SL PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU 1 POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION Y Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.69) to • “No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered. tune into the desired radio station. • “Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered. • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. ENTER RETURN 2 DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Hold down MEMORY for seconds. X The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.79). station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter, each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty ENHANCER PURE DIRECT L C R SW SR SBR SBL Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number. VOLUME (unused) preset number after the most recently registered number. Numeric keys MEMORY Preset number Preset STEREO TUNED 01:FM 98.50MHz Preset OK VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL X To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into the desired radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and then press MEMORY again. “Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered Preset STEREO TUNED 01:Empty FM 98.50MHz VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL En 70 Operating the radio on the TV ■ Browse screen You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV. AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 1 a Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. c The playback screen is displayed on the TV. AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT TUNER b ■ Playback screen MAIN ZONE 2 SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE b a 4 a Preset station list Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor key (q/w) to select a preset station and press ENTER to tune into it. c VOLUME b Preset number c Operation menu TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor key (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN To close the submenu, press RETURN. a Radio station information Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band (FM/AM) and frequency. Menu MODE TUNING b TUNED/STEREO indicators PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Submenu Memory Auto Preset Automatically registers FM radio stations with strong signals (up to 40 stations). Clear Preset Clear the preset station selected in the list. Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations. “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. “STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received. Utility c Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor key (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu 1 Page Up Function Function Registers the current station to the preset number selected in the list. Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list). 1 Page Down Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the Menu operation keys to redisplay it. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the Menu operation keys to redisplay it. En 71 Listening to DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) AV 1 5 2 3 6 7 V-AUX 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET first DAB radio station as stored in station order. DAB X • If no DAB radio stations are found by an initial scan, the message in Step 1 using MPEG-4 audio codec (AAC+), which has a more efficient appears again. Press ENTER to start an initial scan again. transmission method. PARTY ZONE 2 1 2 • You can check reception strength of each DAB channel label (p.74). HDMI OUT Y SCENE 3 • To perform an initial scan again after some DAB radio stations are stored, select “Init Scan” (p.106) in the “Option” menu. If you perform an initial scan • The unit supports Band III (174 to 240 MHz) only. 4 again, the DAB radio stations currently registered to the preset numbers will • Be sure to check the DAB coverage in your area in that not all areas are currently being PROGRAM MUTE be cleared. covered. For a list of nationwide DAB statuses and worldwide DAB frequencies, check VOLUME L C R SW SR SBR SBL receive DAB+ (an upgraded version of DAB) that allows for more stations TUNER VOL. SL and more stable reception compared to analog signals. The unit can also AUDIO MAIN BBC Radio 4 DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) uses digital signals for clearer sound 4 1 When the initial scan finishes, the unit automatically tunes into the WorldDMB online at http://www.worlddab.org/. TOP MENU X POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION Selecting a DAB radio station for reception For details on the antenna connection, see “Connecting the radio antennas” (p.38). You can select a DAB radio station from the stations stored by the initial ENTER ENTER RETURN scan. Preparing the DAB tuning DISPLAY BAND BAND MODE TUNING PRESET TUNING SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Before tuning into DAB radio stations, follow the procedure below to perform an initial scan. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 2 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. Press BAND to select the DAB band. 1 2 3 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. Press BAND to select the DAB band. Press TUNING repeatedly to select a DAB radio station. DAB The following message appears on the front panel if you have not performed an initial scan yet. Init Scan Press [ENTER] 3 VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL Y • “Off Air” appears when the selected DAB radio station is currently not VOL. available. • When the unit is receiving a secondary station, “2” appears next to “DAB”. Secondary station Press ENTER to start an initial scan. Init Scan >>>------- 30% BBC Radio 4 Daily Service DAB 2 VOL. BBC National VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL X You can watch videos input from external devices while listening to radio by selecting the video input jack in “Video Out” (p.110) in the “Option” menu. En 72 Registering favorite DAB radio stations (presets) You can register up to 40 DAB radio stations as presets. Once you have AV 1 2 5 3 6 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their preset numbers. AUDIO TUNER X You can register up to 40 favorite radio stations each for DAB and FM bands. MAIN ZONE 2 2 3 ■ Registering a DAB radio station as presets 4 Select a DAB radio station and register it to a preset number. PROGRAM MUTE POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. Press BAND to select the DAB band. Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired DAB radio You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the numeric keys after pressing PRESET once. PRESET:01 Follow “Selecting a DAB radio station for reception” OPTION 2 RETURN TUNING X (unused) preset number after the most recently registered To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.71). number. 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 • “Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MUSIC SLEEP Y station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter, PRESET INFO L C R SW SR SBR BAND BAND MODE SL • “No Presets” appears when no DAB radio stations are registered. Hold down MEMORY for seconds. The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio DISPLAY VOL. SBL (p.72) to tune into the desired DAB radio station. ENTER MOVIE 1 2 3 VOLUME 1 TOP MENU Tune into a registered DAB radio station by selecting its preset number. station. SCENE 1 ■ Selecting a preset DAB radio station 4 Preset number MEMORY Preset 01:BBC Radio 4 Preset OK VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL X To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into the desired DAB radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and then press MEMORY again. “Empty” (not in use) or “Overwrite?” (in use) Preset 02:Empty BBC Radio 4 VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL En 73 Displaying the DAB information The unit can receive various types of DAB information when it is tuned into a DAB radio station. AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 TUNER 1 2 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes. Info Program Type 4 RETURN SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER VOL. Item name POP-UP/MENU OPTION 100 [best]). Press INFO. VOLUME ON SCREEN You can check reception strength of each DAB channel label (0 [none] to Tune into the desired DAB radio station. SCENE displayed item appears. DAB DISPLAY Checking reception strength of each DAB channel label Classic FM Classic Music 1 2 3 4 5 BAND TUNING VOL. SL Use the cursor keys to select “Tune AID” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select the desired DAB DAB channel label SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO 3 Press OPTION. Tune AID 12B Level: 80 L C R SW SR SBR SBL Information PRESET Press BAND to select the DAB band. channel label. BAND MODE Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. 4 DLS (Dynamic Label Segment) Information on the current station Ensemble Label Ensemble name Program Type Station genre Date And Time Current date and time Audio Mode Audio mode (monaural/stereo) and bit rate CH Label/Freq. Channel label and frequency Signal Quality Signal reception quality (0 [none] to 100 [best]) DSP Program Sound mode name Audio Decoder Decoder name X Some information may not be available depending on the selected DAB radio station. En 74 6 VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL Reception strength To exit from the menu, press OPTION. ■ DAB frequency information The unit supports Band III (174 to 240 MHz) only. Frequency Channel label Frequency Channel label 174.928 MHz 5A 225.648 MHz 12B 176.640 MHz 5B 227.360 MHz 12C 178.352 MHz 5C 229.072 MHz 12D 180.064 MHz 5D 230.784 MHz 13A 181.936 MHz 6A 232.496 MHz 13B 183.648 MHz 6B 234.208 MHz 13C 185.360 MHz 6C 235.776 MHz 13D 187.072 MHz 6D 237.488 MHz 13E 188.928 MHz 7A 239.200 MHz 13F 190.640 MHz 7B 192.352 MHz 7C 194.064 MHz 7D 195.936 MHz 8A 197.648 MHz 8B 199.360 MHz 8C 201.072 MHz 8D 202.928 MHz 9A 204.640 MHz 9B 206.352 MHz 9C 208.064 MHz 9D 209.936 MHz 10A 211.648 MHz 10B 213.360 MHz 10C 215.072 MHz 10D 216.928 MHz 11A 218.640 MHz 11B 220.352 MHz 11C 222.064 MHz 11D 223.936 MHz 12A En 75 Listening to FM radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) You can tune into a radio station by specifying its frequency or selecting from registered radio stations. AV 1 5 2 3 6 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT Y AUDIO TUNER Registering favorite FM radio stations (presets) If you cannot obtain good reception on the radio, adjust the direction of the DAB/FM You can register up to 40 FM radio stations as presets. Once you have antennas. registered stations, you can easily tune into them by selecting their preset numbers. MAIN ZONE 2 Selecting a frequency for reception SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 1 2 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN “Auto Preset” (p.79). Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. ■ Registering a radio station Press BAND to select the FM band. Select a radio station manually and register it to a preset number. FM 87.50MHz OPTION VOL. 1 ENTER RETURN BAND BAND TUNING Follow “Selecting a frequency for reception” (p.76) to tune into the desired radio station. DISPLAY MODE X You can automatically register FM radio stations that have strong signals by using 4 3 PRESET Use the following keys to set a frequency. 2 Hold down MEMORY for seconds. PRESET TUNING: Increase/decrease the frequency. Hold down the key for TUNING about a second to search stations automatically. The first time that you do register a station, the selected radio Numeric keys: Enter a frequency directly. For example, to select station will be registered to the preset number “01”. Thereafter, 98.50 MHz, press “9”, “8”, “5” and “0” (or ENT). each radio station you select will be registered to the next empty SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Numeric keys MEMORY (unused) preset number after the most recently registered FM 98.50MHz number. VOL. STEREO TUNED SL L C R SW SR SBR Preset number SBL “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. Preset “STEREO” also lights up when a stereo signal is received. Y “Wrong Station!” appears when you enter a frequency that is out of reception range. STEREO TUNED 01:FM 98.50MHz Preset OK VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL X To select a preset number for registering, press MEMORY once after tuning into X the desired radio station, press PRESET to select a preset number, and then You can switch between “Stereo” (stereo) and “Mono” (monaural) for FM radio reception in “FM Mode” (p.110) in the “Option” menu. When the signal reception for an press MEMORY again. “Empty” (not in use) or the frequency currently registered FM radio station is unstable, switching to monaural may improve it. Preset STEREO TUNED En 76 01:Empty FM 98.50MHz VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL ■ Selecting a preset station Tune into a registered radio station by selecting its preset number. AV 1 5 2 3 6 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT AUDIO MAIN ZONE 2 TUNER 1 2 3 2 3 Press BAND to select the FM band Press PRESET repeatedly to select the desired radio station. SCENE 1 Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. You can also enter a preset number (01 to 40) directly by using the 4 numeric keys after pressing PRESET once. PROGRAM MUTE Preset VOLUME 01:FM 98.50MHz VOL. STEREO TUNED SL TOP MENU ON SCREEN L C R SW SR SBR SBL POP-UP/MENU Y OPTION • “No Presets” appears when no radio stations are registered. ENTER • “Wrong Num.” appears when an invalid number is entered. RETURN DISPLAY • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. BAND BAND MODE TUNING PRESET PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE X To clear preset stations, use “Clear Preset” or “Clear All Preset” (p.79). MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT 4 Numeric keys En 77 Radio Data System tuning Program Service Program service name Program Type Current program type Radio Text Information on the current program Clock Time Current time data, such as “Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text” and DSP Program Sound mode name “Clock Time”, when it is tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting Audio Decoder Decoder name (U.K., Europe and Russia models only) Radio Data System is a data transmission system used by FM stations in AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 3 PHONO many countries. The unit can receive various types of Radio Data System AUDIO 1 2 TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT station. MAIN ZONE 2 ■ Displaying the Radio Data System information SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 4 1 VOLUME Tune into the desired Radio Data System broadcasting station. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Y X OPTION ENTER We recommend using “Auto Preset” to tune into the Radio Data System broadcasting stations (p.79). RETURN DISPLAY 2 BAND MODE TUNING PRESET MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Press INFO. Each time you press the key, the displayed item changes. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO STEREO TUNED Info Program Type VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL Item name About 3 seconds later, the corresponding information for the displayed item appears. Frequency (always displayed) STEREO TUNED FM 98.50MHz CLASSICS VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL Information En 78 “Program Service”, “Program Type”, “Radio Text”, and “Clock Time” are not displayed if the radio station does not provide the Radio Data System service. Operating the radio on the TV ■ Browse screen You can view the radio information or select a radio station on the TV. AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 1 a Press TUNER to select “TUNER” as the input source. c The playback screen is displayed on the TV. AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT TUNER b ■ Playback screen MAIN ZONE 2 SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE b a 4 Displays the list of preset stations. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a preset station and press ENTER to tune into it. 仮画面 VOLUME a Preset station list c b Preset number c Operation menu TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN To close the submenu, press RETURN. a Radio station information Menu Displays the information of the selected radio station such as the selected band (DAB/FM) and frequency. MODE TUNING (U.K., Europe and Russia models only) PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT When tuning into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.78), the Radio Data System information (“Program Service”, “Program Type,” “Radio Text” and “Clock Time”) is also displayed. Submenu Memory Auto Preset Automatically registers FM radio stations with strong signals (up to 40 stations). Clear Preset Clear the preset station selected in the list. Clear All Preset Clear all the preset stations. Utility b TUNED/STEREO indicators Function Registers the current station to the preset number selected in the list. “TUNED” lights up when a signal is received from a radio station. “STEREO” lights up when a stereo signal is received. 1 Page Up c Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu 1 Page Down Moves to the previous/next page of the list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. Function Browse Moves to the browse screen (preset station list). Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. Y (U.K., Europe and Russia models only) Only Radio Data System broadcasting stations are stored automatically by “Auto Preset”. En 79 Playing back music via Bluetooth You can play back music files stored on a Bluetooth device (such as smartphones) on the unit. Also, you can enjoy audio played back on the AV 1 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX unit using Bluetooth speakers/headphones. 5 AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET Playing back Bluetooth device music on the unit Follow the procedure below to establish a Bluetooth connection between a Bluetooth device (such as smartphones) and the unit, and BLUETOOTH play back music stored the Bluetooth device on the unit. MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT The unit SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 4 Bluetooth device (such as smartphones) Y The unit does not support video playback via Bluetooth. 1 VOLUME Press BLUETOOTH to select “Bluetooth” as the input source. TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN 2 OPTION On the Bluetooth device, select the unit (network name of the unit) from the available device list. ENTER RETURN The unit DISPLAY Bluetooth speakers/ headphones A connection between the Bluetooth device and the unit will be made. BAND MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 3 4 Y If the pass key is required, enter the number “0000”. • To use the Bluetooth function, set “Bluetooth” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu to “On”. • You cannot make Bluetooth connections to a Bluetooth device (such as smartphones) and Bluetooth speakers/headphones at the same time. 3 On the Bluetooth device, select a song and start playback. The playback screen (artist name, album name and song title) is • Stand the wireless antenna upright for connecting to a Bluetooth device wirelessly. displayed on the TV. For details, see “Preparing the wireless antenna” (p.39). X X For details on supported Bluetooth devices, see “Supported devices and file formats” • If the unit detects the Bluetooth device previously connected, the unit automatically connects to the Bluetooth device after Step 1. To establish another Bluetooth (p.163). connection, first terminate the current Bluetooth connection. • To terminate the Bluetooth connection, perform one of the following operations. – Perform the disconnect operation on the Bluetooth device. – Select an input source other than “Bluetooth” on the unit. – Select “Disconnect” in “Setup menu items” (p.120) in the “Setup” menu. • You can use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. En 80 Enjoying audio using Bluetooth speakers/headphones 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT Bluetooth speakers/headphones. between Bluetooth speakers/headphones and the unit, and enjoy audio AUDIO 1 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to check the desired Follow the procedure below to establish a Bluetooth connection AV 1 4 Input selection keys played back on the unit using Bluetooth speakers/headphones. Y • To use this function, set “Transmitter” (p.134) in the “Setup” menu to “On”. MAIN ZONE 2 • AirPlay and DSD audio cannot be delivered. SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 4 1 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND 2 3 Use the input selection keys (except BLUETOOTH) to X select an input source. The checkmark indicates the Bluetooth device currently selected. 5 Press ON SCREEN. While the Bluetooth speakers/headphones are in the pairing mode, use the cursor keys to select “CONNECT” and press ENTER. Use the cursor keys and ENTER to select “Setup” ! “Bluetooth” ! “Audio Send” ! “Device Search” and “OK”. MODE TUNING PRESET The list of available Bluetooth devices (BD addresses) is displayed. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 When the connection process finishes, audio played back on the unit will be reproduced from the Bluetooth speakers/headphones. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. X To terminate the Bluetooth connection, perform the disconnect operation on the Bluetooth speakers/headphones. Y • AirPlay and DSD audio cannot be delivered. • When the Pure Direct mode is enabled, input sources other than the network sources and USB cannot be delivered. En 81 Playing back music stored on a USB storage device You can play back music files stored on a USB storage device on the unit. 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT Playback of USB storage device contents The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (FAT16 or FAT32 AV USB format). Follow the procedure below to operate the USB storage device contents X and start playback. For details on playable file formats, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.163). You can control the USB memory device with the menu displayed on the TV screen. MAIN ZONE 2 Connecting a USB storage device SCENE 1 2 3 4 1 Press USB to select “USB” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. PROGRAM MUTE VOLUME 1 Connect the USB storage device to the USB jack. The unit (front) TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU (CONNECT) PROGRAM ON SCREEN ENTER OPTION RETURN DISPLAY PHONES ENTER USB 5V RETURN 1A YPAO MIC SILENT CINEMA DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING X PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC If playback is ongoing on your USB storage device, the playback screen is ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT displayed. 3 4 USB storage device USB Connected VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL X If the USB storage device contains many files, it may take time to load the them. In this case, “Loading...” appears in the front display. Y • Stop playback of the USB storage device before disconnect it from the USB jack. • Connect a USB memory device directly to the USB jack of the unit. Do not use extension cables. • The unit cannot charge USB devices while it is in standby mode. En 82 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is displayed. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX ■ Browse screen a b c e AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT d MAIN ZONE 2 a Status indicators SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 4 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING X b List name • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. c Contents list • To return to the top screen during menu operations on the browse screen, OPTION ENTER hold down RETURN. Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Displays the list of USB storage device contents. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. • Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected. d Item number/total • If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden e Operation menu files) during playback, playback stops automatically. • You can register your favorite items as shortcuts and access them directly by PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.84) and playback status (such as play/pause). Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. selecting the shortcut numbers (p.100). MUSIC Menu ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Function 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down En 83 Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. ■ Playback screen ■ Shuffle/repeat settings You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for playback of USB storage a b device contents. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX c AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 2 PROGRAM MUTE X Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.84) and playback status (such as play/pause). 4 • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. b Playback information VOLUME Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. a Status indicators 3 When “USB” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. 2 SCENE 1 1 • Texts in parentheses denote indicators on the front display. Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. TOP MENU Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND OPTION Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER RETURN c Operation menu 3 Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Item Shuffle (Shuffle) Function MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. Setting Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “x” appears on the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears on the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the TV screen. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT X Repeat (Repeat) You can use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. 4 En 84 Function To exit from the menu, press OPTION. Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) You can play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS on the unit. Media sharing setup Y To play back music files stored on your PC or DLNA-compatible NAS, first you need to configure • To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router (p.39). You can check whether the media sharing setting on each music server. the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network Connection” (p.131) in the “Information” menu. ■ For a PC with Windows Media Player installed • The audio may be interrupted while using the wireless network connection. In this case, use the wired network connection. The setting procedure may vary depending on the PC and Windows Media Player version (The X following procedure is a setup example for Windows Media Player 12). For details on playable file formats, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.163). 1 2 3 4 5 Start Windows Media Player 12 on your PC. Select “Stream”, then “Turn on media streaming”. Click “Turn on media streaming”. Select “Allowed” from the drop-down list next to the unit’s model name. Click “OK” to exit. X For details on media sharing settings, refer to Windows Media Player help. ■ For a PC or a NAS with other DLNA server software installed Refer to the instruction manual for the device or software and configure the media sharing settings. En 85 Playback of PC music contents AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 3 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. Follow the procedure below to operate the PC music contents and start If a song is selected, playback starts and the playback screen is playback. displayed. You can control the PC/NAS with the menu displayed on the TV screen. AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 NET 1 Press NET repeatedly to select “SERVER” as the input source. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 4 X VOLUME • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN • To return to the top screen during menu operations on the browse screen, hold down OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY RETURN. • Files not supported by the unit cannot be selected. Cursor keys ENTER RETURN during playback, playback stops automatically. If playback of a music file selected from the unit is ongoing on your PC, the MODE TUNING • If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) X BAND PRESET playback screen is displayed. MUSIC ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT 2 • You can register your favorite items as shortcuts and access them directly by selecting the shortcut numbers (p.100). SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE Use the cursor keys to select a music server and press ENTER. En 86 ■ Browse screen a b c AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX ■ Playback screen a b 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 d 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE a Status indicators a Status indicators SCENE 1 4 Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.88) and playback status (such as play/pause). POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. Displays the list of PC content. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER BAND MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET Display the current shuffle/repeat settings (p.88) and playback status (such as play/pause). b Playback information b List name VOLUME c Contents list TOP MENU c e AUDIO 1 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. c Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. d Item number/total e Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Function Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT Menu MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Function ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down 10 Pages Up X • You can use the external device operation keys on the remote control to control Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. En playback (some functions may not work depending on the PC/NAS). • You can also use a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. For details, see “DMC Control” (p.112). 87 ■ Shuffle/repeat settings You can configure the shuffle/repeat settings for the playback of PC music content. AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX 1 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 2 2 3 Use the cursor keys to select “Shuffle” (Shuffle) or “Repeat” (Repeat) and press ENTER. SCENE 1 When “SERVER” is selected as the input source, press OPTION. AUDIO X 4 • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME • Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY OPTION 3 Item Cursor keys ENTER RETURN Shuffle (Shuffle) BAND MODE TUNING Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. PRESET Setting Off (Off) Turns off the shuffle function. On (On) Plays back songs in the current album (folder) in random order. “x” appears on the TV screen. Off (Off) Turns off the repeat function. One (One) Plays back the current song repeatedly. “c” appears on the TV screen. All (All) Plays back all songs in the current album (folder) repeatedly. “v” appears on the TV screen. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Repeat (Repeat) 4 Function To exit from the menu, press OPTION. En 88 Listening to Internet radio You can listen to Internet radio stations from all over the world. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX • To use this function, the unit must be connected to the Internet (p.39). You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET Playback of Internet radio Y AV NET 1 source. the unit in “Network” (p.131) in the “Information” menu. The browse screen is displayed on the TV. • You may not be able to receive some Internet radio stations. MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT • The unit uses the airable.Radio service. airable is a service of Tune In GmbH. • This service may be discontinued without notice. SCENE 1 2 Press NET repeatedly to select “NET RADIO” as the input 3 4 • Folder names are different depending on the language. PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Cursor keys ENTER RETURN 2 MODE TUNING Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. If an Internet radio station is selected, playback starts and the BAND PRESET playback screen is displayed. SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 X • To return to the previous screen, press RETURN. • You can register your favorite items as shortcuts and access them directly by selecting the shortcut numbers (p.100). En 89 ■ Browse screen a b c AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX ■ Playback screen a b 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 d SCENE 1 2 3 4 a Playback indicator a Playback indicator b List name b Playback information Displays the station name, album name, song title, and elapsed time. c Contents list PROGRAM MUTE VOLUME Displays the list of Internet radio content. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER to confirm the selection. TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN e Operation menu RETURN DISPLAY Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. c Operation menu Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. d Item number/total OPTION ENTER c e AUDIO 1 Press the cursor key (r) and then use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. Menu Function Add to favorites Adds the current station to the “Favorites” folder (p.91). Browse Moves to the browse screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. BAND Menu MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Add to favorites (Remove from favorites) Function Adds/removes the station selected in the list to/from the “Favorites” folder (p.91). 4 1 Page Up Moves to the previous/next page of the list. 1 Page Down X • You can use the external device operation key (s) on the remote control to stop playback. 10 Pages Up Moves 10 pages forward/backward. 10 Pages Down Return Returns to the higher-level list. Now Playing Moves to the playback screen. Screen Off Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. En 90 • Some information may not be available depending on the station. Registering favorite Internet radio stations (Favorites) By registering your favorite Internet radio stations to “Favorites”, you can quickly access to them from the “Favorites” folder in the browse AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX screen. X AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT You can also register up to 40 favorite USB and network contents or Bluetooth input source as shortcuts (p.100). MAIN ZONE 2 ■ Registering the station on the browse/playback screen SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 4 1 VOLUME screen or start playback of it to display the playback screen. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Select the desired Internet radio station in the browse 2 Press the cursor key (r) to select “Add to favorites” and press ENTER. BAND MODE TUNING The selected station is added to the “Favorites” folder. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Radio stations registered to favorites are displayed with “S”. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Browse screen X To remove a station that is registered to favorites, select the station and then select “Remove from favorites”. En 91 Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay The AirPlay function allows you to play back iTunes/iPod music on the unit via network. Playback of iTunes/iPod music contents iTunes Follow the procedure below to play back iTunes/iPod music contents on the unit. PC (wired or wireless) 1 Router Turn on the unit, and start iTunes on the PC or display the playback screen on the iPod. The unit If the iTunes/iPod recognizes the unit, the AirPlay icon appears. iTunes (example) (wired or wireless) iPhone/iPad/iPod touch iOS 10 (example) Y If the icon does not appear, check whether the unit and PC/iPod are connected to the router properly. Y 2 • To use this function, the unit and your PC or iPod must be connected to the same router. You can check whether the network parameters (such as the IP address) are properly assigned to the unit in “Network” (p.141) in the On the iTunes/iPod, click (tap) the AirPlay icon and select the unit (network name of the unit) as the audio output device. “Information” menu. • When using a multiple SSID router, access to the unit might be restricted depending on the SSID to connect. 3 Connect the iPod to the SSID which can access the unit. Select a song and start playback. X The unit automatically selects “AirPlay” as the input source and starts playback. • For details on supported iPod devices, see “Supported devices and file formats” (p.163). The playback screen is displayed on the TV. • You can restrict access to the unit using the AirPlay Password (p.103). X • You can turn on the unit automatically when starting playback on iTunes or iPod by setting “Network Standby” (p.132) in the “Setup” menu to “On”. • You can edit the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on iTunes/iPod in “Network Name” (p.133) in the “Setup” menu. • You can adjust the unit’s volume from the iTunes/iPod during playback. To disable volume controls from iTunes/iPod, set “Volume Interlock” (p.112) in the “Input” menu to “Off”. Caution When you use iTunes/iPod controls to adjust volume, the volume may be unexpectedly loud. This could result in damage to the unit or speakers. If the volume suddenly increases during playback, stop playback on the iTunes/iPod immediately. En 92 ■ Playback screen a b AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX c AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 a Playback indicator SCENE 1 2 3 4 b Playback information Displays the artist name, album name, song title, and elapsed/remaining time. PROGRAM MUTE Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select scrollable information. VOLUME c Operation menu TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN Press the cursor key (r) to select an item. Press ENTER to confirm the selection. OPTION ENTER RETURN DISPLAY Menu operation keys Cursor keys ENTER Menu Screen Off Function Closes the screen display and shows the background. Press one of the menu operation keys to redisplay it. BAND MODE TUNING External device operation keys PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT X You can use the external device operation keys (a, s, d, f, g) on the remote control to control playback. 4 En 93 Playing back videos/audio in multiple rooms (multi-zone) The multi-zone function allows you to play back different input sources in the room where the ■ Enjoying videos/music in another room unit is installed (main zone) and in another room (Zone2). You can enjoy videos/music using a TV placed in another room. For example, while you are watching TV in the living room (main zone), another person can listen to radio in the study room (Zone2). Enjoying videos/music using a TV and speakers • Audio signals that can be output to Zone2 vary depending on how you connect the device in Zone2 to the unit’s output jacks. For details, see “Multi-zone output” (p.165). Video (HDMI) Multi-zone configuration examples Audio (SPEAKERS or ZONE OUT) Since there are many possible ways to use the unit in a multi-zone configuration, we recommend that you consult with your nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center Guest room (Zone2) about the multi-zone connections that best meet your requirements. ■ Enjoying music in another room Living room (main zone) Connections TV: p.96 You can enjoy music using speakers placed in another room. Speakers (connecting to the unit directly): p.30 Speakers (using an external amplifier): p.95 Enjoying videos/music using only a TV Audio (SPEAKERS or ZONE OUT) Study room (Zone2) Video/audio (HDMI) Living room (main zone) Connections Speakers (connecting to the unit directly): p.30 Study room (Zone2) Speakers (using an external amplifier): p.95 Living room (main zone) Connection TV: p.96 En 94 Preparing Zone2 ■ Connecting speakers to play back audio Connect speakers to play back audio in Zone2. The connection method varies depending on Connect the device that will be used in Zone2 to the unit. the amplifier being used (the unit or an external amplifier). Caution Using the unit’s internal amplifier • Remove the unit’s power cable from the AC wall outlet before connecting speakers or an external amplifier. Connect the speakers placed in Zone2 to the unit with speaker cables. For details, see • Ensure that the bare wires of the speaker cable do not touch one another or come into contact with the unit’s metal parts. Doing so may damage the unit or the speakers. If the speaker cables short circuit, “Check SP Wires” will appear on the front display when the unit is turned on. “Connecting Zone2 speakers” (p.30). Using an external amplifier Connect the external amplifier placed in Zone2 to the unit with a stereo pin cable and connect speakers to the external amplifier. The unit (rear) HDMI (HDCP2.2) HDMI OUT (HDCP2.2) 2 AV 2 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) AV 1 (1 BD/DVD) AV 3 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 AV 4 (1 BD/DVD) AV 4 ZONE OUT (ZONE2) jacks COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 PB A PR ZONE OUT VIDEO B AUDIO 2 Y AUDIO 3 PR PB AV 2 PRE OUT ZONE OUT L (SINGLE) L R R 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL 6 OPTICAL ZONE 2 R FRONT SURROUND L SURROUND SUR. BACK R SUB EXTRA S SURROUND ZONE 2 ANTENNA (4 RADIO) 75ȍ FM AM ZONE External amplifier Audio input (analog stereo) L R AUDIO Zone2 Main zone X You can adjust the volume for Zone2 output with the unit. When using an external amplifier with volume control, set “Volume” (p.135) in the “Setup” menu to “Fixed”. En 95 ■ Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio • Videos/audio interruptions may happen in another zone when any of the following operations is performed. – Tuning on/off a TV connected to the unit via HDMI or switching the TV input Connect an HDMI-compatible device (such as a TV) to play back videos/audio at Zone2. – Enabling/disabling a zone output or selecting its input source Y – Changing the sound mode or audio settings • To watch videos played back on a video device at Zone2, you need to connect the video device to the unit with an HDMI cable (p.34). • We recommend that you disable HDMI Control on the playback devices connected to the unit. ■ Operating the unit from Zone2 (remote connection) • On-screen operations are not available for Zone2. You can operate the unit or external devices from Zone2 using the remote control supplied with each device if you connect an infrared signal receiver/emitter to the unit’s REMOTE HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack The unit (rear) HDMI OUT HDMI OUT (HDCP2.2) 2 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) IN/OUT jacks. AV 1 2(1 B (HDCP2.2) X (ZONE OUT) AV 1 AV 2 (1 BD/DVD) AV 3 AV 4 Y HDMI (China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) VIDEO PHONO L AUDIO 1 AUDIO 2 You can operate external devices with the supplied remote control if you register a remote control code for each Y AUDIO 3 (2 TV) L device. For details, refer to “Supplement for Remote Control” on the supplied CD-ROM. R R GND 1 OPTICAL 2 OPTICAL 3 COAXIAL 4 COAXIAL 5 COAXIAL 6 OPTICAL ZO REMOTE IN/OUT jacks The unit (rear) ANTENNA (4 RADIO) 75ȍ FM AM HDMI (HDCP2.2) HDMI OUT (Example: using a TV) (HDCP2.2) 2 HDMI input AV 2 DVD) 1 ARC (ZONE OUT) 1 AV 3 AV 1 AV 2 AV 3 NETWO AV 4 AV 5 AV 6 AV 7 (1 BD/DVD) AV 4 TRIGGER OUT COMPONENT VIDEO Y AV 1 Y AV 2 A PB PR PB PR 1 IN OUT 2 IN B PRE OUT ZONE OUT (SINGLE) REMOTE REMOTE 12V 0.1A MAX. TOTAL HDMI OUT 1 HDMI 2 AXIAL 5 COAXIAL 6 OPTICAL ZONE 2 FRONT SURROUND SUR. BACK SUBWOOFER CENTER SPEAKERS R SURROUND L R EXTRA SP2 SURROUND BACK L R EXTRA SP1 F.PRESENCE L CENTER TENNA RADIO) AM SINGLE ZONE 2 ZONE 2/BI-AMP Infrared signal transmitter Infrared signal receiver Zone2 External device (such as a CD player) Main zone Remote control (supplied with each device) To assign the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack to Zone2, set “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu to “Zone2”. X • When the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is assigned to Zone2, you can enable/disable the audio output from the Zone2 HDMI OUT 2 jack by setting “Audio Output” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to “On” or “Off” (default). Main zone • You can also use speakers placed in Zone2 to output audio (p.30). En 96 Remote connections between Yamaha products An infrared signal transmitter is not required if you are using Yamaha products that support remote connections, as the unit does. You can transmit remote control signals by connecting the REMOTE IN/OUT jacks with monaural mini-jack cables and an infrared signal receiver. REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE REMOTE IN/OUT jacks REMOTE IN IN OUT OUT Infrared signal receiver Yamaha products (up to six, including the unit) Remote control Zone2 En 97 Controlling Zone2 z AV 1 5 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 3 PHONO AUDIO 1 2 Input selection keys 1 2 4 station. Set MAIN/ZONE2 to “ZONE2”. Refer to the instruction manual for the external device. For details on the following operations, see the corresponding Press z (receiver power). pages. Each time you press the key, Zone2 is enabled or disabled. TUNER USB BLUETOOTH NET When Zone2 is enabled, “ZONE2” lights up in the front display. MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT MAIN/ZONE2 SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE 4 VOLUME 3 Use the input selection keys to select an input source. Y output” (p.165). TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU OPTION ENTER • You cannot select Bluetooth, USB and network sources exclusively for each • Playing back music stored on a USB storage device (p.82) • Listening to Internet radio (p.89) • Playing back iTunes/iPod music with AirPlay (p.92) BAND Y PRESET • The on-screen operations are not available for Zone2. Use the front display or SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MUSIC web control (p.101) to control Zone2. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO only) (p.76) • Playing back music via Bluetooth (p.80) • Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS) (p.85) DISPLAY TUNING only) (p.72) for the main zone, the input source for the main zone also switches to MODE MOVIE Russia models) (p.69) • Listening to DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models zone. For example, if you select “SERVER” for Zone2 when “USB” is selected “SERVER”. RETURN • Listening to FM/AM radio (except Australia, U.K., Europe and • Listening to FM radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models • Audio signals that can be output to Zone2 vary depending on how you connect the device in Zone2 to the unit’s output jacks. For details, see “Multi-zone ON SCREEN Start playback on the external device or select a radio SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT • AirPlay is available in Zone2 only when AirPlay playback is ongoing in the main 4 zone. X • The Zone2 input automatically switches in conjunction with the input source selected in the main zone when “Main Zone Sync” is selected as the Zone2 input with the web control (p.101) or AV CONTROLLER (p.9). • To play back DSD audio in Zone2, select “Main Zone Sync” as the Zone2 input or use the party mode (p.99). Caution To avoid unexpected noise, never play back DTS-CDs in Zone2. En 98 ■ Other operations for Zone2 The following functions are also available when Zone2 is enabled. ■ Enjoying the same source in multiple rooms (party mode) The party mode allows you to play back in Zone2 the same music that is AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX Adjusting the volume being played back in the main zone. During the party mode, stereo Press VOLUME or MUTE. playback is automatically selected for all zones. Utilize this function AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET when you want to use main zone music as background music for a house Selecting the input source and settings at once (SCENE) party. Press SCENE. MAIN PARTY ZONE 2 HDMI OUT PARTY SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 4 VOLUME SCENE VOLUME POP-UP/MENU MUTE ON SCREEN OPTION 1 X To register the current settings (input source, volume and tone control) to a scene, hold Each time you press the key, the party mode is turned on or off. down the desired SCENE key until “SET Complete” appears on the front display. When the party mode is turned on, “PARTY” lights up in the front display. Setting the sleep timer Press SLEEP repeatedly to set the time (120 min, 90 min, 60 min, 30 min, Y off). If the party mode does not work on Zone2, set “Party Mode Set” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu to “Enable” (default). ENTER Playing back digitally compressed formats (such as MP3, etc.) with RETURN enriched sound (Compressed Music Enhancer) DISPLAY Press ENHANCER. BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Press PARTY. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT ENHANCER SLEEP En 99 Registering favorite items (shortcut) You can register up to 40 favorite USB and network contents or Bluetooth 1 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX shortcut numbers. 5 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT ZONE 2 Recall a registered item by selecting the shortcut number. X AUDIO MAIN Recalling a registered item input source as shortcuts and access them directly by selecting the AV BLUETOOTH USB NET • You can also use the “Favorites” feature to register Internet radio stations (p.91). • Only the input source will be registered for Bluetooth and AirPlay. Individual contents cannot be registered. 1 2 2 3 4 Registering an item PROGRAM MUTE Recall Preset 01:USB VOLUME Select a desired item and register it to a shortcut number. TOP MENU Use the numeric keys to enter a shortcut number (01 to 40). You can also use PRESET on the front panel to select a shortcut. SCENE 1 Press BLUETOOTH, USB or NET. POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN 1 2 OPTION ENTER RETURN Play back a song or a radio station to be registered. Memory Preset 01:Empty BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL • “No Presets” appears when no items are registered. – The PC/NAS which contains the registered item is turned off or not connected to the network. – The registered network content is temporarily unavailable or out of service. – The registered item (file) has been deleted or moved to another location. – A Bluetooth connection cannot be established. To change a shortcut number to which the item will be registered, use numeric keys to select the shortcut number after Step 2. Memory Preset 02:Empty • When you register music files stored on a USB storage device or a PC/NAS, the unit memorizes the relative position of the music files in the folder. If you have added or deleted any music files to or from the folder, the unit may not recall the music file correctly. In such cases, register the items again. VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL To confirm the registration, press MEMORY. En • The registered content (songs and Internet radio stations) can be displayed as a list and easily recalled by using MusicCast CONTROLLER (p.59) on your mobile device. “Empty” (not in use) or item currently registered 3 Y – The USB storage device which contains the registered item is not connected to the unit. VOL. X MEMORY L C R SW SR SBR SBL • The registered item cannot be recalled in the following cases. Shortcut number (flashes) ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Numeric keys SL • “Empty” appears when a preset number not in use is entered. Press MEMORY. DISPLAY MOVIE VOL. 100 Controlling the unit from a web browser (web control) X You can control the unit with the web control screen displayed in a web browser. • You can check the IP address of the unit in “Network” (p.141) in the “Information” menu. Web browser • You can bookmark the unit’s IP address in the browser or create a shortcut link (p.103) to access the web control screen quickly in the future. However, if you are using a DHCP server, the IP address of the unit may change each time the unit is turned on. Web control Web control • If you have enabled the MAC Address Filter (p.132), you need to specify the MAC address of your PC to allow the PC to access the unit. For information on how to check the MAC address of your PC, refer to its instruction (wired or wireless) PC manual. (wired or wireless) Router The unit • By using the application for smartphone/tablet “AV CONTROLLER”, you can control the unit from an iPhone, Y iPad, iPod touch or Android devices (p.9). • To use this function, the unit and your PC must be connected to the same router. • Some security software installed on your PC may block the access of the unit to your PC. In these cases, configure the security software appropriately. • To display the web control screen or turn on the unit from the web control when the unit is in standby mode, set “Network Standby” (p.103) to “On”. • We recommend using one of the following web browsers. – Internet Explorer 11.x – Safari 9.x 1 2 Start the web browser. Enter the IP address of the unit in the address bar of the web browser. (Example) En 101 Top menu screen Control screen c a e a f b c d d e g b f a PLAY INFO a CONTROL Selects an input source or controls playback for the selected zone. Moves to the control screen for the selected zone. b TOP MENU b STATUS Moves to the top menu screen. Turns on/off the power for each zone or displays the input source and volume set for each zone. c SCENE c SETTINGS Selects a scene for the selected zone. Moves to the settings screen. d POWER d PARTY MODE Turns on/off the power for the selected zone. Turns on/off the party mode (p.99). e VOLUME e SYSTEM POWER Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the selected zone. You can also select the increments used for volume adjustment. Turns on/off the power for all zones. f MAIN VOLUME f RELOAD Adjusts the volume or mutes the audio output for the main zone. You can also select the increments used for volume adjustment. Reloads the current status of the unit. Y g RELOAD Reloads the current status of the unit. Multi-zone volume adjustment is not available when an external amplifier is used. En 102 Settings screen Google Analytics Displays an explanation of data collection by Google Analytics. Data collection can be enabled or disabled at any time. b BACK Moves to the top menu screen. c RELOAD a Reloads the current status of the unit. Note • If the network settings are changed, you may need to restart the browser or regain access to the unit. b • When using the MAC address filter, make sure you specify the MAC addresses of your network devices correctly. Otherwise, the unit will be inaccessible from your network devices such as PCs and other external devices. c a Rename • Do not operate the unit during the recovery process, as this may result in the incorrect recovery of the settings. When the recovery finishes, click “OK” to set the unit to standby mode. Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) (p.133) or the name of each zone (p.134). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit. • The backup does not contain user information (such as user account and password) or unit-specific information (such as MAC address and IP address). Network • Some characters entered with a PC may not appear correctly on the unit. Selects the network connection method (p.131) or configures the network parameters (such as IP address) (p.131). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit. AirPlay Password Sets the password to restrict access to the unit via AirPlay (p.92). Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit. MAC Filter Sets the MAC address filter (p.132) to limit access to the unit from the network devices. Click “APPLY” to apply the changes to the unit. Auto Reload Enables/disables automatic reloading. When “Auto Reload” is “On” (enabled), the web control screen reloads the status of the unit every 5 seconds. Network Standby Enables/disables the network standby function (p.132). Backup/Recovery Creates a backup of the unit’s settings on the PC or restores the settings from the backup. Firmware Updates the firmware of the unit by using the firmware you have downloaded on the PC. Follow the on-screen instructions to start the firmware update. Create Link Creates a shortcut link to the desired control screen. Tips Displays tips for use of the web control. Licenses Displays the licenses of the software used in the unit. En 103 Viewing the current status AV 1 5 2 3 6 AV 1-7 selected) on the front panel display or TV. VIDEO AUX 7 V-AUX 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT AUDIO 1-3 Switching information on the front display 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU Press INFO repeatedly to select between the various TUNER (FM/AM) Info Audio Decoder VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL TUNER (DAB) Item name POP-UP/MENU OPTION About 3 seconds after a display item is selected, its corresponding RETURN AV1 †‡ Dsur DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT Bluetooth USB information appears. ENTER VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR SBL SERVER AirPlay Information ENHANCER PURE DIRECT INFO 3 4 DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) * (U.K., Europe and Russia models only) Radio Data System data is also available when the unit is tuned into a Radio Data System broadcasting station (p.78). 4 VOLUME ON SCREEN DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) (AM radio feature is not available on the Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) display items. SCENE 1 Item PHONO AUDIO ZONE 2 You can view the current status (input or DSP program currently 4 1 MAIN Currently input source See “Displaying the DAB information” (p.74) for details. Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*) Song (song title), Artist (artist name), Album (album name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*), IP Address (IP address), Ethernet MAC (Ethernet MAC address), Wi-Fi MAC (Wi-Fi MAC address) NET RADIO Song (song title), Album (album name), Station (station name), DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*), IP Address (IP address), Ethernet MAC (Ethernet MAC address), Wi-Fi MAC (Wi-Fi MAC address) MusicCast Link DSP Program (sound mode name), Audio Decoder (decoder name*), IP Address (IP address), Ethernet MAC (Ethernet MAC address), Wi-Fi MAC (Wi-Fi MAC address) X Available items vary depending on the selected input source. The displayed item can (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) also be applied separately to each input source. * The name of the audio decoder currently activated is displayed. If no audio decoder is activated, “Decoder Off” appears. En 104 Viewing the status information on the TV 1 AV 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 V-AUX The following information is displayed on the TV. Input source/ Party mode status AUDIO 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT MAIN ZONE 2 Press DISPLAY. Compressed Music Enhancer status Volume/YPAO Volume status CINEMA DSP status Sound mode SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE TOP MENU 4 VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION Audio format/ Decoder ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING DISPLAY 2 To close the information display, press DISPLAY. PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 En 105 Configuring playback settings for different playback sources (Option menu) You can configure separate playback settings for different playback sources. This menu is Option menu items available on the front panel (or on the TV screen), allowing you to easily configure settings X during playback. 1 • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. Press OPTION. • Text in parentheses denotes indicators on the front display. Front display Option Tone Control • Default settings are underlined. Item VOL. SL L C R SW SR SBR TV screen YPAO Volume (YPAO Volume) Dialogue (Dialog) 2 Use the cursor keys to select an item and press ENTER. X 3 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a setting. Subwoofer/Bass (Subwoofer/Bass) To exit from the menu, press OPTION. Enhancer (Enhancer) Video Processing (Video Process.) En 106 Page 107 YPAO Volume (YPAO Vol.) Enables/disables YPAO Volume. 107 Adaptive DRC (A.DRC) Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted when the volume is adjusted. 107 Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl) Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. 108 DTS Dialogue Control (DTS Dialog) Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds for DTS:X contents. 108 Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift) Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. 108 Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. 108 Lipsync Adjustment (Lipsync Adj.) To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. Function Adjusts the level of high-frequency range and low-frequency range individually. Tone Control (Tone Control) SBL Subwoofer Trim Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. (SW.Trim) 108 Extra Bass (Extra Bass) Enables/disables Extra Bass. 108 Enhancer (Enhancer) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer. 109 Hi-Res Mode (HiRes Mode) Enables/disables the high-resolution mode (for enhancing the quality of uncompressed digital audio). 109 Enables/disables the video signal processing settings configured in the “Setup” menu. 109 Item Function Corrects volume differences between input sources. 109 Audio Select (A.Sel) Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for one input source. 109 Video Out (V.Out) Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. 110 FM Mode (FM Mode) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception. 110 Init Scan (Init Scan) (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) Tune AID (Tune AID) (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) Shuffle (Shuffle) Configures the shuffle setting for the USB storage device (p.84) or media server (p.88). - Repeat (Repeat) Configures the repeat setting for the USB storage device (p.84) or media server (p.88). - Input Settings (Input Settings) ■ YPAO Volume (YPAO Volume) Page Input Trim (In.Trim) Enables/disables YPAO Volume or Adaptive DRC. YPAO Volume (YPAO Vol.) Enables/disables YPAO Volume. When YPAO Volume is enabled, the high- and low-frequency Performs an initial scan for DAB radio reception. Checks reception strength of each DAB channel label. levels are automatically adjusted according to the volume so that you can enjoy natural sounds even at low volume. Settings 72 74 Off (Off) Disables YPAO Volume. On (On) Enables YPAO Volume. X • YPAO Volume works effectively after the measurement results of “Auto Setup” have been already saved (p.43). • We recommend enabling both YPAO Volume and Adaptive DRC when you are listening at lower volumes or at night. Adaptive DRC (A.DRC) ■ Tone Control (Tone Control) Sets whether the dynamic range (from maximum to minimum) is automatically adjusted when Adjusts the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) individually. the volume level is adjusted. When it is set to “On”, it is useful for listening to playback at a low volume at night. Choices Treble (Treble), Bass (Bass) Settings Setting range -6.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +6.0 dB, *0.5 dB increments Y Off (Off) The dynamic range is not automatically adjusted. On (On) Automatically adjusts the dynamic range when YPAO Volume is enabled. • When both “Treble” and “Bass” are 0.0 dB, “Bypass” appears. If “On” is selected, the dynamic range becomes narrow at a low volume and wide at a high • If you set an extreme value, sounds may not match those from other channels. volume. X Output level repeatedly to select “Treble” or “Bass”, and PROGRAM to make an adjustment. On Off Input level En 107 Volume: high Output level Volume: low You can also adjust the “Tone Control” setting with the front panel controls by pressing TONE CONTROL On Off Input level ■ Dialogue (Dialog) ■ Lipsync Adjustment (Lipsync Adj.) Adjusts the volume or perceive height of dialogue sounds. Adjusts the delay between video and audio output. Setting range 0 ms to 500 ms (1 ms increments) Dialogue Level (Dialog Lvl) X Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds. If dialogue sounds cannot be heard clearly, you can turn up its volume by increasing this setting. This setting is available only when “Delay Enable” (p.127) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Enable” (default). Setting range 0 to 3 ■ Subwoofer/Bass (Subwoofer/Bass) X Adjust the subwoofer volume or bass sound. This setting is not available when DTS:X content is played back, or when the Dolby Surround or Neural:X decoder is working. Subwoofer Trim (SW.Trim) Fine-adjusts the subwoofer volume. DTS Dialogue Control (DTS Dialog) Setting range -6.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) Adjusts the volume of dialogue sounds for DTS:X contents. Setting range 0 to 6 Extra Bass (Extra Bass) X Enables/disables Extra Bass. When Extra Bass is enabled, you can enjoy enhanced bass This setting is available only when DTS:X content which supports the DTS Dialogue Control feature is played back. sounds, regardless of the size of the front speakers and the presence or absence of the subwoofer. Dialogue Lift (Dialog Lift) Settings Adjusts the perceived height of dialogue sounds. If the dialogue sounds as if it is coming from below the TV screen, you can raise its perceived height by increasing this setting. X This setting is available only when one of the following conditions is met. – One of the sound programs (except for 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo) is selected when front presence speakers are used. – Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) (p.64) is working. (You may hear dialogue sounds from the surround speakers depending on the listening position.) Setting range 0 to 5 (The bigger the value the higher the position) Ideal position En 108 Off (Off) Disables Extra Bass. On (On) Enables Extra Bass. ■ Enhancer (Enhancer) ■ Video Processing (Video Process.) Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer and the high-resolution mode. Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio) settings configured in “Processing” (p.129) in the “Setup” menu. Enhancer (Enhancer) Settings Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68). X • This setting is applied separately to each input source. Direct (Direct) Disables the video signal processing. Processing (Processing) Enables the video signal processing. • You can also use ENHANCER on the remote control to enable/disable Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68). ■ Input Settings (Input Settings) Settings Off (Off) Disables Compressed Music Enhancer. Configures the input settings. On (On) Enables Compressed Music Enhancer. X This setting is applied separately to each input source. Default TUNER, Bluetooth, USB, (network sources): On (On) Input Trim (In.Trim) Others: Off (Off) Corrects volume differences between input sources. If you are bothered by volume differences Y when switching between input sources, use this function to correct it. Compressed Music Enhancer does not work on the following audio sources. – Signals whose sampling frequency is over 48 kHz Setting range -6.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +6.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) – DSD audio Hi-Res Mode (HiRes Mode) Audio Select (A.Sel) Enables/disables the high-resolution mode when “Enhancer” is set to “On”. If this function is Selects the audio input jack to use when more than one audio connection is made for one input set to “On”, you can enhance the quality of uncompressed digital audio (such as 2-channel source. PCM and FLAC) using Compressed Music Enhancer. Settings Settings Automatically selects the audio input jack in the following priority order. Enables the high-resolution mode. On (On) (The high-resolution mode may not work depending on the audio signal processing condition.) Off (Off) Disables the high-resolution mode. Auto (Auto) 1. HDMI input 2. Digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL) 3. Analog input (AUDIO) En 109 HDMI (HDMI) Always selects HDMI input. No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the HDMI jack. Coax/Opt (Coax/Opt) Always selects digital input (COAXIAL or OPTICAL). No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the COAXIAL or OPTICAL jack. Analog (Analog) Always selects analog input (AUDIO). No sounds are produced when no signals are input through the AUDIO jacks. Video Out (V.Out) Selects a video to be output with the audio input source. Settings Off (Off) Does not output video. AV 1-7 (AV1-7), VIDEO AUX (V-AUX) Outputs video input through the corresponding video input jacks. ■ FM Mode (FM Mode) Switches between stereo and monaural for FM radio reception. Settings Stereo (Stereo) Receives FM radio in stereo sounds. Mono (Mono) Receives FM radio in monaural sounds. En 110 CONFIGURATIONS Configuring input sources (Input menu) 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. You can change the input source settings using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Input” and press ENTER. X To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 5 6 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an input source to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Input menu items X • Available items vary depending on the selected input source. • Default settings are underlined. Item The input source of the unit also changes. X You can still switch the input source by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. En 111 Function Page Rename/Icon Select Changes the input source name and icon. 112 Decoder Mode Sets the format of digital audio playback to DTS. 112 Volume Interlock Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay. 112 DMC Control Selects whether to allow a DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. 112 ■ Rename/Icon Select ■ Decoder Mode Changes the input source name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. Sets the format of digital audio playback to “DTS”. X For example, if the unit does not detect DTS audio and outputs noise, set “Decoder Mode” to “DTS”. Some network input sources (such as “AirPlay”) cannot be renamed or have the icons changed. ■ Setup procedure Input sources AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX, AUDIO 1-3 (available only when any audio digital input jack is assigned) 1 Settings Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “Auto” or “Manual” and press the cursor key (w). If you select “Auto”, the unit creates a name automatically according to the connected device. In this case, skip Steps 3 and 4. X This step is available only when “AV1-7”, “VIDEO AUX” or “AUDIO1-3” (available only when any audio digital Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w). 3 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. 4 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. Automatically selects an audio format to match the input audio signal. DTS Selects DTS only. (Other audio signals are not reproduced.) ■ Volume Interlock input jack is assigned) is selected. 2 Auto Enables/disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod via AirPlay. Input sources AirPlay Settings Off Disables volume controls from iTunes/iPod. Limited Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod within the limited range (-80 dB to -20 dB and mute). Full Enables volume controls from iTunes/iPod in the full range (-80 dB to +16.5 dB and mute). ■ DMC Control Selects whether to allow DLNA-compatible Digital Media Controller (DMC) to control playback. X 5 6 To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. Input source SERVER Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. Settings X Disable Does not allow DMCs to control playback. To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. Enable Allows DMCs to control playback. X To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. A Digital Media Controller (DMC) is a device that can control other network devices through the network. When this function is enabled, you can control playback of the unit from DMCs (such as Windows Media Player 12) on the same network. En 112 Configuring the SCENE function (Scene menu) 5 6 You can change the settings of the SCENE function (p.61) using the TV screen. 1 2 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to change the setting. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Press ON SCREEN. Scene menu items Use the cursor keys to select “Scene” and press ENTER. Item 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a scene to be configured and press the cursor key (q). Function Page Save Registers the current settings in the selected scene. 113 Load Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. You can also configure the SCENE link playback setting, select items to be included as the scene assignments, or view the settings currently assigned to the selected scene. 114 Rename/Icon Select Changes the scene name and icon. 115 Reset Restores the default settings for the selected scene. 115 ■ Save Registers the unit’s current settings (such as input source and sound program) in the selected scene. X If you have changed the input assignment for a scene, you also need to change the external device assigned to the corresponding SCENE key (p.62). X You can still switch the scene by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. En 113 ■ Load Check or uncheck Loads the settings registered for the selected scene. Select “DETAIL” to configure the SCENE link playback setting or view the scene assignments. Device Control Recalls a selected scene and starts its playback on an external device connected to the unit via HDMI. (SCENE link playback) Settings Choices Off Disables the SCENE link playback function. HDMI Control Enables SCENE link playback using HDMI Control signals. Select this if an HDMI Control-compatible device (such as a BD/DVD player) is connected to the unit via HDMI. It also turns on the TV if it supports HDMI Control. Input Input (p.60), Station*1, Listening*1, Music Content*2, Playback*2, Audio Select (p.109) *1 Only when “TUNER” is selected *2 Only when “Bluetooth”, “USB” or “NET” is selected Default SCENE1-2: HDMI Control HDMI Output HDMI Output (p.60) SCENE3-12: Off Mode DSP Program (p.63), Pure Direct Mode (p.128), Enhancer (p.68), Enhancer Hi-Res Mode (p.109) Y Sound Tone Control (p.107), YPAO Volume (p.107), Adaptive DRC (p.107), Extra Bass (p.108) Surround CINEMA DSP 3D Mode (p.128), Dialogue Lift (p.108), Dialogue Level (p.108), Subwoofer Trim (p.108) Video Video Mode (p.129) Volume Master Volume (p.60) To control playback of an HDMI Control-compatible device by SCENE link playback, you need to set “HDMI Control” in the “Setup” menu to “On” and perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.165). Detail Selects items to be included as the scene assignments. You can also view the settings currently assigned to the selected scene. Lipsync Lipsync (p.127), Delay (p.127) To include items as the scene assignments, use the cursor keys to select an item and press Speaker Setup Setting Pattern (p.123), PEQ Select (p.126) ENTER to check the box (or uncheck the box to exclude). Default Input, HDMI Output, Mode: selected For example, if you often adjust the volume while watching TV but listen to radio with low volume at night, exclude “Volume” from the assignments for SCENE2 and include “Volume” in Sound, Surround, Video, Volume, Lipsync, Speaker Setup: not selected the assignments for SCENE4. X The scene assignments can include radio stations, or the content on a selected USB storage device and a network device. En 114 ■ Rename/Icon Select Playing a radio station or content included as the scene assignments automatically when pressing SCENE Changes the scene name and icon displayed on the front display or TV screen. Y ■ Setup procedure Individual contents cannot be registered for “Bluetooth” and “AirPlay”. The content lastly played back on each device will be recalled. 1 1 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an icon and press the cursor key (w). 2 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. 3 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. In the “Detail” screen, use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “Input” and press the cursor key (r). 2 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to set “Listening” or “Playback” to “On”. When “TUNER” is selected, “Listening” is available. When “Bluetooth”, “USB” or “NET” is selected, “Playback” is available. 3 If “Input” is unchecked, press ENTER to check the box. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. X To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 4 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. X To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 5 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Reset Restores the default settings (p.61) for the selected scene. En 115 Configuring sound programs/surround decoders (DSP Program menu) 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. You can change the settings of the sound programs and surround decoders using the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “DSP Program” and press ENTER. X • To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. • To restore the default settings for the selected sound program, select “Reset”. 5 6 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a sound program to be configured and press the cursor key (q). X You can still switch the sound program by using cursor keys (e/r) after Step 3. En 116 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. DSP Program menu items Item Function Settings 1.0 s to 5.0 s X Reverb Time Adjust the decay time of the rear reverberant sound. Reverb Delay 0 ms to 250 ms Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and reverberant sound generation. Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. Reverb Level Adjusts the volume of the reverberant sound. • Available items vary depending on the selected sound program or surround decoder. • Default settings are underlined. ■ Settings for sound programs Item Decode Type Function Selects a surround decoder to be used in combination with the selected sound program. 0% to 100% Settings Auto, bDsur*, Neural:X, Neo:6 Cinema, Neo:6 Music* (* Available only when “SURROUND DECODER” is selected) -6 dB to 0 dB to +3 dB DSP Level Adjusts the sound field effect level. Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and presence sound field generation. Surround Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround sound field generation. Surround Back Initial Delay Adjusts the delay between the direct sound and surround back sound field generation. Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the presence sound field. Surround Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround sound field. Surround Back Room Size Adjusts the broadening effect of the surround back sound field. Liveness Adjusts the loss of the presence sound field. Surround Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround sound field. Surround Back Liveness Adjusts the loss of the surround back sound field. Higher to enrich the reverberant sound and lower to have clear sound. Higher to enhance the sound field effect, and lower to reduce it. 1 ms to 99 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. 1 ms to 49 ms Higher to enhance the delay effect, and lower to reduce it. 0.1 to 2.0 Higher to enhance the broadening effect, and lower to reduce it. 0 to 10 Higher to enhance the reflectivity, and lower to reduce it. En 117 Higher to strengthen the reverberant sound, and lower to weaken it. ■ Settings for decoders The following items are available when you select “7ch Stereo”. Item Function Level Adjusts the entire volume. Front / Rear Balance Adjusts the front and rear volume balance. Left / Right Balance Adjusts the left and right volume balance. The following items are available when you set “Decode Type” of “SURROUND DECODER” to Settings “bDsur” or “Neo:6 Music”. -5 to 0 to +5 -5 to 0 to +5 Decode Type Item Higher to enhance the front side, and lower to enhance the rear side. bDsur -5 to 0 to +5 Center Spread Selects whether to spread the center channel signals to left and right when 2-channel source is played. Center Image Adjusts the center orientation level (broadening effect) of the front sound field. Higher to enhance the right side, and lower to enhance the left side. 0 to 5 to 10 Height Balance Monaural Mix Higher to enhance the upside, and Adjust the height volume balance lower to enhance the downside. (The using the front presence speakers. front presence speakers do not produce sounds when “Height Balance” is set to “0”.) Neo:6 Music Enables/disables monaural sound Off, On output. X Available items in “7ch Stereo” vary depending on the speaker system being used. En 118 Function Settings Off, On Select “On” to spread center channel signals to left and right if you feel the center sound is too strong when 2-channel source is played. 0.0 to 0.3 to 1.0 Higher to strengthen the center orientation level (less broadening effect) and lower to weaken (more broadening effect). Configuring various functions (Setup menu) 4 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an item and press ENTER. You can configure the unit’s various function with the menu displayed on the TV screen. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. X To return to the previous screen during menu operations, press RETURN. 3 5 6 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a menu. En 119 Use the cursor keys to select a setting and press ENTER. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Setup menu items Menu Item Function Automatically optimizes the speaker settings (YPAO). Auto Setup Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. 123 Setting Data Copy Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. 123 Configuration Manual Setup Lipsync Sound Video 43 Setting Pattern Selects a speaker system. 123 Front Selects the size of the front speakers. 124 Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. 124 Surround Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their size. 124 Surround Back Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their size. 124 Front Presence Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected and their size. 125 Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. 125 Layout Selects the layouts of the surround speakers and front presence speakers. 125 Power Amp Assign Speaker Page Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position. 125 Level Adjusts the volume of each speaker. 126 Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. 126 Test Tone Enables/disables the test tone output. 126 Delay Enable Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. 127 Auto/Manual Select Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. 127 Adjustment Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually. 127 Dynamic Range Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS signals) playback. 127 Max Volume Sets the limit value of the volumes. 127 Initial Volume Sets the initial volume for when this receiver is turned on. 128 Pure Direct Mode Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode. 128 Adaptive DSP Level Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level. 128 CINEMA DSP 3D Mode Enables/disables CINEMA DSP HD3. 128 Virtual Presence Speaker Selects whether to create Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers. 128 Virtual Surround Back Speaker Selects whether to create Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround speakers. 128 Object Decode Mode Enables/disables playback of object-based audio signals such as Dolby Atmos or DTS:X contents. 128 Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). 129 En 120 Menu HDMI Network Item Function Page HDMI Control Enables/disables HDMI Control. You can also configure the relevant settings (such as ARC and TV audio input). 130 Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. 130 Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in standby mode. 131 Network Connection Selects the network connection method. 131 IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). 131 Network Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from other network devices. 132 MAC Address Filter Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. 132 Network Name Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. 133 MusicCast Link Power Interlock Selects whether turning on the power of the master device of the MusicCast network (the unit) also turns on the power of other devices of the network. 133 Bluetooth Enables/disables the Bluetooth functions. 133 Disconnect Terminates the Bluetooth connection between the Bluetooth device (such as smartphones) and the unit. 80 Bluetooth Standby Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from Bluetooth devices (Bluetooth standby). 133 Transmitter Enables/disables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function. 134 Device Search Searches available Bluetooth devices (speakers/headphones) when the unit is used as a Bluetooth audio transmitter. 81 Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 134 Volume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. 135 Audio Receive Bluetooth Audio Send Main Zone Set Max Volume Sets the Zone2 limit value of the volumes. 135 Initial Volume Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. 135 Audio Delay Adjusts the Zone2 audio output timing. 135 Mono Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output. 135 Enhancer Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer for Zone2 output. 135 Tone Control Adjusts the level of high-frequency range and low-frequency range for Zone2 output. 135 Zone2 Set Multi Zone Extra Bass Enables/disables Extra Bass for Zone2 output. 136 Balance Adjusts the front speaker balance for Zone2 output. 136 Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. 136 HDMI OUT2 Assign Select the zone for which the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is used. 136 Party Mode Set Enables/disables switching to the party mode. 136 Zone Rename En 121 Menu Item Page 137 Assigns the desired function to the PROGRAM keys of the remote control. 137 Dimmer (Front Display) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. 137 Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated. 137 Wallpaper Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. 138 Remote PROGRAM Key Display Set Function Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. Input Assignment Function Trigger Output1 Trigger Mode Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. 138 Trigger Output2 Target Zone Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. 138 Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. 139 Auto Power Standby Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. 139 ECO Mode Enables/disables the eco mode (power saving mode). 140 Select an on-screen menu language. 140 ECO Language En 122 Speaker (Manual Setup) ■ Setting Data Copy Copies the “Setting Pattern” parameters in the specified direction. Configures the speaker settings manually. Choices X • Some speaker settings are not available depending on the selected “Power Amp Assign” setting. • Default settings are underlined. Pattern1 ▶ 2 Copies the “Pattern1” parameters to “Pattern2”. Pattern2 ▶ 1 Copies the “Pattern2” parameters to “Pattern1”. ■ Power Amp Assign Selects a speaker system. The unit has 7 built-in amplifiers. You can connect 2 to 9 speakers and up to 2 subwoofers (with built-in amplifier) to create the favorite acoustic space in your room. You can also apply bi-amp connections, channel expansion (using an external power amplifier) or multi-zone configurations to enhance your system. Settings ■ Setting Pattern Registers two speaker setting patterns and switches between them. When you configure the following speaker settings, the settings will be memorized in the Basic Select this option when you use the basic speaker configuration (up to 7-channel plus front presence speakers) (p.18). 7.1 +1Zone Select this option when you use Zone2 speakers in addition to the 7.1 system in the main zone (p.27). 5.1.2 +1Zone Select this option when you use Zone2 speakers in addition to the 5.1.2 system in the main zone (p.28). 5.1 Bi-Amp Select this option when you use the 5.1 system (including bi-amp front speakers) (p.28). 7.1 Bi-Amp [ext.SB] Select this option when you use the 7.1 system (including bi-amp front speakers and surround back channel expansion using an external amplifier) (p.29). selected pattern. • Measurement results (Auto Setup) • Power Amp Assign • Configuration • Distance • Level • Parametric EQ Settings Pattern1, Pattern2 X • The setting pattern currently selected is shown at the top of the “Manual Setup” screen. • This function is useful when you want to save certain settings according to the varying conditions of your listening environment. For example, if you want to switch the settings when curtains are open or closed, you can save the settings suited for each condition and switch between them. En 123 ■ Configuration Surround Configures the output characteristics of the speakers. Selects whether or not surround speakers are connected and their sizes. X Settings • When you configure the speaker size, select “Large” if the woofer diameter of your speaker is 16 cm (6-1/4”) or Select this option for large speakers. larger or “Small” if it is smaller than 16 cm (6-1/4”) as a guide. Large • When the speaker size is set to “Small”, you can configure the “Crossover” setting after pressing ENTER. Frequency sounds lower than the specified value will be output from the subwoofer and higher will be output Select this option for small speakers. from the corresponding speakers. Small Front None Settings Select this option for large speakers. The front speakers will produce surround channel audio. Virtual CINEMA DSP works when you select a sound program. Surround Back The front speakers will produce all of the front channel frequency components. Selects whether or not surround back speakers are connected and their sizes. Select this option for small speakers. Small The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). Select this option when no surround speakers are connected. Selects the size of the front speakers. Large The surround speakers will produce all of the surround channel frequency components. The subwoofer will produce front channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). Settings Select this option when one large speaker is connected. X Large x1 “Front” is automatically set to “Large” when “Subwoofer” is set to “None”. The surround back speaker will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. Select this option when two large speakers are connected. Large x2 Center Selects whether or not a center speaker is connected and its size. Select this option when one small speaker is connected. Settings Large Small x1 Select this option for large speakers. The center speaker will produce all of the center channel frequency components. None The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). Select this option when two small speakers are connected. Select this option for small speakers. Small The surround back speakers will produce all of the surround back channel frequency components. Small x2 The subwoofer or front speakers will produce center channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). Select this option when no center speaker is connected. None The front speakers will produce center channel audio. The subwoofer or front speakers will produce surround back channel low-frequency components lower than the specified crossover frequency (default: 80 Hz). Select this option when no surround back speakers are connected. The surround speakers will produce surround back channel audio. X This setting is not available when “Surround” is set to “None”, or when “Layout (Surround)” is set to “Front”. En 124 Front Presence Layout Selects whether or not front presence speakers are connected and their size. Selects the layouts of the surround speakers and front presence speakers. Settings Surround Large Select this option for large speakers. Small Select this option for small speakers. None Select this option when no front presence speakers are connected. Selects a surround speaker layout when surround speakers are used. Settings Rear Select this option when surround speakers are placed on the rear side of the room. Front Select this option when surround speakers are placed on the front side of the room. Virtual CINEMA FRONT (p.66) works in this case. Subwoofer Selects whether or not a subwoofer is connected and its phase. X Settings Normal Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase not reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Reverse Select this option when a subwoofer is connected (phase reversed). The subwoofer will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. This setting is not available when “Configuration (Surround)” is set to “None”. Front Presence Use Selects a front presence layout when front presence speakers are used. This setting facilitates the optimization of the sound field effect. Settings None Select this option when no subwoofer is connected. The front speakers will produce LFE (low-frequency effect) channel audio and low-frequency components from other channels. Front Height Select this option when front presence speakers are installed on the front side wall. X Overhead Select this option when front presence speakers are installed to the ceiling. When the bass sound is lacking or unclear, switch the subwoofer phase. Dolby Enabled SP Select this option when using the Dolby Enabled speakers as the front presence speakers. X • This setting is not available when “Configuration (Front Presence)” is set to “None”. • To play Dolby Atmos contents using the front presence speakers, see “Presence speaker layout” (p.22). ■ Distance Sets the distance between each speaker and listening position so that sounds from the speakers reach the listening position at the same time. First, select the unit of distance from “Meter” or “Feet”. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer Setting range 0.30 m to 3.00 m to 24.00 m (1.0 ft to 10.0 ft to 80.0 ft), *0.05 m (0.2 ft) increments En 125 ■ Level 4 Adjusts the volume of each speaker. Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select a center frequency from the 7 preset bands (4 for subwoofer) and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Choices Front L, Front R, Center, Surround L, Surround R, Surround Back L, Surround Back R, Front Presence L, Front Presence R, Subwoofer Setting range -10.0 dB to 0.0 dB to +10.0 dB (0.5 dB increments) ■ Parametric EQ Adjusts the tone with an equalizer. Setting range Gain: -20.0 dB to +6.0 dB Settings Manual 5 Select this option when you want to adjust the equalizer manually. To fine-adjust the center frequency or Q factor (bandwidth), press ENTER repeatedly to select For details, see “Manual equalizer adjustment”. an item. YPAO:Flat Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics. YPAO:Front Adjusts individual speakers to achieve the same characteristics as the front speakers. Frequency: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the center frequency of the selected band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. YPAO:Natural Adjusts all speakers to achieve a natural sound. Through Does not use the equalizer. Q: Use the cursor keys (e/r) to adjust the Q factor (bandwidth) of the selected band and the cursor keys (q/w) to adjust the gain. Setting range Center frequency: 15.6 Hz to 16.0 kHz (15.6 Hz to 250.0 Hz for subwoofer) X Q factor: 0.500 to 10.080 “YPAO:Flat”, “YPAO:Front”, and “YPAO:Natural” are available only when the measurement results of “Auto 6 Setup” have already been saved (p.43). Press ENTER again to view the measurement results. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Manual equalizer adjustment ■ Test Tone 1 Set “Parametric EQ” to “Manual” and press ENTER. Enables/disables the test tone output. Test tone output helps you to adjust the speaker 2 Press ENTER again to enter the edit screen. 3 Use the cursor keys to select a speaker and press ENTER. balance or equalizer while confirming its effect. Settings X • To restore the default settings for all speakers, select “PEQ Data Clear” and then “OK”. • To copy the parametric equalizer values acquired with “Auto Setup” (p.43) to the “Manual” fields for fine adjustment, select “PEQ Data Copy” and then an equalizer type. En 126 Off Does not output test tones. On Outputs test tones automatically when you adjust the speaker balance or equalizer. Sound Adjustment Adjusts the delay between video and audio output manually when “Auto/Manual Select” is set Configures the audio output settings. to “Manual”. You can fine-adjust the audio output timing when “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”. ■ Lipsync Setting range 0 ms to 500 ms (1 ms increments) Adjusts the delay between video and audio by holding up the audio output. X Delay Enable • “Offset” shows the difference between automatic adjustment and fine adjustment. Enables/disables the Lipsync adjustment for each input source. • This setting is also available in “Lipsync Adjustment” (p.108) in the “Option” menu. Choices AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX, AUDIO 1-3 ■ Dynamic Range Settings Selects the dynamic range adjustment method for bitstream audio (Dolby Digital and DTS Disable Disable the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source. signals) playback. Enable Enables the Lipsync adjustment for the selected input source. Settings Auto/Manual Select Maximum Produces audio without adjusting the dynamic range. Standard Optimizes the dynamic range for regular home use. Selects the method to adjust the delay between video and audio output. Sets the dynamic range for clear sound even at night or at low volumes. Minimum/Auto Setting range Auto Adjusts the delay between video and audio output automatically when a TV that supports an automatic lipsync function is connected to the unit via HDMI. ■ Max Volume If necessary, you can fine-adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”. Manual When playing back Dolby TrueHD signals, the dynamic range is automatically adjusted based on the input signal information. Sets the limit value of the volume. Select this option when you want to adjust the delay between video and audio output manually. Setting range -30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB Adjust the audio output timing in “Adjustment”. Y Even if “Auto/Manual Select” is set to “Auto”, the automatic adjustment does not work depending on the TV connected to the unit. In this case, adjust the delay manually in “Adjustment”. En 127 ■ Initial Volume ■ Virtual Presence Speaker Sets the initial volume when the receiver is turned on. Selects whether to create Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) using the front, center, and surround speakers. When VPS is enabled, the unit creates front VPS when no front presence speakers are Settings connected, and creates rear VPS when front presence speakers are connected (p.64). Off On Sets the level to the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode. Settings Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments). (This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.) Off Disables Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS). On Enables Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS). ■ Pure Direct Mode X Selects whether to output video signals during the Pure Direct mode (p.68). Depending on the installation height of the surround speakers, VPS may not be effective. In this case, set “Virtual Presence Speaker” to “Off”. Settings Auto Automatically outputs video signals when any videos are input from the selected input source or an input source that can be operated with the on-screen display is selected. When no video signals are input, the wall paper is displayed. ■ Virtual Surround Back Speaker Video Off Does not output video signals including the wall paper. When VSBS is enabled, the unit creates VSBS when no surround back speakers are connected. Selects whether to create Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) using the surround speakers. Settings ■ Adaptive DSP Level Off Disables Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS). Selects whether to automatically adjust the CINEMA DSP effect level. On Enables Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS). Settings X Off Does not adjust the effect level automatically. On Adjusts the effect level automatically according to the YPAO measurement results and the volume level. VSBS is effective only when 6.1- or 7.1-channel content is played back. ■ Object Decode Mode Enables/disables playback of object-based audio signals such as Dolby Atmos or DTS:X ■ CINEMA DSP 3D Mode contents. Enables/disables CINEMA DSP HD3 (p.64). If this function is set to “On”, CINEMA DSP HD3 Settings functions with the selected sound programs (except 2ch Stereo and 7ch Stereo). Settings Off On Disables CINEMA DSP HD3. 3 Enables CINEMA DSP HD . Disable Disables playback of object-based audio signals. Those signals will be played in normal 5.1-/7.1-channel audio. Enable Enables playback of object-based audio signals. X If audio output is not available when Dolby Atmos or DTS:X signals are input, set “Object Decode Mode” to “Enable”. En 128 Video Resolution Selects a resolution to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”. Configures the video output settings. Settings Through Does not convert the resolution. Auto Selects a resolution automatically in accordance with TV resolution. 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i, 1080p, 4K Output video signals with a selected resolution. (Only the resolutions supported by your TV are selectable.) X If you need to select a resolution that is not supported by your TV, set “MONITOR CHECK” (p.144) in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “SKIP” and try again. (Note that the output video may not be displayed on your TV normally.) ■ Video Mode Enables/disables the video signal processing (resolution and aspect ratio). Aspect Settings Direct Processing Selects an aspect ratio to output HDMI video signals when “Video Mode” is set to “Processing”. Disables the video signal processing. Settings Enables the video signal processing. Select a resolution and an aspect ratio in “Resolution” and “Aspect”. X • When “Video Mode” is set to “Direct”, the unit transmits video signals with the least circuitry in order to reduce Through Does not convert the aspect ratio. 16:9 Normal Outputs 4:3 video signals to a 16:9 TV with black bands on either side of the screen. X video output delay. This setting functions only when 480i/576i or 480p/576p signals are converted into 720p, 1080i, 1080p, or 2160p • When “Video Mode” is set to “Processing” and the resolution is being converted, short messages are not (4K) signals. displayed on the TV screen. En 129 HDMI ARC Enables/disables ARC (p.167) when “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. Configures the HDMI settings. Settings Off Disables ARC. On Enables ARC. Y You do not need to change this setting normally. In case noises are produced from the speakers connected to the unit because TV audio signals input to the unit via ARC are not supported by the unit, set “ARC” to “Off” and use the TV’s speakers. Standby Sync ■ HDMI Control Select whether to use HDMI control to link the standby behavior of the TV and the unit when Enables/disables HDMI Control (p.165). “HDMI Control” is set to “On”. Settings Settings Off On Disables HDMI Control. Off Does not set the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off. On Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off. Auto Sets the unit to standby mode when the TV is turned off only when the unit is receiving TV audio or HDMI signals. Enables HDMI Control. Configure the settings in “TV Audio Input”, “ARC” and “Standby Sync”. Y To use HDMI control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.165) after connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices. ■ Audio Output Selects a device to output audio. TV Audio Input Selects an audio input jack of the unit to be used for TV audio input when “HDMI Control” is set X to “On”. The unit’s input source automatically switches to TV audio when the TV input is • The “HDMI OUT1” setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”. switched to its built-in tuner. • The “HDMI OUT2” setting is available only when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) is set to “Main”. Settings AUDIO 1-3 HDMI OUT1, HDMI OUT2 Enables/disables the audio output from a TV connected to the HDMI OUT 1 jack or HDMI OUT Default AUDIO 1 2 jack. Y Settings When using ARC to input TV audio to the unit, you cannot use the input jacks selected here for connecting an external device because the input will be used for TV audio input. Off Disables the audio output from the TV. On Enables the audio output from the TV. Y The HDMI OUT 1-2 jacks output 2-channel audio signals when the unit is turned on. En 130 Network ■ Standby Through Select whether to output videos/audio (input through HDMI jacks) to the TV when the unit is in Configures the network settings. standby mode. If this function is set to “On” or “Auto”, you can use the input selection keys (AV 1-7 and V-AUX) to select an HDMI input even when the unit is in standby mode (the standby indicator on the unit blinks). Settings Off (This setting is available only when “HDMI Control” is set to “Off”.) Does not output videos/audio to the TV. On Outputs videos/audio to the TV. (The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.) Auto Outputs videos/audio to the TV. If no signals are detected, the unit is set to the power saving mode. ■ Network Connection Selects the network connection method. Settings Wired Select this option when you want to connect the unit to a network with a commercially-available network cable (p.39). Wireless (Wi-Fi) Select this option when you want to connect the unit to a network via the wireless router (access point). For details on settings, see “Connecting the unit to a wireless network” (p.52). Wireless Direct Select this option when you want to connect a mobile device to the unit directly. For details on settings, see “Connecting a mobile device to the unit directly (Wireless Direct)” (p.57). ■ IP Address Configures the network parameters (such as IP address). DHCP Select whether to use a DHCP server. Settings En 131 Off Does not use a DHCP server. Configure the network parameters manually. For details, see “Manual network settings”. On Uses a DHCP server to automatically obtain the unit’s network parameters (such as IP address). ■ Manual network settings ■ MAC Address Filter 1 2 Sets the MAC address filter to limit access to the unit from other network devices. 3 Set “DHCP” to “Off”. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select a parameter type and press ENTER. Filter IP Address Specifies an IP address. Enables/disables the MAC address filter. Subnet Mask Specifies a subnet mask. Settings Default Gateway Specifies the IP address of the default gateway. DNS Server (P) Specifies the IP address of the primary DNS server. DNS Server (S) Specifies the IP address of the secondary DNS server. Off Disables the MAC address filter. On Enables the MAC address filter. In “MAC Address 1-10”, specify the MAC addresses of the network devices that will be permitted access to the unit. X Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a AirPlay (p.92) and DMC (p.112) operations are not subject to the MAC address filter. value. 4 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. 5 To configure another network parameter, repeat steps 2 to 4. 6 To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. 7 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. MAC Address 1-10 Specifies the MAC addresses (up to 10) of the network devices that will be permitted access to the unit when “Filter” is set to “On”. ■ Setup procedure 1 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “MAC Address 1-5” or “MAC Address 6-10” and press ENTER. ■ Network Standby Selects whether the unit can be turned on from other network devices (network standby). 2 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select an MAC address number and press ENTER. Settings 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to move the edit position and the cursor keys (q/w) to select a Off On value. Disables the network standby function. Enables the network standby function. (The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.) Enables the network standby function. Auto (If “Network Connection” is set to “Wired”, the unit is set to the power saving mode when the network cable is disconnected.) With an advanced energy saving design, this product achieves a low power consumption of not more than two watts when in Network Standby mode. En 132 4 To confirm the setting, press ENTER. 5 To save the changes, use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. 6 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Bluetooth ■ Network Name Edits the network name (the unit’s name on the network) displayed on other network devices. Configures the Bluetooth settings. ■ Setup procedure 1 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. 2 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. ■ Bluetooth Enables/disables the Bluetooth function (p.80). Settings X To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 3 Disables the Bluetooth function. On Enables the Bluetooth function. Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. X ■ Audio Receive To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 4 Off Configures the Bluetooth settings when the unit is used as the Bluetooth audio receiver. To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Bluetooth Standby ■ MusicCast Link Power Interlock Selects whether to enable/disable the function that turns on the unit from Bluetooth devices Selects whether turning on the power of the master device of the MusicCast network (the unit) (Bluetooth standby). If this function is set to “On”, the unit automatically turns on when a also turns on the power of other devices of the network. connect operation is performed on the Bluetooth device. Settings Settings Off Disables the power interlock from the unit (MusicCast master). On Enables the power interlock from the unit (MusicCast master). Off On Disables the Bluetooth standby function. Enables the Bluetooth standby function. (The unit consumes more power than when “Off” is selected.) X This setting is not available when “Network Standby” (p.132) is set to “Off”. En 133 Multi Zone ■ Audio Send Configures the Bluetooth settings when the unit is used as the Bluetooth audio transmitter. Configures the multi zone settings. Transmitter Enables/disables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function. When this function is enabled, you can enjoy audio played back on the unit using Bluetooth speakers/headphones (p.81). Settings Off Disables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function. On Enables the Bluetooth audio transmitter function. ■ Main Zone Set Configures the main zone setting. Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for main zone) displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Setup procedure 1 Press ENTER to enter the name edit screen. 2 Use the cursor keys and ENTER to rename and select “ENTER” to confirm the entry. X To clear the entry, select “CLEAR”. 3 Use the cursor keys to select “OK” and press ENTER. X To restore the default setting, select “RESET”. 4 En 134 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. ■ Zone2 Set Audio Delay Configures the Zone2 settings. Adjusts the Zone2 audio output timing so that the audio is synchronized with the video. Setting range 0 ms to 100 ms (1 ms increments) Volume Enables/disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. Mono If you have connected an external amplifier with volume control to the unit, disable volume adjustments for Zone2. Switches between stereo and monaural for Zone2 output. Settings Settings Fixed Disables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. Off Produces stereo sounds in Zone2. Variable Enables volume adjustments for Zone2 output. On Produces monaural sounds in Zone2. X Enhancer This setting is not available depending on the “Power Amp Assign” setting. Enables/disables Compressed Music Enhancer (p.68) for Zone2 output. Max Volume Settings Sets the Zone2 limit value of the volumes. Off Disables Compressed Music Enhancer. Setting range -30.0 dB to +15.0 dB (5.0 dB increments), +16.5 dB On Enables Compressed Music Enhancer. X Tone Control This setting is available only when “Volume” is set to “Variable”. Adjusts the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) for Zone2 output. Initial Volume Settings Sets the Zone2 initial volume for when the unit is turned on. Settings Off Sets the level at the volume level of the unit when it last entered standby mode. On Sets at Mute or the specified volume level (-80 dB to +16.5 dB, 0.5 dB increments). (This setting works only when the initial volume is set lower than “Max Volume”.) X This setting is available only when “Volume” is set to “Variable”. En 135 Auto Adjusts the levels of the high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) automatically in synchronization with the main volume, with correction for the auditory response of the human ear. Manual Adjusts the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass) manually (-6.0 to +6.0 dB, 0.5 dB increments). Bypass Does not adjust the level of high-frequency range (Treble) and low-frequency range (Bass). ■ HDMI OUT2 Assign Extra Bass Select the zone for which the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is used. Enables/disables Extra Bass for Zone2 output. When Extra Bass is enabled, you can enjoy enhanced bass sounds, regardless of the size of speakers. Settings Main, Zone2 Settings Off Disables Extra Bass. On Enables Extra Bass. X For details on audio signals that can be output to Zone2, see “Multi-zone output” (p.165). Zone2 - Audio Output Balance Enables/disables the audio output from the HDMI OUT 2 jack when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” is set Adjusts the front speaker balance for Zone2 output. to “Zone2”. Setting range -20 to 0 to +20 (negative to the left and positive to the right) On Enables the audio output. Off Disables the audio output (video output only). Zone Rename Changes the zone name (for Zone2) displayed on the front display or TV screen. ■ Party Mode Set You can change the zone name in the same manner as “Zone Rename” in “Main Zone Set” Enables/disables switching to the party mode (p.99). (p.134). Choice Target: Zone2 Settings En 136 Disable Disables switching to the party mode. Enable Enables switching to the party mode. You can turn on/off the party mode by pressing PARTY on the remote control. Function ■ Remote PROGRAM Key Assigns the desired function to the PROGRAM keys of the remote control. Configures the functions that make the unit easier to use. For example, when “INPUT Selection” is selected, the PROGRAM keys will operate as the input switching keys. Settings DSP Program Selection Select a sound program. INPUT Selection Select an input source for playback. NET Selection Select a network source. Preset Selection Select a registered item (shortcut). ■ Input Assignment Browse Screen 1 Page Up/Down Move to the previous/next page of the browse screen list. Assigns the COMPONENT VIDEO, COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to another input source. Subwoofer Trim Adjust the subwoofer volume. ■ Procedure Dialogue Level Adjust the volume of dialogue sounds. qRepeat / wShuffle Select the repeat/shuffle setting for the USB storage device or media server. Example: assigning the OPTICAL (2) jack to the input source “AV 2” 1 Use the cursor keys to select the cell at the intersection of “AV 2” and “Optical”, and press ENTER. ■ Display Set Configures the settings related to the front display and TV screen display. Dimmer (Front Display) Adjusts the brightness of the front display. Setting range -4 to 0 (higher to brighten) 2 Y Use the cursor keys to select “2” and press ENTER. The front display may become dark when “ECO Mode” (p.140) is set to “On”. Short Message Selects whether to display short messages on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as input selection and volume adjustment). Settings 3 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. X You cannot assign both COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks to the same input source. En 137 On Displays short messages on the TV screen. Off Does not display short messages on the TV screen. Wallpaper Manual Switches the output level for electronic signal transmission manually when “Trigger Mode” is Selects the image to be used as wallpaper on the TV. set to “Manual”. This setting can also be used to confirm proper function of the external device Settings connected via the TRIGGER OUT jack. Piano Displays the piano image on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Gray Displays a gray background on the TV screen when there is no video signal. Choices ■ Trigger Output1, Trigger Output2 Sets the TRIGGER OUT 1-2 jacks to function in sync with the power status of each zone or input Low Stops the electronic signal transmission. High Transmits the electronic signal. Target Zone switching. Specifies the zone with which the TRIGGER OUT jack functions are synchronized. Trigger Mode Settings Specifies the condition for the TRIGGER OUT jack to function. Main Settings Power Source The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the power status of the zone specified with “Target Zone”. The TRIGGER OUT jack functions in sync with the input switching in the zone specified with “Target Zone”. Zone2 An electronic signal is transmitted according to the setting made in “Source.” Manual Select this to manually switch the output level for electronic signal transmission with “Manual”. All Source Specifies the output level of the electronic signal transmitted with each input, switching when “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”. Choices AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX, AUDIO 1-3, PHONO, TUNER, (network sources), Bluetooth, USB Settings Low Stops the electronic signal transmission when you switch to the input source specified in this option. High Transmits the electronic signal when you switch to the input source specified in this option. En 138 When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of the main zone. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Power”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the power status of the main zone or Zone2. When “Trigger Mode” is set to “Source”, electronic signal transmission is synchronized with the input switching in the main zone or Zone2. ECO ■ Memory Guard Prevents accidental changes to the settings. Configures the power supply settings. Settings Off Does not protect the settings. On Protects the settings until “Off” is selected. X When “Memory Guard” is set to “On”, the lock icon (o) is displayed on the menu screen. Icon ■ Auto Power Standby Sets the amount of time for the auto-standby function. If you do not operate the unit or if no input signals are detected for the specified time, the unit will automatically go into standby mode. Settings Off Does not set the unit to standby mode automatically. 20 Minutes Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit and no input signals are detected for 20 minutes. 2 Hours, 4 Hours, 8 Hours, 12 Hours Sets the unit to standby mode when you have not operated the unit for the specified time. For example, when “2 Hours” is selected, the unit will switch to standby mode if you do not operate it for 2 hours. Default U.K., Europe and Russia models: 20 Minutes Other models: Off X Just before the unit enters standby mode, “AutoPowerStdby” appears and then countdown starts in the front display. En 139 Viewing information about the unit (Information menu) ■ ECO Mode Enables/disables the eco (power saving) mode. You can reduce the unit’s power consumption by setting “ECO Mode” to “On”. After setting, be sure to press ENTER to restart the unit. You can view information about the unit using the TV screen. Settings X Off If new firmware is available, Disables the eco mode. (mail icon) appears at the upper right of the “Information”. For details, see “Updating the unit’s firmware via the network” (p.147). On Enables the eco mode. Y • When “ECO Mode” is set to “On”, the front panel display may become dark. • If you want to play audio at high volume, set “ECO Mode” to “Off”. 1 2 Press ON SCREEN. 3 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select an information type. 4 To exit from the menu, press ON SCREEN. Use the cursor keys to select “Information” and press ENTER. Language Select an on-screen menu language. Settings English, Japanese, French, German, Spanish, Russian, Italian, Chinese X The information on the front display is provided in English only. En 140 Types of information ■ HDMI Monitor Displays information about the TVs connected to the HDMI OUT jacks. You can check the following information in the Information menu. Use the cursor keys (q/w) to switch between “OUT1” and “OUT2”. ■ Audio Signal Interface TV interface Displays information about the current audio signal. Video Resolution Resolutions supported by the TV Format Channel Input Output Audio format of the input signal ■ Network The number of source channels in the input signal (front/surround/LFE) Displays the network information on the unit. For example, “5.1 (3/2/0.1)” means 5.1ch in total (3 front channels, 2 surround channels, and LFE). Sampling The number of samples per second of the input digital signal Dialogue The dialogue normalization level of the input bitstream signal Channel The number of signal output channels (for example, “5.1.2” denotes “standard 5.1-channel plus 2 for overhead speaker channels”) and the speaker terminals from which signals are output (When using wired or wireless [Wi-Fi] network connection) X IP Address IP address Subnet Mask Subnet mask Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway DNS Server (P) The IP address of the primary DNS server DNS Server (S) The IP address of the secondary DNS server MAC Address (Ethernet) MAC address • Even when the unit is set to output bitstream signals directly, the signal may be converted depending on the MAC Address (Wi-Fi) specifications and settings of the playback device. Network Name Network name (the unit’s name on the network) (p.133) MusicCast Network The status of the MusicCast network connection ■ Video Signal Wired/Wireless The status of the wired or wireless connection Displays information about the current video signal. SSID • Some information may not be available depending on the signal type. HDMI Signal Presence or absence of HDMI signal input/output HDMI Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog or HDMI) and output signal (HDMI) Analog Resolution Resolutions of input signal (analog) En 141 (When using wireless [Wi-Fi] network connection) The SSID of the wireless network Configuring the system settings (ADVANCED SETUP menu) (When using Wireless Direct) SSID The SSID of the wireless network Security Security method Security Key Security key IP Address IP address Subnet Mask Subnet mask MAC Address (Wi-Fi) MAC address MusicCast Network The status of the MusicCast network connection Network Connection “Wireless Direct” indication Configure the system settings of the unit while viewing the front display. 1 2 Set the unit to standby mode. While holding down STRAIGHT on the front panel, press MAIN ZONE z. MAIN ZONE z STRAIGHT ■ System Displays the system information on the unit. Remote ID The unit’s remote control ID setting (p.144) TV Format The unit’s video signal type (p.144) Speaker Impedance The speaker impedance setting of the unit (p.143) Tuner Freq. Step PROGRAM 3 4 5 (Asia and General models only) The FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit (p.144) System ID System ID number Firmware Version The version of firmware installed on the unit (mail icon) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and the corresponding message will be displayed in this screen. You can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in this screen and following the procedure in “Updating the unit’s firmware via the network” (p.147). ■ Multi Zone Displays information about Zone2. Input The input source selected for Zone2 Volume The volume for Zone2 Press STRAIGHT to select a setting. Press MAIN ZONE z to set the unit to standby mode and turn it on again. The new settings take effect. X If the unit detects a newer firmware over the network, Press PROGRAM to select an item. En 142 ADVANCED SETUP menu items Changing the speaker impedance setting (SPEAKER IMP.) X Default settings are underlined. Item Function SPEAKER IMP. Changes the speaker impedance setting. 143 REMOTE SENSOR Turns on/off of the remote control sensor on the main unit. 143 REMOTE ID Selects the unit’s remote control ID. 144 TUNER FRQ STEP (Brazil, Asia and General models only) Changes the FM/AM tuning frequency setting. SPEAKER¡IMP. 8¬MIN Page Change the unit’s speaker impedance settings depending on the impedance of the speakers connected. Settings 144 TV FORMAT Switches the video signal type. 144 MONITOR CHECK Removes the limitation on HDMI video output. 144 4K MODE Selects the HDMI 4K (60 Hz/50 Hz) signal format. 145 DTS MODE Switches the DTS format notification setting. 145 RECOV./BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of the unit, or recovers the settings from the backup. 145 INITIALIZE Restores the default settings. 146 FIRM. UPDATE Updates the firmware. 146 VERSION Checks the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. 146 6 Ω MIN Select this option when you connect 6-ohm speakers to the unit. You can also use 4-ohm speakers as the front speakers. 8 Ω MIN Select this option when you connect 8-ohm or higher speakers to the unit. Turning on/off the remote control sensor (REMOTE SENSOR) REMOTE SENSOR ON Turn on/off the remote control sensor on the main unit. While the remote control sensor is turned off, you cannot control the unit from the remote control. Settings En 143 ON Turns on the remote control sensor. OFF Turns off the remote control sensor. Selecting the remote control ID (REMOTE ID) REMOTE ID Switching the video signal type (TV FORMAT) TV FORMAT NTSC ID1 Change the unit’s remote control ID so that it matches the remote control’s ID (default: ID1). Switch the video signal type of the unit so that it matches to the format of your TV. When using multiple Yamaha AV receivers, you can set each remote control with a unique remote control ID for its corresponding receiver. Settings NTSC, PAL Settings ID1, ID2 Default U.S.A., Canada, Korea, Brazil and General models: NTSC Other models: PAL ■ Changing the remote control ID of the remote control 1 To select ID1, hold down the cursor key (e) and SCENE1 together for 3 seconds. Removing the limitation on HDMI video output (MONITOR CHECK) To select ID2, hold down the cursor key (e) and SCENE2 together for 3 seconds. Changing the FM/AM tuning frequency setting (TUNER FRQ STEP) MONITOR CHECK YES The unit automatically detects resolutions supported by a TV connected to the HDMI OUT jack. (Brazil, Asia and General models only) Disable the monitor check function if you want to specify a resolution in “Resolution” (p.129) TUNER FRQ STEP FM50/AM9 when the unit cannot detect the TV’s resolution or when you want to specify a different resolution than the detected resolution. Change the FM/AM tuning frequency setting of the unit depending on your country or region. Settings Settings FM100/AM10 FM50/AM9 Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 100-kHz steps and AM by 10-kHz steps. Select this when you want to adjust the FM frequency by 50-kHz steps and AM by 9-kHz steps. YES Enables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a resolution supported by the TV only.) SKIP Disables the monitor check function. (Outputs video signals with a specified resolution regardless of compatibility with the TV.) Y Reset to “YES” if the unit becomes inoperable because video from the unit cannot be displayed on the TV after “MONITOR CHECK” has been set to “SKIP”. En 144 Selecting the HDMI 4K signal format (4K MODE) Switching the DTS format notification setting (DTS MODE) DTS MODE MODE 1 4K MODE MODE 1 Selects the format of signals input/output at the unit when HDMI 4K compatible TV and Switches the DTS format notification setting. playback device are connected to the unit. This setting informs the video device (such as BD/DVD player) about the DTS formats that the Settings unit supports. Settings Inputs/outputs 4K signals shown in the table below. MODE 1 MODE 2 Depending on the connected device or HDMI cables, video may not be displayed correctly. In this case, select “MODE 2”. This mode conforms to the DTS:X standard. MODE 1 Use this setting under normal circumstances. Inputs/outputs 4K signals shown in the table below. Use this setting if the video device (such as BD/DVD player) fails to properly output a DTS signal even when it is playing back DTS-HD or DTS:X content. MODE 2 Format MODE 1 8 bit RGB 4:4:4 , YCbCr 4:4:4 , 4K/60, 50 Hz 4K/30, 25, 24 Hz 10 bit MODE 2 12 bit 8 bit 10 bit - - - - Backing up/recovering the settings (RECOV./BACKUP) 12 bit RECOV./BACKUP BACKUP YCbCr 4:2:2 , - YCbCr 4:2:0 , , - RGB 4:4:4 , , - YCbCr 4:4:4 , , - YCbCr 4:2:2 , Creates backup of the settings of the unit, or recovers the settings from the backup. ■ Backup/recovery procedure 1 , Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “BACKUP” or “RECOVERY” and press INFO to start the process. Y Choices • When “MODE 1” is selected, use a Premium High Speed HDMI Cable or Premium High Speed Cable with Ethernet. • Regardless of the setting, 4K signals are input as “MODE 2” for the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack. BACKUP Creates backup of the settings of the unit in the internal memory. RECOVERY Recovers the settings of the unit from the backup (available only when backup has been created). Note • Do not turn off the unit during the recovery process. Otherwise, the settings may not be restored correctly. • The backup does not contain user information (such as user accounts and passwords). En 145 Restoring the default settings (INITIALIZE) Checking the firmware version (VERSION) INITIALIZE CANCEL VERSION x.xx Restores the default settings for the unit. Check the version of firmware currently installed on the unit. Choices X VIDEO Restores the default settings for video configurations. ALL Restores the default settings for the unit. CANCEL Does not perform an initialization. • You can also check the firmware version in “System” (p.142) in the “Information” menu. • It may take a while until the firmware version is displayed. Updating the firmware (FIRM. UPDATE) FIRM. UPDATE USB New firmware that provides additional features or product improvements will be released as needed. Updates can be downloaded from the Yamaha website. If the unit is connected to the Internet, you can download the firmware via the network. For details, refer to the information supplied with updates. ■ Firmware update procedure Do not perform this procedure unless firmware update is necessary. Also, make sure you read the information supplied with updates before updating the firmware. 1 Press STRAIGHT repeatedly to select “USB” or “NETWORK” and press INFO to start firmware update. Choices USB Update the firmware using a USB memory device. NETWORK Update the firmware via the network. X If the unit detects newer firmware over the network, the corresponding message will be displayed after ON SCREEN is pressed. In this case, you can also update the unit’s firmware by following the procedure in “Updating the unit’s firmware via the network” (p.147). En 146 Updating the unit’s firmware via the network New firmware that provides additional features or product 1 2 3 4 6 7 V-AUX 3 PHONO Internet, you can download the firmware via the network and update it. 5 AUDIO 1 2 Note TUNER MAIN BLUETOOTH ZONE 2 USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT • Do not operate the unit or disconnect the power cable or network cable during firmware update. Firmware update takes about 20 minutes or more (depending on your Internet connection speed). • If the unit is connected to the wireless network, network update may not be possible depending on the condition of the wireless connection. In this case, update the firmware using the USB memory device (p.146). SCENE 1 2 PROGRAM 3 MUTE Updating the unit’s firmware immediately improvements will be released as needed. If the unit is connected to the AV 4 1 2 To start the firmware update, use the cursor keys to select “START” and press ENTER. 3 If “UPDATE SUCCESS PLEASE POWER OFF!” appears on the front display, press MAIN ZONE z on the front panel. • For details on update, visit the Yamaha website. VOLUME Read the on-screen description. The firmware update is complete. TOP MENU POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN OPTION Cursor keys ENTER ENTER RETURN DISPLAY X X • You can also update the firmware using the USB memory device from the “ADVANCED If you want to cancel without doing anything now, select “CLOSE”. SETUP” menu (p.146). • The firmware update indicator (p.12) on the front display lights up when a firmware be displayed in the “System” screen (p.142). You can update the unit’s firmware by pressing ENTER in the “System” screen. update is available via the network. BAND A firmware update is available if the following message is displayed after MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT (mail icon) appears at the upper right of the “Information” and “System” icons, and a message will Information icon ON SCREEN is pressed. ENHANCER PURE DIRECT 4 Message System Icon En 147 Updating the unit’s firmware at power off z AV 1 5 2 3 6 4 7 V-AUX 1 2 3 PHONO TUNER BLUETOOTH USB NET PARTY HDMI OUT AUDIO MAIN ZONE 2 1 2 2 To set the firmware to update at power off, use the cursor keys to select “LATER” and press ENTER. 3 Press z (receiver power) to turn off the unit. The following message is displayed on the front display. SCENE 1 Read the on-screen description. 3 4 Firmware update indicator (flashes) PROGRAM MUTE TOP MENU NETWORK UPDATE:ENTER VOLUME POP-UP/MENU ON SCREEN X OPTION The unit turns off automatically without performing the firmware update 2 ENTER RETURN DISPLAY BAND MODE TUNING PRESET SUR. DECODE STRAIGHT MOVIE MUSIC INFO SLEEP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 MEMORY ENT ENHANCER PURE DIRECT Cursor keys ENTER RETURN minutes after Step 3. 4 To start the firmware update, press ENTER. X • To cancel the firmware update and turn off the unit, press RETURN. • You can also start the firmware update by pressing INFO on the front panel. • The unit turns off without performing the firmware update if you turn off the unit with AV CONTROLLER or MusicCast CONTROLLER. If the firmware update is complete, the unit turns off automatically. En 148 APPENDIX Frequently asked questions every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. For information on The new speaker system does not provide an ideal sound balance... how HDMI Control works between your TV and playback devices, refer to the instruction manuals for each device. If you have changed speakers or have a new speaker system, use “Auto Setup” to optimize the I want to turn off the on-screen messages displayed during operations... speaker settings again (p.43). If you want to adjust the speaker settings manually, use “Manual Setup” in the “Setup” menu (p.123). By default, short messages are displayed on the TV screen when the unit is operated (such as Since we have small children, we want to set limitations on the volume control... input selection and volume adjustment). If the short messages bother you when you are watching movies or sports, configure “Short Message” (p.137) in the “Setup” menu to turn off If a small child accidentally operates the controls on the main unit or remote control, the the short messages. volume may suddenly increase. This may also cause injury or damage the unit or speakers. We I want to prevent accidental changes to the settings... recommend using “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the maximum volume level for the unit in advance (p.127). You can also set the maximum volume for Zone2 (p.127). You can protect the settings configured on the unit (such as speaker settings) by utilizing “Memory Guard” in the “Setup” menu (p.139). I am occasionally startled by a sudden loud sound when turning on the unit... The unit’s remote control is simultaneously controlling another Yamaha product as well as the unit... By default, the volume level when the unit last entered standby mode is automatically applied. If you want to fix the volume, use “Initial Volume” in the “Setup” menu to set the volume to be When using multiple Yamaha products, the remote control may work on another Yamaha applied when the receiver is turned on (p.128). You can also set the initial volume for Zone2 product or another remote control may work on the unit. If this happens, register different (p.128). remote control IDs for the devices that you want to control with each remote control (p.144). We are bothered by volume differences when switching between input sources… I want to enjoy videos/audio played back on the video device even when the unit is in standby mode... You can correct volume differences between input sources by utilizing “Input Trim” in the If you have connected a video device to the unit with HDMI, you can output videos/audio “Option” menu (p.109). played back on the video device to the TV even when the unit is in standby mode. To use this function, set “Standby Through” (p.131) in the “Setup” menu to “On” or “Auto”. You can also I made HDMI connections but HDMI Control does not work at all... switch the input source using the remote control of the unit when this function is enabled. To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the HDMI Control link setup (p.165). After connecting HDMI Control-compatible devices (such as BD/DVD players) to the unit, enable HDMI Control on each device and perform the HDMI Control link setup. This setup is required En 149 Troubleshooting Refer to the table below when the unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instructions below do not help, turn off the unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. First, check the following: 1 2 3 The power cables of the unit, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are connected to AC wall outlets securely. The unit, subwoofer, TV and playback devices (such as BD/DVD players) are turned on. The connectors of each cable are securely inserted in to jacks on each device. Power, system and remote control Problem Cause Remedy The power does not turn on. The protection circuitry has been activated three times consecutively. As a safety precaution, capability to turn on the power is disabled. Contact your nearest When the unit is in this condition, the standby indicator on the unit blinks Yamaha dealer or service center to request repair. if you try to turn on the power. The power does not turn off. The internal microcomputer has frozen, due to an external electric shock Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power reboot the unit. (If the problem persists, disconnect the power cable from the AC wall supply voltage. outlet and plug it again.) The power turns off (standby mode) immediately. The unit was turned on while a speaker cable was shorted. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers (p.25). The sleep timer worked. Turn on the unit and start playback again. The auto-standby function activated because the unit was not used for the specified time. To disable the auto-standby function, set “Auto Power Standby” in the “Setup” menu to “Off” (p.139). The speaker impedance setting is incorrect. Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers (p.143). The protection circuitry has been activated because of a short circuit. Twist the bare wires of each speaker cable firmly and reconnect to the unit and speakers (p.25). The protection circuitry has been activated because the volume of the unit is too high. Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, set it to “Off” (p.140). The unit enters standby mode automatically. The unit is not reacting. The internal microcomputer is frozen, due to an external electric shock Hold down MAIN ZONE z on the front panel for more than 10 seconds to initialize and (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or to a drop in the power reboot the unit. (If the problem persists, disconnect the power cable from the AC wall supply voltage. outlet and plug it again.) En 150 Problem The unit cannot be controlled using the remote control. Cause Remedy The unit is out of the operating range. Use the remote control within the operating range (p.6). The batteries are weak. Replace with new batteries. The unit’s remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight or strong lighting. Adjust the lighting angle, or reposition the unit. (China, Korea, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) The remote control is set to control external devices. Press RECEIVER to set the remote control to control the unit (the key lights up in orange). The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.144). The remote control sensor on the main unit is turned off. Set “REMOTE SENSOR” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “ON” (p.143). Audio Problem No sound. Cause Remedy Another input source is selected. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys. Signals that the unit cannot reproduce are being input. Some digital audio formats cannot be played back on the unit. To check the audio format of the input signal, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.141). The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The maximum volume is set. Use “Max Volume” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the maximum volume (p.127). A device connected to the output jacks of the unit is not turned on. Turn on all devices connected to the output jacks of the unit. The volume cannot be increased. The playback source does not contain a signal for the channel. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.141). The currently selected sound program/decoder does not use the speaker. To check it, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.126). Audio output of the speaker is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.43) or use “Configuration” in the “Setup” menu to change the speaker settings (p.124). The volume of the speaker is set too low. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.43) or use “Level” in the “Setup” menu to adjust the speaker volume (p.128). The speaker cable connecting the unit and the speaker is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another speaker cable. The speaker is malfunctioning. To check it, replace with another speaker. If the problem persists, the unit may be malfunctioning. The playback source does not contain LFE or low-frequency signals. To check if the subwoofer is working properly, use “Test Tone” in the “Setup” menu (p.126). Subwoofer output is disabled. Perform “Auto Setup” (p.43) or set “Subwoofer” in the “Setup” menu to “Use” (p.125). The volume of the subwoofer is too low. Adjust the volume on the subwoofer. The subwoofer has been turned off by its auto-standby function. Disable the auto-standby function of the subwoofer or adjust its sensitivity level. No sound is coming from a specific speaker. No sound is coming from the subwoofer. En 151 Problem Cause Remedy The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content No sound from the playback device (connected to the Protection). unit with HDMI). The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack exceeds the limit. No sound from the playback device (when HDMI Control is used). No sound from the TV (when HDMI Control is used). The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the playback device audio is output from the speakers connected to the unit. TV audio is selected as the input source. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys. The TV is set to output audio from the TV speakers. Change the audio output setting on your TV so that the TV audio is output from the speakers connected to the unit. A TV that does not support ARC is connected to the unit only with an HDMI cable. Use a digital optical cable to make an audio connection (p.32). (If the TV is connected to the unit with an audio cable) The TV audio input setting does not match the actual connection. (If you are trying to use ARC) Use “TV Audio Input” in the “Setup” menu to select the correct audio input jack (p.130). Set “ARC” in the “Setup” menu to “On” (p.130). Also, enable ARC on the TV. ARC is disabled on the unit or TV. Only the front speakers work on multichannel audio. Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications. The playback device is set to output 2-channel audio (such as PCM) only. To check it, use “Audio Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.141). If necessary, change the digital audio output setting on the playback device. The unit is too close to another digital or radio frequency device. Move the unit further away from the device. The cable connecting the unit and playback device is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The volume of the unit is too high. Turn down the volume. If “ECO Mode” in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”, set it to “Off” (p.140). A device connected to the unit’s output jacks is not turned on. Turn on all devices connected to the unit’s output jacks. Noise/hum is heard. The sound is distorted. The sound is interrupted. If the HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack is assigned to Zone2, HDMI audio For details, see “Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio” output may be interrupted during some zone operations due to internal (p.96). circuitry switching. En 152 Video Problem Cause Remedy Another input source is selected on the unit. Select an appropriate input source with the input selection keys. Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit. The video signal output from the unit is not supported by the TV. Set “MONITOR CHECK” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “YES” (p.144). No video. No video from the playback device (connected to the unit with HDMI). The cable connecting the unit and TV (or playback device) is defective. If there is no problem with the connection, replace with another cable. The input video signal (resolution) is not supported by the unit. To check the information about the current video signal (resolution), use “Video Signal” in the “Information” menu (p.141). For information about video signals supported by the unit, see “HDMI signal compatibility” (p.167). The TV does not support HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). The playback device that supports HDCP 2.2 is connected to the VIDEO AUX (HDMI IN) jack. Refer to the instruction manuals for the TV and check the TV’s specifications. If you want to play back contents that require HDCP 2.2-compatible devices, both the TV and playback device must support HDCP 2.2. To play back contents that require HDCP 2.2-compatible devices, connect the playback device to the HDMI (AV 1–7) jack (p.34). The number of devices connected to the HDMI OUT jack is over the limit. Disconnect some of the HDMI devices. The menu of the unit is not displayed on the TV. Another input source is selected on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit (HDMI OUT jack). (If you are using 2 TVs in the main zone) Select “HDMI OUT 1” or “HDMI OUT 2” to output the signals only to the TV you are using (p.60). Another TV is turned off when “HDMI OUT 1+2” is selected. The video is interrupted. (If the HDMI OUT 2 jack is assigned to Zone2) For details, see “Connecting an HDMI-compatible device to play back videos/audio” HDMI audio output may be interrupted during some zone operations due (p.96). to internal circuitry switching. En 153 FM/AM radio (AM radio feature is not available for the Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) Problem Cause Remedy There is multi-path interference. Adjust the FM antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location. Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. Set “FM Mode” in the “Option” menu to “Mono” to select monaural FM radio reception (p.110). FM radio reception is weak or noisy. Use an outdoor FM antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. AM radio reception is weak or noisy. The noises may be caused by fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats, or It is difficult to completely eliminate noise. It may be reduced by using an outdoor AM other electrical equipment. antenna. Select the station manually (p.69). Your area is too far from the FM station transmitter. Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. Adjust the AM antenna orientation. Radio stations cannot be selected automatically. Select the station manually (p.69). The AM radio signal is weak. Use an outdoor AM antenna. Connect it to the ANTENNA (AM) jack together with the supplied AM antenna. AM radio stations cannot be registered as presets. Auto Preset is for registering FM radio stations only. Register AM radio stations manually (p.70). Auto Preset has been used. DAB radio (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) Problem No DAB radio reception. Cause Remedy An initial scan has not been performed. Perform an initial scan to receive DAB radio (p.72). Reception strength of DAB radio is poor. Check reception strength in “Tune AID” in the “Option” menu (p.74), and adjust the antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location. There is no DAB coverage in your area. Check with your dealer or WorldDMB online at “http://www.worlddab.org” for a listing of the DAB coverage in your area. There is multi-path interference. Check reception strength in “Tune AID” in the “Option” menu (p.74), and adjust the antenna height or orientation, or place it in a different location. Your area is too far from the DAB station transmitter. Use an outdoor antenna. We recommend using a sensitive multi-element antenna. No DAB radio reception even after performing an initial scan. DAB radio reception is weak or noisy. DAB information is not available or is inaccurate. The selected DAB radio station may be temporarily out of service or may Contact the DAB broadcaster. not provide information. No DAB radio sound. The selected DAB radio station may be temporarily out of service. En 154 Try the station later or select another station. Bluetooth Problem Cause Remedy The Bluetooth function of the unit is disabled. A Bluetooth connection cannot be established. No sound is produced, or the sound is interrupted during playback. Enable the Bluetooth function (p.133). Another Bluetooth device is already connected to the unit. Terminate the current Bluetooth connection and then establish a new connection (p.80). The unit and the Bluetooth device are too far apart. Move the Bluetooth device closer to the unit. There is a device (such as microwave oven and wireless LAN) that outputs signals in the 2.4 GHz frequency band nearby. Move the unit away from those devices. The Bluetooth device does not support A2DP. Use a Bluetooth device that supports A2DP. The connection information registered on the Bluetooth device is not working for some reason. Delete the connection information on the Bluetooth device, and then establish a connection between the Bluetooth device and the unit again (p.80). The volume of the Bluetooth device is set too low. Turn up the volume of the Bluetooth device. The Bluetooth device is not set to send audio signals to the unit. Switch the audio output of the Bluetooth device to the unit. The Bluetooth connection has been terminated. Establish a Bluetooth connection between the Bluetooth device and the unit again (p.80). The unit and the Bluetooth device are too far apart. Move the Bluetooth device closer to the unit. There is a device (such as microwave oven and wireless LAN) that outputs signals in the 2.4 GHz frequency band nearby. Move the unit away from those devices. En 155 USB and network Problem Cause Remedy The USB device is not connected to the USB jack securely. Turn off the unit, reconnect your USB device, and turn the unit on again. The unit does not detect the USB device. The file system of the USB device is not FAT16 or FAT32. Use a USB device with FAT16 or FAT32 format. Folders and files in the USB device cannot be viewed. The data in the USB device is protected by the encryption. Use a USB device without an encryption function. The files in the USB device cannot be played back continuously. Files not supported by the unit exist in the selected folder. If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during playback, playback stops automatically. Do not store the unsupported files in the playback folder. The network feature does not function. The network parameters (IP address) have not been obtained properly. Enable the DHCP server function on your router and set “DHCP” in the “Setup” menu to “On” on the unit (p.131). If you want to configure the network parameters manually, check that you are using an IP address which is not used by other network devices in your network (p.131). The wireless router (access point) is turned off. Turn on the wireless router. The unit cannot connect to the Internet via a wireless The unit and the wireless router (access point) are too far apart. router (access point). There is an obstacle between the unit and the wireless router (access point). Microwave ovens or other wireless devices in your neighborhood might disturb the wireless communication. Place the unit and the wireless router (access point) closer to each other. Move the unit and the wireless router (access point) in a location where there are no obstacles between them. Turn off these devices. Wireless network is not found. Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of the wireless Check the firewall setting of the wireless router (access point). router (access point). Configure the sharing setting and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.85). The media sharing setting is not correct. Some security software installed on your PC is blocking the access of the Check the settings of security software installed on your PC. unit to your PC. The unit does not detect the PC. The unit and PC are not in the same network. Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the unit and the PC to the same network. The MAC address filter is enabled on the unit. In “MAC Address Filter” in the “Setup” menu, disable the MAC address filter or specify the MAC address of your PC to allow it to access to the unit (p.132). The files in the PC cannot be viewed or played back. The files are not supported by the unit or the media server. Use the file format supported by both the unit and the media server. For information about the file formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.85). The files in the PC cannot be played back continuously. Files not supported by the unit exist in the selected folder. If the unit detects a series of unsupported files (such as images and hidden files) during playback, playback stops automatically. Do not store the unsupported files in the playback folder. En 156 Problem The Internet radio cannot be played. The iPod does not recognize the unit when using AirPlay. Cause Remedy The selected Internet radio station is currently not available. There may be a network problem at the radio station, or the service may have been stopped. Try the station later or select another station. The selected Internet radio station is currently broadcasting silence. Some Internet radio stations broadcast silence at certain of times of the day. Try the station later or select another station. Access to the network is restricted by the firewall settings of your network devices (such as the router). Check the firewall settings of your network devices. The Internet radio can be played only when it passes through the port designated by each radio station. The port number varies depending on the radio station. The unit is connected to a multiple SSID router. Access to the unit might be restricted by the network separation function on the router. Connect the iPod to the SSID which can access the unit. The unit and smartphone/tablet are not in the same network. Check the network connections and your router settings, and then connect the unit and smartphone/tablet to the same network. The MAC address filter is enabled on the unit. In “MAC Address Filter” in the “Setup” menu, disable the MAC address filter or specify the MAC address of your smartphone/tablet to allow it to access to the unit (p.132). The MusicCast compatible device is turned off. Turn on the MusicCast compatible device. The MusicCast compatible device is not connected to the MusicCast network. Connect the device with “MusicCast CONTROLLER”. The application for smartphone/tablet “AV CONTROLLER” does not detect the unit. No sound from the MusicCast compatible device. The MusicCast connection cannot be made on “MusicCast CONTROLLER”. “MusicCast CONTROLLER” does not detect a MusicCast compatible device. Connect the mobile device to the wireless router and start “MusicCast CONTROLLER”. The mobile device which “MusicCast CONTROLLER” is installed is not connected to the wireless network at your home. Disable the cellular data transmission. The MusicCast compatible device is turned off. Turn on the MusicCast compatible device. The mobile device which “MusicCast CONTROLLER” is installed is not connected to the wireless network at your home. Connect the mobile device to the wireless router and set the MusicCast compatible device with “MusicCast CONTROLLER”. Turn on the MusicCast compatible device. The MusicCast compatible device is turned off. Enable the network standby function on the MusicCast compatible device. Firmware update via the network is failed. It may not be possible depending on the condition of the network. En 157 Update the firmware via the network again or use a USB memory device (p.146). Error indications on the front display Message Access denied Cause Remedy Access to the PC is denied. Configure the sharing settings and select the unit as a device to which music contents are shared (p.85). The unit cannot access the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. Make sure your router and modem are turned on. Access error There is a problem with the signal path from the network to the unit. Check the connection between the unit and your router (or hub) (p.39). Check SP Wires The speaker cables short circuit. Twist the bare wires of the cables firmly and connect to the unit and speakers properly. Internal Error An internal error has occurred. Contact the nearest authorized Yamaha dealer or service center. No content There are no playable files in the selected folder. Select a folder that contains files supported by the unit. No device The unit cannot detect the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. Please wait The unit is preparing for connecting to the network. Wait until the message disappears. If the message stays more than 3 minutes, turn off the unit and turn it on again. RemID Mismatch The remote control IDs of the unit and the remote control are not identical. Change the remote control ID of the unit or the remote control (p.144). Remote Off The unit cannot be operated from remote control because the remote control sensor on the main unit is turned off. Use the controls on the front panel. To use the remote control, set “REMOTE SENSOR” in the “ADVANCED SETUP” menu to “ON” (p.143). The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the USB device for some reasons. Check the song data. If it cannot be played on another device, the song data may be defective. The unit cannot play back the songs stored on the PC for some reason. Check if the format of files you are trying to play is supported by the unit. For information about the formats supported by the unit, see “Playing back music stored on media servers (PCs/NAS)” (p.85). If the unit supports the file format, but still cannot play back any files, the network may be overloaded with heavy traffic. Firmware update is failed. Update the firmware again. USB Overloaded An overcurrent is flowing through the USB device. Turn off the unit and reconnect your USB device. If the problem persists, try another USB device. Version error Firmware update is failed. Update the firmware again. Unable to play Update failed. En 158 Glossary This section explains the technical terms used in this manual. DSD (Direct Stream Digital) DSD (Direct Stream Digital) technology stores audio signals on digital storage media, such as SACD (Super Audio CDs). The signals are stored at a high-frequency sampling rate (such as 2.8224 MHz and 5.6448 MHz). The highest Audio information (audio decoding format) frequency response is equal to or higher than 100 kHz, with a dynamic range of 120 dB. This technology offers better Dolby Atmos DTS 96/24 Introduced first in the cinema, Dolby Atmos brings a revolutionary sense of dimension and immersion to the Home DTS 96/24 is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. This format Theater experience. Dolby Atmos is an adaptable and scalable object based format that reproduces audio as remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This audio quality than that used for CDs. independent sounds (or objects) that can be accurately positioned and move dynamically throughout the 3 technology is used for music DVDs, etc. dimensional listening space during playback. A key ingredient of Dolby Atmos is the introduction of a height plane of DTS Dialog Control sound above the listener. DTS Dialog Control allows you to boost the dialog. This can be useful in noisy environments to help make the dialog Dolby Atmos Stream more intelligible. People with impaired hearing may also benefit. Note that the content creator may disable the use Dolby Atmos content will be delivered to your Dolby Atmos enabled AV receiver via Dolby Digital Plus or Dolby of this feature in the mix, so that DTS Dialog Control may not always be available. Note that updates to your AVR may TrueHD on Blu-ray Disc, downloadable files and streaming media. A Dolby Atmos stream contains special metadata add more functionality to DTS Dialog Control or increase the range of the feature. that describes the positioning of sounds within the room. This object audio data is decoded by a Dolby Atmos AV DTS Digital Surround receiver and scaled for optimum playback through Home Theater speaker systems of every size and configuration. DTS Digital Surround is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel audio. Dolby Digital This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs. Dolby Digital is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports 5.1-channel DTS-ES audio. This technology is used for audio on most DVD discs. DTS-ES creates total 6.1-channel audio from 5.1-channel sources that are recorded with DTS-ES. This decoder adds Dolby Digital Plus a surround back sound to the original 5.1-channel sound. In the DTS-ES Matrix 6.1 format, a surround back sound is Dolby Digital Plus is a compressed digital audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. that supports recorded in the surround channels, and in the DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 format, a discrete surround back channel is 7.1-channel audio. Dolby Digital Plus remains fully compatible with the existing multichannel audio systems that recorded. support Dolby Digital. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). DTS Express Dolby Enabled Speaker DTS Express is a compressed digital audio format that supports 5.1-channel audio and allows a higher compression A convenient alternative to speakers built into the ceiling, products utilizing Dolby speaker technology employ the rate than the DTS Digital Surround format developed by DTS, Inc. This technology is developed for audio streaming ceiling above you as a reflective surface for reproducing audio in the height plane above the listener. Dolby enabled services on the Internet and secondary audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). speakers feature a unique upward firing driver and special signal processing that can be built into a conventional DTS-HD High Resolution Audio speaker, or a standalone speaker module, minimally impacting the overall speaker system footprint while providing DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is a compressed digital audio format developed by DTS, Inc. that supports an immersive listening experience during Dolby Atmos and Dolby surround playback. 7.1-channel and 96 kHz/24-bit audio. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio remains fully compatible with the existing Dolby Surround multichannel audio systems that support DTS Digital Surround. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray Dolby surround is a next generation surround technology that intelligently up mixes stereo; 5.1 and 7.1 content for discs). playback through your surround speaker system. Dolby surround is compatible with traditional speaker layouts, as DTS-HD Master Audio well as Dolby Atmos enabled playback systems that employ in-ceiling speakers or products with Dolby speaker DTS-HD Master Audio is an advanced lossless audio format developed to offer a high-definition home theater technology. experience with the quality of the studio master by DTS, Inc. DTS-HD Master Audio can carry up to eight channels of Dolby TrueHD 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on Dolby TrueHD is an advanced lossless audio format developed by Dolby Laboratories, Inc. to offer a high-definition BD (Blu-ray discs). home theater experience with the quality of the studio master. Dolby TrueHD can carry up to eight channels of 96 kHz/24-bit audio (up to six channels of 192 kHz/24-bit audio) simultaneously. This technology is used for audio on BD (Blu-ray discs). En 159 DTS Neo:6 WMA (Windows Media Audio) DTS Neo:6 enables 6-channel playback from 2-channel sources. There are two modes available: “Music mode” for One of the compressed digital audio formats developed by Microsoft Corporation. With psychoacoustic music sources and “Cinema mode” for movie sources. This technology provides discrete full-bandwidth matrix technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing channels of surround sound. data quantity by about 1/20 maintaining a certain level of audio quality. DTS:X DTS:X is the next generation object-based, multi-dimensional audio technology from DTS. Unbound from channels, DTS:X conveys the fluid movement of sound to create an incredibly rich, realistic and immersive soundscape - in front of, behind, beside and above the audience - more accurately than ever before. DTS:X offers the ability to automatically adapt the audio to the speaker layout that best fits the space, from a television’s built-in speakers to a home surround theater system to a dozen or more speakers in a commercial cinema. Immerse yourself at www.dts.com/dtsx FLAC FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data compression. FLAC is inferior to lossy compressed audio formats in compression rate but provides higher audio quality. MP3 One of the compressed digital audio format used by MPEG. With psychoacoustic technologies, this compression method achieves a high compression rate. Reportedly, it is capable of compressing data quantity by about 1/10 maintaining a certain level of audio quality. MPEG-4 AAC An MPEG-4 audio standard. It is used for mobile telephones, portable audio players, and audio streaming services on Internet because it allows a high compression rate of data while maintaining better audio quality than MP3. Neural:X Neural:X is the latest downmixing/upmixing and spatial remapping technology from DTS. It is built in to DTS:X to provide upmix of Neural:X-encoded and non-encoded (PCM) data. In DTS:X for AVRs and Sound Bars, Neural:X can produce up to 11.x channels. PCM (Pulse Code Modulation) PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded, and transmitted. This technology is the basis of all other audio format. This technology is used as a lossless audio format called Linear PCM for audio on a variety of media, including CDs and BD (Blu-ray discs). Sampling frequency/Quantization bit Sampling frequency and quantization bits indicate the quantity of information when an analog audio signal is digitized. These values are noted as in the following example: “48 kHz/24-bit”. • Sampling frequency Sampling frequency (the number of times the signal is sampled per second) is called the sampling rate. When the sampling frequency is higher, the range of frequencies that can be played back are wider. • Quantization bit The number of quantization bits indicate the degree of accuracy when converting the sound level into a numeric value. When the number of quantized bits is higher, the expression of the sound level is more accurate. WAV Windows standard audio file format, which defines the method of recording the digital data obtained by converting audio signals. By default, the PCM method (no compression) is used, but you can also use other compression methods. En 160 Audio Information (Others) HDMI and video information Bi-amplification connection (Bi-amp) Component video signal A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a speaker. When you use the bi-amplification connection, the With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for luminance and the Pb and unit drives the tweeter and woofer in a speaker with the discrete amplifiers. As a consequence, the tweeter and Pr signals for chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals woofer provide clear audio signal without the interference. is independent. LFE (Low Frequency Effects) 0.1 channel Composite video signal This channel reproduces low-frequency bass signals and has a frequency range from 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is With the composite video signal system, color, brightness, and synchronization data signals are combined and added to the channels for all bands with Dolby Digital or DTS to enhance low frequency audio effects. This channel transmitted with a single cable. is labeled 0.1 because it is limited to only low frequency audio. Deep Color Lip sync Deep Color is a technology that HDMI specification supports. Deep Color increases the number of available colors Video output sometimes lags behind audio output due to the complexity of signal processing caused by an increase within the boundaries defined by the RGB or YCbCr color space. Conventional color systems process the color using in video signal capacity. Lip sync is a technique for automatically correcting the timing lag between audio and video 8 bits. Deep Color processes the color with 10, 12, or 16 bits. This technology allows HDTVs and other displays to output. increase from millions of colors to billions of colors and eliminate on-screen color banding for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. HDCP HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) is a digital copy protection form that prevents copying of digital contents as it travels across connections (such as HDMI). HDMI HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the world-wide standard interface for digital audio/video signal transmission. This interface transmits both digital audio and digital video signals using a single cable without any loss. HDMI complies with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) and provides a secure audio/video interface. For further information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://www.hdmi.org/”. x.v.Color “x.v.Color” is a technology that the HDMI specification supports. It is a more extensive color space than sRGB and allows the expression of colors that were not hitherto possible. While remaining compatible with the color gamut of sRGB standards, “x.v.Color” expands the color space, and thus can produce more vivid, natural images. En 161 Network information Yamaha technologies SSID CINEMA DSP (Digital Sound Field Processor) SSID (Service Set Identifier) is a name that identifies a particular wireless LAN access point. Since the surround sound systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best experienced Wi-Fi in a theater that has many speakers designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions (such as room size, wall material, and number of speakers) can differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in the sound that you Wi-Fi (Wireless Fidelity) is a technology that allows an electronic device to exchange data or connect to the Internet hear. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, CINEMA DSP, Yamaha’s original DSP technology provides the wirelessly using radio waves. Wi-Fi offers the advantage of eliminating the complexity of making connections with audiovisual experience of a movie theater in your own home. network cables by using wireless connection. Only products that complete Wi-Fi Alliance interoperability tests can carry the “Wi-Fi Certified” trademark. CINEMA DSP HD3 WPS The actually measured sound field data contain the information of the height of the sound images. CINEMA DSP HD3 feature achieves the reproduction of the accurate height of the sound images so that it creates the accurate and WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) is a standard established by the Wi-Fi Alliance, which allows easy establishment of a intensive stereoscopic sound fields in a listening room. wireless home network. Compressed Music Enhancer The Compressed Music Enhancer feature compensates for missing harmonics in compression music formats (such as MP3). As a result, this technology provides improved performance for the overall sound system. SILENT CINEMA Yamaha has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound program, so that accurate representations of all the sound programs can be enjoyed on headphones. Virtual CINEMA DSP Virtual CINEMA DSP allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with front left and right speakers. Even if the surround speakers are not connected, the unit creates the realistic sound field in a listening room. Virtual CINEMA FRONT Virtual CINEMA FRONT allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround speakers with front surround speakers. Even if the surround speakers placed in the front, the unit creates the realistic sound field in a listening room. Virtual Presence Speaker (VPS) Virtual Presence Speaker allows the system to virtually reproduce the height of the 3D sound field without presence speakers. Even if the presence speakers are not connected, the unit creates the 3D sound field in your room. Virtual Surround Back Speaker (VSBS) Virtual Surround Back Speaker allows the system to virtually reproduce the sound field of the surround back speakers. Even if the surround back speakers are not connected, the unit adds a sense of depth to the rear sound filed of CINEMA DSP. En 162 Supported devices and file formats File formats For information about specifications of each file, refer to the instruction manual of your This section explains the devices and file formats supported by the unit. recording device or consult file's help. Supported devices ■ USB/PC (NAS) For information about specifications of each device, refer to the instruction manual of it. File ■ Bluetooth device • The unit supports Bluetooth devices that support A2DP or AVRCP. WAV * • A Bluetooth device may not be detected by the unit or some feature may not be compatible, depending on the model. ■ USB devices • The unit supports USB mass storage class devices (e.g., flash memories or portable audio players) using FAT16 or FAT32 format. • USB devices with encryption cannot be used. 32/44.1/48/88.2/96/ 176.4/192 Quantization bitrate (bit) Bitrate The number of channels Gapless playback 16/24 - 2 , MP3 32/44.1/48 - 8 to 320 2 - WMA 32/44.1/48 - 8 to 320 2 - MPEG-4 AAC 32/44.1/48 - 8 to 320 2 - FLAC 32/44.1/48/88.2/96/ 176.4/192 16/24 - 2 , ALAC 32/44.1/48/88.2/96 16/24 - 2 , AIFF 32/44.1/48/88.2/96/ 176.4/192 16/24 - 2 , DSD 2.8 MHz/5.6 MHz 1 - 2 - • Do not connect devices other than USB mass storage class devices (such as USB chargers or USB hubs), PCs, card readers, an external HDD, etc. Sampling frequency (kHz) • Some features may not be compatible, depending on the model or manufacturer of the USB * Linear PCM format only storage device. Y • To play back FLAC files stored on a PC or NAS, you need to install server software that supports sharing of FLAC ■ AirPlay files via DLNA on your PC or use a NAS that supports FLAC files. AirPlay works with iPhone, iPad, and iPod touch with iOS 4.3.3 or later, Mac with OS X Mountain • Digital Rights Management (DRM) contents cannot be played back. Lion or later, and PC with iTunes 10.2.2 or later. Made for. iPhone 7 Plus, iPhone 7, iPhone SE, iPhone 6s Plus, iPhone 6s, iPhone 6 Plus, iPhone 6, iPhone 5s, iPhone 5c, iPhone 5, iPhone 4s iPad Pro (9.7″ and 12.9″), iPad mini 4, iPad Air 2, iPad mini 3, iPad Air, iPad mini 2, iPad mini, iPad (3rd and 4th generation), iPad 2 iPod touch (5th and 6th generation) (as of March 2017) En 163 Video signal flow Video conversion table Video signals input from a video device to the unit are output X to a TV as shown below. • You can select the resolution and the aspect ratio applied to HDMI-output video processing in “Video Mode” (p.129) in the “Setup” menu. • The unit does not convert 480-line and 576-line video signals interchangeably. Video device The unit HDMI out TV Resolution 480i/576i 480p/576p 720p 1080i 1080p 4K m m m m m m m m m m m 720p m m m m 1080i m m m m 1080p/50, 60 Hz m m m m m m 480i/576i 480p/576p HDMI in HDMI out HDMI HDMI HDMI HDMI HDMI in 1080p/24 Hz m 4K COMPONENT VIDEO in COMPONENT VIDEO m m m m m m m m m m 720p m m m m 1080i m m m m m m m m 480i/576i m COMPONENT VIDEO PR PR PB PB Y Y 480p/576p COMPONENT VIDEO in VIDEO in VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO in 480i/576i m: Available En 164 m m Information on HDMI Multi-zone output Audio signals that can be output to Zone2 vary depending on how you connect the device in This section explains the functions related to HDMI and its signal compatibility. Zone 2 to the unit's output jacks. Using the unit’s internal amplifier (p.30) HDMI Control Using an external amplifier (p.95) HDMI Control allows you to operate external devices via HDMI. If you connect a TV that EXTRA SP jacks ZONE OUT jacks HDMI OUT 2 (ZONE OUT) jack (*1) Digital audio (HDMI) m (*2) m (*2) m (*3) Digital audio (COAXIAL/OPTICAL) m(*4) m (*4) Analog audio (AUDIO) m m USB (*5) m m Operations available from the TV’s remote control Network sources (*5) m m • Standby synchronization TUNER m m • Volume control including mute In \ Zone2 Out supports HDMI Control to the unit with an HDMI cable, you can control the unit (such as power and volume) with TV remote control operations. You can also control playback devices (such as HDMI Control-compatible BD/DVD players) connected to the unit with an HDMI cable. For details on connections, see “Connecting a TV and playback devices” (p.32) and “Connecting video devices (such as BD/DVD players)” (p.34). • Switching to input audio from the TV when the TV input is switched to its built-in tuner m: Available • Switching to input video/audio from the selected playback device *1 Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2” (Audio • Switching between audio output devices (the unit or TV speaker) Output: On) (Example) *2 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input (stereo output [down mixed to 2-channels] when the input source selected in the main zone is selected) Available when “HDMI OUT2 Assign” (p.136) in the “Setup” menu is set to “Zone2” HDMI Control HDMI Control *3 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input (stereo output [down mixed to 2-channels] when the input source selected in the main zone is selected) *4 Available when 2-channel PCM signals are input Playback device also turns off *5 To play back DSD audio in Zone2, select “Main Zone Sync” as the Zone2 input with the web The unit turns off (standby) Turn off the TV control (p.101) or use the party mode (p.99). Operations available from the unit’s remote control • Starting playback on the playback device and turning on the TV with a scene selection (p.61) • Switching the TV input to display the on-screen menu (when ON SCREEN is pressed) • Controlling the playback device (playback and menu operations) using the external device operation keys En 165 (Example) 4 Use the cursor keys (e/r) to select “HDMI”. For details on settings and operating your TV, refer to the instruction manual for the TV. 5 Use the cursor keys (q/w) to select “HDMI Control” and press ENTER. Y 6 Use the cursor keys to select “On”. 7 Press ON SCREEN. HDMI Control HDMI Control Playback starts Turns on and displays video from the playback device Press SCENE 1 To use HDMI Control, you need to perform the following HDMI Control link setup after connecting the TV and playback devices. This setup is required every time you add a new HDMI Control-compatible device to your system. 1 2 Turn on the unit, TV, and playback devices. 3 Control-compatible BD/DVD players). Configure the settings of the unit. 1 Switch the TV input to display video from the unit. 2 Press ON SCREEN. ON SCREEN RETURN 3 4 Turn off the main power of the TV and then turn off the unit and playback devices. 5 6 7 OPTION ON SCREEN Cursor keys ENTER ENTER Enable HDMI Control on the TV and playback devices (such as HDMI DISPLAY Use the cursor keys to select “Setup” and press ENTER. Turn on the unit and playback devices and then turn on the TV. Switch the TV input to display the video from the unit. Check the followings. On the unit: The input to which the playback device is connected is selected. If not, select the input source manually. On the TV: The video from the playback device is displayed. 8 Check that the unit is properly synchronized with the TV by turning off the TV or adjusting the TV volume with the TV remote control. En 166 Y HDMI signal compatibility • If HDMI Control does not work properly, try unplugging the TV in Step 3 and plugging in the TV again in Step 4. It may solve the problem. Also, HDMI Control may not work if the number of connected devices exceeds the • When CPPM copy-protected DVD-Audio is played back, video/audio signals may not be limit. In this case, disable HDMI Control on the devices not in use. output, depending on the type of the DVD player. • If the unit is not synchronized to the TV’s power operations, check the priority of the audio output setting on • The unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or DVI devices. For details, refer to the TV. the instruction manual for each device. • We recommend using TV and playback devices from the same manufacturer so that HDMI Control works more • To decode audio bitstream signals on the unit, set the input source device appropriately so effectively. that the device outputs the bitstream audio signals directly (does not decode the bitstream • We do not assure the operation of all HDMI Control-compatible devices. signals on the playback device). For details, refer to the instruction manual for the playback device. Audio Return Channel (ARC) ARC allows you to input TV audio to the unit with the HDMI cable which transmits video signal to the TV. Check the following after the HDMI Control settings. 1 2 Select a TV program with the TV remote control. Check that the input source of the unit will be automatically switched to “AUDIO 1” and the TV audio will be played back on the unit. If you cannot hear the TV audio, check the following: • “ARC” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu is set to “On”. • The HDMI cable is connected to the ARC-compatible HDMI jack (HDMI jack marked “ARC”) on the TV. Some HDMI jack on the TV is not compatible with ARC. For details, refer to the instruction manual for the TV. Y • If the audio is interrupted while using ARC, set “ARC” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to “Off” and use an audio cable (digital optical or stereo pin cable) to input TV audio to the unit (p.33). • When using ARC, connect a TV with an HDMI cable that supports ARC. X “AUDIO 1” is set as TV audio input at the factory. If you have connected any external device to the AUDIO 1 jacks, use “TV Audio Input” (p.130) in the “Setup” menu to change the TV audio input assignment. To use the SCENE function (p.62), you also need to change the input assignment for SCENE 2. En 167 Trademarks Bluetooth protocol stack (Blue SDK) Copyright 1999-2014 OpenSynergy GmbH Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Dolby Atmos, Dolby Surround, and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. All rights reserved. All unpublished rights reserved. The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ Logo is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance®. The Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ Identifier Mark is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance®. (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) The unit supports DAB/DAB+ tuning. For DTS patents, see http://patents.dts.com. Manufactured under license from DTS, Inc. DTS, the Symbol, DTS in combination with the Symbol, DTS:X, and the DTS:X logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of DTS, Inc. in the United States and/or other countries. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. MusicCast is a trademark or registered trademark of Yamaha Corporation. The terms HDMI, the HDMI Logo, and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries. x.v.Color™ “x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation. Yamaha Eco-Label is a mark that certifies products of high environmental performance. Supports iOS 7 or later for setup using Wireless Accessory Configuration. “Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod, iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards. Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance. iTunes, AirPlay, iPad, iPhone, iPod, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. iPad Air and iPad mini are trademarks of Apple Inc. “SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of Yamaha Corporation. DLNA™ and DLNA CERTIFIED™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of Digital Living Network Alliance. All rights reserved. Unauthorized use is strictly prohibited. Google Noto Fonts (Version 1.001) Windows™ Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the “License”); you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. You may obtain a copy of the License at http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 Internet Explorer, Windows Media Audio and Windows Media Player are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc. Copyright © 2012 Google Inc. All rights reserved. Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software distributed under the License is distributed on an “AS IS” BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License for the specific language governing permissions and limitations under the License. Android™ Google Play™ Android and Google Play are trademarks of Google Inc. The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by Yamaha Corporation is under license. Blu-ray is a trademark of the Blu-ray Disc Association. Explanations regarding GPL This product utilizes GPL/LGPL open-source software in some sections. You have the right to obtain, duplicate, modify, and redistribute this open-source code only. For information on GPL/LGPL open source software, how to obtain it, and the GPL/LGPL license, refer to the Yamaha Corporation website (http://download.yamaha.com/sourcecodes/musiccast/). En 168 Specifications Input jacks • Analog Audio Audio x 9 (AV 1-4, AUDIO 1-3, PHONO, VIDEO AUX) • Digital Audio • Supported Audio Formats • TRIGGER OUT x 2 • RS-232C x 1 – Dolby Atmos HDMI – DTS:X – Dolby TrueHD • HDMI Features Optical x 3 (AV 3, AUDIO 1–2) (Supported sampling frequencies: 32 kHz to 96 kHz) – 4K UltraHD Video (include 4K/60,50Hz 10/12bit) Coaxial x 3 (AV 1-2, AUDIO 3) (Supported sampling frequencies: 32 kHz to 192 kHz) – ARC (Audio Return Channel) • Video Composite x 4 (AV 1-4) Component x 2 (AV 1-2) • HDMI Input HDMI x 8 (AV 1-7, VIDEO AUX) • Others USB x 1 (USB2.0) NETWORK x 1 (100Base-TX/10Base-T) Output jacks • Analog Audio – 3D Video – HDMI Control (CEC) – Dolby Digital Plus – Dolby Digital – DTS-HD Master Audio – DTS-HD High Resolution – DTS Express – Auto Lip Sync – DTS – 21:9 Aspect Ratio – DSD 2.8 MHz 2-ch to 6-ch – Deep Color – PCM 2-ch to 8-ch (Max. 192 kHz/24 bit) – x.v.Color • Content Protection: HDCP compatible – BT.2020 Colorimetry (HDMI [AV 1–7]: HDCP 2.2 compatible) – HDR (High Dynamic Range) – HD audio playback TUNER – Selectable HDMI input in HDMI standby mode • Analog Tuner – HDMI Zone Output [Australia model] • Video Format (Repeater Mode) DAB/FM x 1 (TUNER) – VGA [U.K., Europe and Russia models] – 480i/60 Hz DAB/FM with Radio Data System x 1 (TUNER) *1 Note: Assignment is possible [F.PRESENCE, ZONE2, BI-AMP] – 576i/50 Hz [Other models] – 480p/60 Hz FM/AM x 1 (TUNER) *2 Note: Assignment is possible [SURROUND BACK, ZONE2] – 576p/50 Hz – Speaker Out x 9 (7 ch) (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R, EXTRA SP 1 L/R *1, EXTRA SP 2 L/R *2) – Pre Out x 7 (FRONT L/R, CENTER, SURROUND L/R, SURROUND BACK L/R) – Subwoofer Out x 2 (SUBWOOFER 1-2, mono) – ZONE OUT x 1 (ZONE 2) USB – 720p/60 Hz, 50 Hz • Capable of Mass Storage Class USB Memory – 1080i/60 Hz, 50 Hz – 1080p/60 Hz, 50 Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz – 4K/60 Hz, 50Hz, 30 Hz, 25 Hz, 24 Hz – Headphone x 1 • HDMI Output HDMI OUT x 2 (HDMI OUT 1-2*) * barter to ZONE OUT (ZONE2) Other jacks • YPAO MIC x 1 • REMOTE IN x 1 • REMOTE OUT x 1 En 169 • Current Supply Capacity: 1 A Bluetooth Compatible Decoding Formats • Sink Function • Decoding Format Source Device to AVR (ex. Smartphone/Tablet) • Source Function AVR to Sink Device (ex. Bluetooth Headphone) (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω) Front L/R............................................................................ 135 W/ch Center ............................................................................... 135 W/ch – Dolby Atmos – Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus Surround L/R ..................................................................... 135 W/ch Surround Back L/R ............................................................ 135 W/ch – Dolby Digital (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 4 Ω) • Source Device to AVR (ex. Smartphone/Tablet) – DTS:X • Capable of Play/Stop Operation from Sink Device • Bluetooth Version........................................................... Ver. 2.1+EDR – DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, DTS Express • Supported Profile – DTS 96/24, DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 Front L/R [U.K., Europe and Russia models].................... 170 W/ch • Maximum Effective Output Power (1-channel driven) (1 kHz, 10% THD, 6 Ω) Sink Function .................................................................A2DP, AVRCP – DTS Digital Surround Front L/R............................................................................ 170 W/ch Source Function .............................................................A2DP, AVRCP • Post Decoding Format Center ................................................................................ 170 W/ch • Supported Codec Sink Function ....................................................................... SBC, AAC Source Function ............................................................................SBC • Wireless Output ...................................................... Bluetooth Class 2 Surround L/R ..................................................................... 170 W/ch – Dolby Surround Surround Back L/R ............................................................ 170 W/ch – Neural:X – DTS Neo:6 Music, DTS Neo:6 Cinema Front L/R............................................................................ 165 W/ch • Radio Frequency (Operational Frequency)... 2402 MHz to 2480 MHz Audio Section • Maximum Output Power (E.I.R.P) .......................... 4.0 dBm (2.5 mW) • Rated Output Power (2-channel driven) • Maximum Communication Distance ................................10 m (33 ft) MusicCast • Controlled by MusicCast Application (iOS, Android) • MusicCast Link Client ..................................................... Main, Zone2 • MusicCast Link Master (Input Source) ................................................. NET/USB/Bluetooth, Analog External Input, Digital External Input, Zone2 Center ................................................................................ 165 W/ch (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 6 Ω) Front L/R ..................................................................... 120 W+120 W Center...................................................................................... 120 W Surround L/R............................................................... 120 W+120 W Surround Back L/R...................................................... 120 W+120 W (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.06% THD, 8 Ω) Front L/R ..................................................................... 110 W+110 W • Network Connectivity ....................................Extend Mode, Connect Center...................................................................................... 110 W Network Surround L/R............................................................... 110 W+110 W • PC Client Function • Compatible with DLNA ver. 1.5 • AirPlay supported Surround Back L/R...................................................... 110 W+110 W (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 8 Ω) Center...................................................................................... 120 W • Wi-Fi function Surround L/R............................................................... 120 W+120 W – Capable of sharing with iOS devices by wireless connection and USB connection Surround L/R ..................................................................... 165 W/ch Surround Back L/R ............................................................ 165 W/ch • Dynamic Power (IHF) Front L/R (8/6/4/2 Ω) ............................................135/165/210/280 W • Damping Factor Front L/R, 1 kHz, 8 Ω.........................................................150 or more • Input Sensitivity / Input Impedance PHONO (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω).............................................3.5 mV/47 kΩ AUDIO 2 etc. (1 kHz, 100 W/8 Ω)....................................200 mV/47 kΩ • Maximum Input Signal PHONO (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) .......................................... 45 mV or more AUDIO 2 etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) .....................................2.4 V or more Front L/R ..................................................................... 120 W+120 W • Internet Radio – Capable of WPS by PIN Method and Push-Button-Method (1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 Ω) Surround Back L/R...................................................... 120 W+120 W • Rated Output Power (1-channel driven) (1 kHz, 0.9% THD, 6 Ω) • Rated Output Level / Output Impedance PRE OUT SUBWOOFER (50 Hz) ...................................................... 1.0 V/470 Ω Except SUBWOOFER (1 kHz) .......................................... 1.0 V/470 Ω ZONE OUT.......................................................................... 1.0 V/470 Ω • Maximum Output Level – Capable of Direct Connection with Mobile Device Front L/R ............................................................................140 W/ch – Available Security Method: WEP, WPA2-PSK (AES), Mixed Mode Center.................................................................................140 W/ch – Radio Frequency Band: 2.4 GHz Surround L/R......................................................................140 W/ch – Wireless LAN Standards: IEEE 802.11 b/g/n Surround Back L/R.............................................................140 W/ch – Radio Frequency (Operational Frequency): 2412 MHz to 2472 MHz – Maximum Output Power (E.I.R.P): 17.5 dBm (56.2 mW) En 170 PRE OUT/ZONE OUT ......................................................2.0 V or more • Headphone Impedance ................................................. 16 Ω or more • Frequency Response AUDIO 2 etc. (10 Hz to 100 kHz) .............................................+0/-3 dB • RIAA Equalization Deviation PHONO (20 Hz to 20 kHz) ...................................................... 0±0.5 dB • Total Harmonic Distortion General • Video Signal Level Composite .........................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω Component [U.S.A. and Canada models] .......................................AC 120 V, 60 Hz PHONO to PreOut (1 kHz, 1 V) ........................................0.04% or less Y ......................................................................................1 Vp-p/75 Ω AUDIO 2 etc. to Speaker Out (20 Hz to 20 kHz, 55 W/ 8 Ω) .........................................................................................0.04% or less Pb/Pr ...........................................................................0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network) (Pure Direct, Input 1 kΩ Shorted, Speaker Out) PHONO .......................................................................... 95 dB or more AUDIO 2 etc ................................................................. 110 dB or more • Residual Noise (IHF-A Network) Speaker Out ...................................................................150 μV or less • Channel Separation (Input 1 kΩ Shorted, 1 kHz/10 kHz) PHONO ............................................................... 75 dB/60 dB or more AUDIO 2 etc ........................................................ 75 dB/60 dB or more • Volume Control Main Zone .............................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB (0.5 dB Step) Zone2 ....................................MUTE, -80 dB to +16.5 dB (0.5 dB Step) • Tone Control Characteristics Main Zone • Video Maximum Input Level .................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more [U.K., Europe and Russia models] ..............................AC 230 V, 50 Hz [U.S.A. and Canada models]...........................87.5 MHz to 107.9 MHz [Brazil, Asia and General models] .................................................. 87.5/87.50 MHz to 108.0/108.00 MHz [U.K., Europe and Russia models]..............87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz [Other models] ............................................87.50 MHz to 108.00 MHz • 50 dB Quiet Sensitivity (IHF, 1 kHz, 100% MOD.) Mono............................................................................. 3 μV (20.8 dBf) • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF) Mono/Stereo ....................................................................69 dB/68 dB • Harmonic Distortion (IHF, 1 kHz) Mono/Stereo ...................................................................... 0.5%/0.6% • Antenna Input ..........................................................75 Ω unbalanced • Tuning Range Bass Boost/Cut .................................... ±6.0 dB/50 Hz (0.5 dB Step) Bass Turnover........................................................................ 350 Hz Treble Boost/Cut ............................... ±6.0 dB/20 kHz (0.5 dB Step) Treble Turnover.................................................................... 3.5 kHz • Filter Characteristics [Korea model]..............................................................AC 220 V, 60 Hz [Australia model].........................................................AC 240 V, 50 Hz Treble Boost/Cut ............................... ±6.0 dB/20 kHz (0.5 dB Step) Zone2 [China model] ..............................................................AC 220 V, 50 Hz • Tuning Range Bass Turnover........................................................................ 350 Hz Treble Turnover.................................................................... 3.5 kHz [Brazil and General models] ....AC 110 to 120/220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz FM Section AM section (except Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models) Bass Boost/Cut .................................... ±6.0 dB/50 Hz (0.5 dB Step) • Power Supply [U.S.A. and Canada models]...............................530 kHz to 1710 kHz [Brazil, Asia and General models] ..... 530/531 kHz to 1710/1611 kHz [Other models] ....................................................531 kHz to 1611 kHz DAB section (Australia, U.K., Europe and Russia models only) • Tuning Range ......................................174 MHz to 240 MHz (Band III) (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz) • Support Audio Format............... MPEG 1 Layer II/MPEG-4 HE-AAC v2 H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround Back: Small) ............................................................................................. 12 dB/oct. • Antenna ....................................................................75 Ω unbalanced [Asia model]................................................ AC 220 to 240 V, 50/60 Hz • Power Consumption [U.S.A. and Canada models] ......................................................450 W [Other models] ...........................................................................420 W • Standby Power Consumption HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off, Network Standby Off ......................................................................................................0.1 W HDMI Control On, Standby Through On (No Signals), Network Standby Off...................................................................1.5 W HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off, Network Standby On, Bluetooth Standby Off Wired.........................................................................................1.8 W Wireless (Wi-Fi).........................................................................1.8 W Wireless Direct..........................................................................1.9 W HDMI Control Off, Standby Through Off, Network Standby On (Wired), Bluetooth Standby On...............1.7 W HDMI Control On, Standby Through On, Network Standby On (Wireless Direct), Bluetooth Standby On ...................................2.7 W • Maximum Power Consumption [Brazil, Asia and General models]............................................1190 W • Dimensions (W x H x D) ................................. 435 x 182 x 439 mm (17-1/8” x 7-1/8” x 17-1/4”) * Including legs and protrusions • Reference Dimensions (W x H x D) (with wireless antenna upright) ................................. 435 x 247 x 439 mm (17-1/8” x 9-3/4” x 17-1/4”) • Weight ....................................................................... 14.9 kg (32.8 lbs) L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .............................................................. 24 dB/oct. * The contents of this manual apply to the latest specifications as of the publishing date. To obtain the latest manual, access the Yamaha website then download the manual file. Video Section • Video Signal Type .................................................. NTSC/PAL/SECAM En 171 Yamaha Global Site https://www.yamaha.com/ Yamaha Downloads http://download.yamaha.com/ Manual Development Group © 2017 Yamaha Corporation Published 04/2017 AM-A0 YJ290A0/EN1
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108
  • Page 109 109
  • Page 110 110
  • Page 111 111
  • Page 112 112
  • Page 113 113
  • Page 114 114
  • Page 115 115
  • Page 116 116
  • Page 117 117
  • Page 118 118
  • Page 119 119
  • Page 120 120
  • Page 121 121
  • Page 122 122
  • Page 123 123
  • Page 124 124
  • Page 125 125
  • Page 126 126
  • Page 127 127
  • Page 128 128
  • Page 129 129
  • Page 130 130
  • Page 131 131
  • Page 132 132
  • Page 133 133
  • Page 134 134
  • Page 135 135
  • Page 136 136
  • Page 137 137
  • Page 138 138
  • Page 139 139
  • Page 140 140
  • Page 141 141
  • Page 142 142
  • Page 143 143
  • Page 144 144
  • Page 145 145
  • Page 146 146
  • Page 147 147
  • Page 148 148
  • Page 149 149
  • Page 150 150
  • Page 151 151
  • Page 152 152
  • Page 153 153
  • Page 154 154
  • Page 155 155
  • Page 156 156
  • Page 157 157
  • Page 158 158
  • Page 159 159
  • Page 160 160
  • Page 161 161
  • Page 162 162
  • Page 163 163
  • Page 164 164
  • Page 165 165
  • Page 166 166
  • Page 167 167
  • Page 168 168
  • Page 169 169
  • Page 170 170
  • Page 171 171
  • Page 172 172

Yamaha RX-A1070 de handleiding

Categorie
Auto media-ontvangers
Type
de handleiding